Bosch Appliances Video Game Controller d9412gv3 User Manual

D9412GV3/D7412GV3 v8.11 and Higher  
Program Entry Guide  
EN Control Panels  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide |  
EN | 3  
2.10.2 Command Authorization............................. 60  
2.10.3 Access Control Functions........................... 62  
2.10.5 Configuration Authority................................. 66  
Keypad Programming of the Keypad Programming  
Option 67  
2.10.6 Authority Level Selections.......................... 67  
2.10.7 Access Control Levels................................ 75  
2.10.8 SIA Duress Passcode Options................... 77  
Table of Contents  
1.0  
1.1  
1.2  
Introduction................................................. 5  
Using this Program Entry Guide................... 5  
Guide to Programming Options.................... 6  
1.2.1 Local Keypad Programming......................... 7  
1.3  
Guide to UL 864 Programming Requirements  
9
2.11  
2.12  
Function List............................................... 77  
Relay Parameters ...................................... 78  
2.0  
Panel and Area Wide Parameters ........... 12  
2.1  
Phone ........................................................ 12  
2.12.1 Area Relays ............................................... 79  
When the keypad reads Parameter Saved, your  
selection has been configured.2.2 .Phone Parameters  
2.12.2 Panel-Wide Relays..................................... 81  
13  
2.1  
Passcode or Token Worksheet .................. 82  
2.2  
2.2.1 Special Point/User Reporting..................... 15  
2.3 Routing ...................................................... 17  
Phone Parameters..................................... 14  
2.1.1 User Groups............................................... 83  
2.1.2 Passcodes ................................................. 83  
2.1.3 User Group Window................................... 83  
2.1.4 User Name................................................. 83  
2.1.5 Tokens and Cards...................................... 83  
2.1.6 Reporting and Logging............................... 84  
2.3.1 Called Party Disconnect............................. 17  
2.3.2 Route Number Groups: Which Has the  
Highest Priority?......................................... 17  
2.3.3 Programming Primary and Backup  
Destinations............................................... 18  
2.3.4 Enhanced Routing ..................................... 18  
2.3.5 Programming a Duplicate Report............... 18  
3.0  
3.1  
3.2  
Points......................................................... 87  
Point Index................................................. 87  
Point Responses........................................ 91  
2.3.6 Routing Destination Communication Failures  
................................................................... 18  
3.2.1 Applications for Point Responses 9, D, and E:  
................................................................... 91  
2.3.7 Message Prioritization within a Route Number  
................................................................... 18  
2.3.8 Communication Attempts........................... 18  
2.3.9 Route Group Categories ............................ 21  
2.3.10 Event Priority.............................................. 27  
3.2.2 Characteristics of a Fire Point: ................... 91  
3.3  
3.4  
4.0  
4.1  
Point Assignments ................................... 101  
COMMAND 7 and COMMAND 9.............. 104  
Schedules (Skeds).................................. 105  
Windows .................................................. 105  
2.4  
2.5  
2.6  
Power Supervision..................................... 29  
Printer Parameters..................................... 30  
RPS Parameters........................................ 32  
4.1.1 Opening and Closing................................ 105  
4.1.2 User Group Windows............................... 112  
4.1.3 Holiday Indexes for User Group Windows 114  
2.6.1 Uploading and Downloading Reports......... 32  
2.6.2 Log Threshold Reports............................... 32  
2.6.3 Panel Initiated Unattended RPS................. 32  
4.2  
4.3  
Schedules (Skeds)................................... 114  
Holiday Indexes........................................ 124  
4.3.1 Add/Change/Delete.................................. 124  
Select the baud rate for RPS-to-control panel  
communication when using a PSTN connection.2.7  
Miscellaneous ............................................ 35  
5.0  
5.1  
5.2  
5.3  
5.4  
AUXPARM................................................ 125  
Introduction .............................................. 125  
RPS Requirements .................................. 125  
SDI Automation........................................ 125  
SDI RPS Parameters ............................... 126  
2.7  
2.8  
Miscellaneous ............................................ 36  
Area Parameters........................................ 36  
2.8.1 Area Parameters........................................ 36  
2.8.2 Shared-Area Characteristics...................... 41  
2.8.3 Bell Parameters ......................................... 41  
2.8.4 Open/Close Options................................... 43  
2.8.5 Arming Features ........................................ 47  
5.4.1 Configuration for RPS Over Network........ 127  
5.5 Programming Path Numbers and IP  
Addresses for Enhanced Communications ........... 131  
5.5.1 Ant-Replay Security Feature .................... 135  
5.6  
SDI RPS/Enhanced Communications  
2.9  
Keypad (Command Center) ....................... 50  
Configuration ........................................................ 135  
2.9.1 Keypad (Command Center) Assignment.... 50  
2.9.2 Area Text ................................................... 56  
5.7  
5.8  
5.9  
6.0  
Route Group Parameters ......................... 136  
Miscellaneous .......................................... 137  
Cross Point Parameters ........................... 139  
ACCESS CONTROL................................ 140  
2.10  
User Interface ............................................ 59  
2.10.1 Commands ................................................ 60  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide |  
EN | 4  
6.1  
6.2  
6.3  
7.0  
Door Profile.............................................. 140 Table 25: Authority Level Selections.................... 67  
Strike Profile............................................. 143 Table 26: L## Secure Door-Door Mode Definitions  
............................................................ 71  
Table 27: Bypassing a Point................................ 98  
Table 28: P### Relay Codes/Relays................. 103  
Table 29: Window Selections ............................ 105  
Event Profile............................................. 145  
SIA CP-01 Quick Reference................... 147  
Programming Prompts Directory....................... 148  
Table 30: Programming for Two Same Day  
Figures  
Opening Windows (refer to Figure 5). 108  
Figure 1: D1255 Keypad Programming Menu and  
Page References................................... 7  
Table 31: Programming to Link Two Days over  
Midnight*............................................ 108  
Figure 2: D1260 Keypad Programming Menu and  
Page References................................... 8  
Table 32: Programming Example: Linking Two  
Closing Windows over Midnight......... 109  
Figure 3: Softkey Locations on the D1260 Keypad  
............................................................ 58  
Figure 4: User Group 122 Example ........................ 84  
Figure 5: Example Opening Window Timeline (using  
two Opening Windows on same day) 107  
Figure 6: COMMAND 43 Flow Chart (D1255)....... 128  
Figure 7: COMMAND 43 Flow Chart (D1265)....... 129  
Figure 8: Poll Rate Timeline.................................. 134  
Table 33: Opening and Closing Windows  
Worksheet ......................................... 111  
Table 34: Opening and Closing Windows.......... 111  
Table 35: Normal Store Hours*.......................... 111  
Table 36: Delivery Schedule* ............................ 112  
Table 37: Monthly Auditor’s Schedule*.............. 112  
Table 38: Cross Point Ranges Within Groups ... 140  
Table 39: Effects of Programming on Custom  
Function Activation ............................ 141  
Table 40: Programming the Control Panels for SIA  
CP--01 Compliance ........................... 147  
Tables  
Table 1:  
Differences between the D9412GV3 and  
D7412GV3............................................. 5  
Table 2:  
Table 3:  
Table 4:  
Literature Referenced............................ 5  
UL 864 Programming Requirements ..... 9  
UL 864 Programming Recommendations  
............................................................ 11  
Table 5:  
Table 6:  
Modem IIIa2 Communication Format Data  
- User ID Numbers............................... 15  
Modem IIIa2 Communication Format Data  
– Point Numbers.................................. 15  
Table 7:  
Table 8:  
Table 9:  
D6000 User IDs and Zones ................. 15  
SDI Path Number by Device................ 18  
Fire Reports......................................... 21  
Table 10: Burglar Reports ................................... 21  
Table 11: User Reports ....................................... 22  
Table 12: Test Reports........................................ 23  
Table 13: Diagnostic Reports .............................. 24  
Table 14: Relay Reports...................................... 24  
Table 15: Auto-Function Reports......................... 25  
Table 16: RPS Reports........................................ 25  
Table 17: Point Reports....................................... 26  
Table 18: User Change Reports.......................... 26  
Table 19: Access Reports ................................... 27  
Table 20:Event Descriptions, Priorities, and Numbers  
............................................................ 27  
Table 21: Verify Time .......................................... 39  
Table 22: CF### Key Strokes ............................. 58  
Table 23: CF### Custom Function Keystrokes ... 58  
Table 24: Keypad Programming Choices ............ 60  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 1.0 Introduction  
EN | 5  
Table 2: Literature Referenced  
1.0 Introduction  
1.1  
Using this Program Entry Guide  
Document Name  
Part Number  
This guide is only for programming the D9412GV3  
and D7412GV3 Control Panels.  
D1255 Installation Instructions  
74-06819-000  
74-06925-000  
D1256/D1257 Installation  
Instructions  
D1255RBD1256RBD1257RB  
Installation Instructions  
D1260 Installation Guide  
D1260 Owner’s Manual  
D6500 Report Directory  
Although this guide specifically refers to the  
D9412GV3 Control Panels, it can be used for  
programming the D7412GV3 Control Panels.  
Differences between the D9412GV3 and D7412GV3  
are shown in Table 1 on page 5.  
F01U011791  
48101  
50410  
Table 1: Differences between the D9412GV3  
and D7412GV3  
74-04651-001  
4998122702  
Conettix D6600/6100  
Receiver/Gateway Program Entry  
Guide  
Features  
D9412GV3  
D7412GV3  
Access Control  
Eight Doors Two Doors  
Conettix D6600/6100  
Receiver/Gateway Computer  
Interface Manual  
4998122703  
Expanded users  
D720 Series Installation Guide  
74-06918-000  
32206  
Passcodes  
Cards/tokens  
249  
996  
16  
99  
396  
4
D9210B Operation and  
Installation Guide  
D9210B Program Entry Guide  
D9210B Program Record Sheet  
Passcode-protected  
custom functions  
Number of printers  
Number of points  
Number of relays  
Areas  
32207  
3
1
32208  
246  
128  
32  
75  
64  
8
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 Operation  
and Installation Guide  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 Program  
Record Sheet  
F01U143070  
F01U170809  
4998141259  
RPS Installation Guide  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 1.0 Introduction  
EN | 6  
1.2  
Guide to Programming Options  
Full configuration of the control panel is only achieved through use of the Remote Programming Software  
(RPS). A limited keypad programmer’s mode is available to modify some of the more commonly changed  
parameters.  
This guide is set up in a specific order. Related program entries are grouped together in modules as they  
appear in RPS.  
This guide shows the programming options for each programming prompt. Each option is listed with:  
The Program Item Prompt: Each prompt is shown as it appears in RPS. Refer to the RPS Installation  
Guide (P/N: 4998141259).  
Program Entry Default Setting: Because defaults are set for the typical installation, programming each  
prompt might not be necessary. Review the default entries in the program record sheet shipped with the  
control panel to determine which prompts must be programmed.  
Program Entry Selections: Only the selections listed can be used for a particular program item.  
Program Entry Description: Describes the various entry selections. Read the descriptions carefully to  
avoid improperly programmed equipment.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 1.0 Introduction  
1.2.1 Local Keypad Programming  
EN | 7  
GV3 now offers a Local Keypad Programming menu with the Service Passcode only. It includes all custom  
options. For a list of program items you can set using Keypad Programming, refer to Figure 1 on page 7 and  
Figure 2 on page 8. To access the Keypad Programming menu, the Keypad Programming option must be set  
to P (refer to Section 2.10.5 Configuration Authorityon page 66), and all control panel areas must be disarmed.  
Figure 1: D1255 Keypad Programming Menu and Page References  
Refer to Phone #  
on page 12.  
Refer to Phone # Format  
on page 13.  
Refer to Enhanced Comm  
on pages 130 to 132.  
Refer to R# Primary Device  
on page 18 and R# Backup Device on page 19.  
Refer to RPS Passcode  
on page 32.  
Refer to RPS Phone #  
on page 34.  
Refer to RPS IP Address #  
on page 129.  
Refer to RPS Port Number  
on page 129.  
Refer to Area# Area On on page 36 and  
Area# Account Number on page 36.  
Refer to CC# Enhanced Command  
Center on page 51 and  
CC# Scope on page 55.  
Refer to P### Point Index  
on page 101.  
Refer to 2.10.5 Configuration Authority  
on page 67.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 1.0 Introduction  
EN | 8  
Figure 2: D1260 Keypad Programming Menu and Page References  
Refer to Phone #  
on page 12.  
Refer to Phone # Format  
on page 13.  
Refer to Enhanced Comm  
on pages 130 to 132.  
Refer to R# Primary Device  
on page 18 and R# Backup Device on page 19.  
Refer to RPS Passcode  
on page 32.  
Refer to RPS Phone #  
on page 34.  
Refer to RPS IP Address #  
on page 129.  
Refer to RPS Port Number  
on page 129.  
Refer to Area# Area On on page 36  
and Area# Account Number on  
page 36.  
Refer to CC# Enhanced Command  
Center on page 51 and  
CC# Scope on page 55.  
Refer to P### Point Index  
on page 101.  
Refer to 2.10.5 Configuration Authority  
on page 67.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 1.0 Introduction  
EN | 9  
1.3  
Guide to UL 864 Programming Requirements  
This section identifies the programming requirements you must make in order to comply with UL 864  
Commercial Fire applications.  
NOTICE TO USERS, INSTALLERS, AUTHORITIES HAVING JURISDICTION, AND OTHER  
INVOLVED PARTIES  
This product incorporates field-programmable software. In order for the product to comply with the  
requirements in the Standard for Control Units and Accessories for Fire Alarm Systems, UL 864,  
you must limit certain programming features or options to specific values. Refer to Table 3.  
Table 3: UL 864 Programming Requirements  
Product Feature/Option Permitted in  
UL 864? (Y/N)  
Possible Settings Settings Permitted in  
UL 864  
Refer to  
Page:  
If using two phone lines:  
Phone 1 through 4  
Yes  
24 characters  
Program a valid phone  
number  
12  
Phone Supervision  
Alarm On Fail  
Buzz On Fail  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
0 to 240 sec  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
10 to 200 sec  
Set to No  
Set to Yes  
16  
16  
16  
16  
Two Phone Lines  
Yes / No  
Set to Yes when using  
PSTN communications.  
Expand Test Report  
Fire Reports  
R# Fire Supervisory  
Missing  
Yes  
Yes/No  
Yes / No  
Yes/No  
Set to Yes  
Set to Yes  
Set to Yes  
17  
Yes  
Required  
21  
21 (Table 9)  
Test Reports  
AC Fail Report  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Required  
Required  
Required  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
1:00 to 90:00 min  
10 to 300 sec  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
Set to Yes  
Set to Yes  
Set to Yes  
Set to Yes  
Set to Yes  
Set to Yes  
Set to Yes  
Set to Yes  
Set to Yes  
Set to Yes  
Set to Yes  
Set to Yes  
Enter 1:00  
10 to 200 sec  
Set to Yes  
Set to Yes  
22  
23 (Table 13)  
23 (Table 13)  
23 (Table 13)  
23 (Table 13)  
23 (Table 13)  
26 (Table 17)  
26 (Table 17)  
26 (Table 17)  
26 (Table 17)  
26 (Table 17)  
26 (Table 17)  
29  
AC Restoral Report  
Battery Missing Report  
Low Battery Report  
Battery Restoral Report  
R# Service Start Report  
R# Service End Report  
R# Fire Walk St Report  
R# Fire Walk End Report Required  
R# Walk Test St Report Required  
R# Walk Test End Report Required  
AC Fail Time  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
AC Fail Display  
AC Tag Along  
AC/Battery Buzz  
29  
29  
30  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 1.0 Introduction  
EN | 10  
Table 3: UL 864 Programming Requirements (continued)  
Product Feature/Option Permitted in  
UL 864? (Y/N)  
Possible Settings Settings Permitted in  
Refer to  
Page:  
UL 864  
Bat Fail/Restoral Report  
Area 1 Area On  
Yes  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
Set to Yes  
Set to Yes  
30  
Required to  
send system  
status reports  
36  
A# Delay Restoral  
Verify Time  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes / No  
Set to Yes  
60 sec  
38  
38  
42  
51  
54  
56  
65  
10 to 60 sec  
1 to 90 min  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
Area # Fire Time  
CC# Supervised  
CC# Trouble Tone  
CC# Scroll Lock  
Remote Program  
5 min (check with AHJ)  
Set to Yes  
Set to Yes  
Set to Yes  
Set to P  
Disable /  
Enable  
-, E, or P  
A# Fire Bell  
A# Reset Sensors  
U### Area # Auth  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
0 to 128, A, B, C  
0 to 128, A, B, C  
0 to 8  
Program with a relay  
Program with a relay  
Program an Authority  
Level for the Fire Area  
79  
79  
85  
U### Passcode  
Yes  
3-, 4-, 5-, or 6-digit Must program at least  
85  
passcode  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
one passcode  
Set to No  
Set to No  
Set to No  
P## Silent Bell  
P## Invisible Point  
P## Local While  
Disarmed  
No  
No  
No  
93  
94  
96  
P## Local While Armed  
P## Disable Restorals  
P## Bypassable  
P## Swinger Bypass  
P## Fire Point  
P## Resettable  
Sked## Function Code  
Sked## Defer Test  
No  
No  
No  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Required  
No  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
1 to 11, 13 to 28  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
Set to No  
Set to No  
Set to No  
Set to No  
Set to Yes  
As required  
Sked Function Code 9  
Set to No  
97  
97  
98  
99  
100  
100  
114  
117  
117  
Sked## Hourly Test  
(Report?)  
No  
Set to No  
Sked## Time  
Sked## Date  
Enter valid time 00:00 to 23:59  
00:00 to 23:59  
Set to No  
123  
123  
123  
123  
123  
123  
123  
123  
123  
123  
No  
mm/dd  
Sked## Sunday  
Sked## Monday  
Sked## Tuesday  
Sked## Wednesday  
Sked## Thursday  
Sked## Friday  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
Set to Yes  
Set to Yes  
Set to Yes  
Set to Yes  
Set to Yes  
Set to Yes  
Set to Yes  
Set to No  
Sked## Saturday  
Sked## Xept On Holiday No  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 1.0 Introduction  
EN | 11  
Table 3: UL 864 Programming Requirements (continued)  
Product Feature/Option Permitted in  
UL 864? (Y/N)  
Possible Settings Settings Permitted in  
Refer to  
Page:  
UL 864  
For IP Communications to a D6600 Receiver  
Enhanced Comm  
Path1 IP Add1 (2, 3 or 4) Yes  
Yes  
Yes / No  
000 to 255  
Set to Yes  
Program a valid IP  
address  
131  
131  
Path 1 Poll Rate  
Path 1 Ack Wait  
Path 1 Retry Count  
SDI 88 Supervision  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
0, 5 to 65535 sec* Program as necessary  
0, 5 to 65535 sec* Program as necessary  
132  
135  
135  
136  
0 to 255  
Yes / No  
Program as necessary  
Set to Yes  
For Ground Fault Enable Switch  
(Refer to the  
Yes  
Closed = Enabled Closed  
Open = Disabled  
N/A  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3  
Operation and Installation  
Guide (P/N:  
F01U143070)  
* Set the Path 1 Poll Rate to 65535 for 24 hr.  
The following programmable parameters are recommended by Bosch when installing a commercial fire alarm  
system. Always check with your local Authority Having Jurisdiction.  
Table 4: UL 864 Programming Recommendations  
Prompt  
Possible Settings  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
Recommendation  
Phone Line Fail Report  
Phone Line Restoral Report  
Fire Walk Start Report  
Fire Walk End Report  
Cancel Report  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes / No  
CC# Scope  
Panel Wide, Account Wide, Area  
Wide, Custom, No Keypad  
Do not program No Keypad  
CC# Enhanced Command  
Center  
Yes / No  
Set to Yes, if applicable  
CC# Menu Key Lock  
Reset Sensors  
Fire Test  
Yes / No  
Disable/Enable/Passcode Protect  
Disable / Enable / Passcode Protect Enable  
If using D1256RB, set to No  
Enable  
L## Reset Sensors  
Disable / Enable  
If Reset Sensor is set to Passcode  
Protect, set this to Enable  
L## Fire Test  
Disable / Enable  
If Fire Test is set to Passcode  
Protect, set this to Enable  
U### User Group  
0 to 8  
Program as 0  
P## Ring Until Restored  
Yes / No  
May be required for Waterflow,  
otherwise No  
P## Cross Point  
D# Fire Unlock  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
Set to No for Fire devices.  
No  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 12  
Phone #  
2.0 Panel and Area Wide  
Parameters  
This section has twelve programming categories:  
Default:  
Blank  
Selection:  
Up to 24 characters  
Numbers 0 through 9  
3-sec pause  
0 to 9  
C
Phone  
Phone Parameters  
Routing  
D
7-sec dial-tone detection  
Used for the same purpose as  
pressing this key on a telephone  
keypad when manually dialing. For  
example, an asterisk (*) may be  
needed to access your long distance  
service. Do not use these characters  
when pulse dialing.  
Area Parameters  
Power Supervision  
Printer Parameters  
RPS Parameters  
Miscellaneous  
Area Parameters  
Keypad  
# or *  
Blank  
Control panel dials no phone number.  
Programming this item Blank does  
not disable phone routing. To disable  
reporting to this phone, refer to  
Section 2.3 Routing on page 17.  
User Interface  
Function List  
Relay Parameters.  
This is the telephone number the control panel dials to  
contact the central station receiver when sending  
event reports. This number is Phone 1 referred to in  
the prompts in Section 2.3 Routing on page 17.  
2.1  
Phone  
The control panel can dial as many as four different  
telephone numbers when sending event reports.  
Refer to Section 2.3 Routing on page 17 for  
information about event report routing and  
communication protocols.  
The control panel waits for a break in the dial tone  
after dialing the first digit. If the control panel must dial  
a digit (for example, 9) to access an outside line, place  
a C before the phone number. The control panel waits  
2 sec and does not wait for the dial tone break.  
When using PSTN telephone lines,  
program two telephone numbers to  
meet UL 864 requirements.  
The control panel is programmed with a 7-sec dial  
tone detect period. When a dial tone is detected or the  
waiting period ends, the control panel begins to dial.  
To extend the dial tone detect period, place a D before  
the phone number. To insert a pause during or after  
dialing, use C in the number sequence. For example,  
if the control panel hangs up before it hears the  
Modem IIIa2 ACK tone from the D6500 or D6600,  
program extra Cs after the phone number. The control  
panel waits on line for two extra seconds for each C  
programmed.  
Enter up to 24 of the characters shown in the Phone #  
table to define dialing characteristics.  
For SIA CP-01 Compliance  
Call Waiting Disable  
If the telephone system at the installation site uses the  
Call Waiting feature, ensure that the primary  
telephone reporting number is programmed to disable  
Call Waiting.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 13  
If you program the primary phone number with a  
sequence to temporarily disable Call Waiting  
(typically *70 pause, but verify with the phone service  
provider) followed by the phone number, you should  
program the backup phone number without the Call  
Waiting cancel sequence. If the subscriber cancels  
Call Waiting without notifying their alarm installing  
company, the control panel can still send reports  
using the backup number.  
Keypad Programming of Phone #  
D1255  
1. Refer to Figure 1 on page 7 to access Keypad  
Programming and navigate to the PHONE  
NUMBERS option.  
2. At the PHONE 1 - 4 prompt, enter the phone  
number you wish to configure and press [ENT].  
The current phone number shows.  
If the current phone number is longer  
than 20 characters, use the [PREV] and  
[NEXT] keys to scroll to view the  
additional characters.  
Dialing a Call Waiting sequence on a  
non-Call Waiting line prevents the system  
from dialing the central station receiver  
successfully.  
3. Press [ENT] to change the phone number.  
4. The [PREV] button acts as a [Backspace] key and  
the [COMMAND] key scrolls through special  
characters. Press [PREV] to delete the characters  
of the phone number, and then enter the new  
phone number. Press [COMMAND] to cycle  
through the special dialing characters {*, #, C, D},  
then press [NEXT] to choose a character.  
Example: If the central station telephone  
number is 555-1234, and the primary  
Route Group destination is Phone 1,  
program Phone 2 with the following  
sequence: *70C5551234.  
5. Press [ENT] to save the phone number.  
6. When the keypad reads PARAMETER SAVED,  
your selection has been configured.  
D1260  
1. Refer to Figure 2 on page 8 to access Keypad  
Programming and navigate to the Phone  
Numbers option and press the corresponding  
softkey.  
2. At the Phone (1-4) prompt, enter the phone  
number you wish to configure and press [ENTER].  
The current phone number shows.  
If the current phone number is longer  
than 20 characters, the Previous and  
Next softkeys appear. Use the softkeys to  
scroll to view the additional characters.  
3. Press the Edit softkey to change the phone  
number.  
4. The Pause (3 sec pause - "C") and DT Detect  
(Dial Tone Detect - "D") softkeys enter special  
characters. The Backspace softkey allows you to  
erase characters. The Clear softkey allows you to  
clear the entire phone number. The [COMMAND]  
and [ENTER] keys allow you to enter an * or a #.  
Use the softkeys, the number buttons, and the  
[COMMAND] and [ENTER] keys on the keypad to  
enter the new phone number.  
5. Press the Save softkey.  
When the keypad reads Parameter Saved, your  
selection has been configured.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 14  
2.2  
Phone Parameters  
Point/User Flag  
The program items in this category describe panel-  
wide characteristics for telephone dialing, receiver  
format, and supervision.  
Default:  
Yes  
Yes or No  
Selection:  
Phone # Format  
Yes  
The control panel sends a flag with  
each report telling the D6500 or  
D6600 to convert point numbers and  
User ID numbers to COMEX format.  
Refer to Table 5 and Table 6 for  
conversion information. When this  
parameter is programmed Yes,  
points and User ID numbers are  
converted, regardless of the  
programming of the D6500 or D6600  
Receiver for output to the computer  
system. Refer to Appendix C in the  
Conettix D6600/D6100  
Default:  
Modem IIIa2  
Modem IIIa2 or Contact ID  
Selection:  
Modem IIIa2 Modem IIIa2 Communication Format  
Contact ID ANSI-SIA Contact ID  
Central Station Receiver Format for Transmission  
of Reports: Modem format provides many reporting  
advantages over the Contact ID format. Refer to the  
D6500 Report Directory (P/N: 74-04651-001) for  
more information about the effect of reporting  
formats.  
Receiver/Gateway Computer  
Interface Manual (P/N: 4998122703).  
Reports identify points as 001 through 247 and  
passcode User ID codes as 000 through 249 at the  
D6500 or D6600 Receiver (unless Point/User Flag is  
programmed Yes; refer to the Point/User Flag  
prompt in this section). When reporting point events,  
Modem IIIa2 Communication Format also sends point  
text to the D6500 or D6600 as programmed in Point  
Assignments.  
No  
The control panel does not send the  
flag. The D6500 or D6600 outputs  
point numbers as 001 to 247 (rather  
than 100 to 732) and User ID  
numbers as 000 to 249 (rather than  
000 to F08), as indicated in Table 5  
and Table 6.  
Keypad Programming of Phone # Format  
This program item determines how point and User ID  
numbers are presented at the D6500 or D6600  
display, printer, and computer RS-232 output.  
D1255  
1. Refer to Figure 1 on page 7 to access Keypad  
Programming and navigate to the PHONE  
PARAMETERS option.  
2. At the PHONE 1 - 4 prompt, enter the phone  
route number you wish to configure and press  
[ENT].  
3. Press [NEXT] or [PREV] to toggle between  
Contact ID and ModemIIIa2 and press [ENT] to  
select the desired phone format.  
When Phone # Format is Yes, the control panel  
sends expanded Bosch Modem IIIa2 Communication  
Format reports to the D6500 or D6600. If your central  
station data files are not set up for point and User ID  
number reporting, you can use this program item to  
convert these numbers to COMEX Reports.  
When Phone # Format is Yes, the control panel  
sends expanded Bosch Modem IIIa2 Communication  
Format Reports to the receiver. Point/User Flag  
affects Bosch Modem IIIa2 Communication Format  
data as shown in Table 5. The Bosch Security  
Systems, Inc. D6500 or D6600 Receiver adds the  
leading zero in the User ID number with Point/User  
Flag programmed No.  
When the keypad reads PARAMETER SAVED, your  
selection has been configured.  
D1260  
1. Refer to Figure 2 on page 8 to access Keypad  
Programming and navigate to the Phone  
Parameters option and press the corresponding  
softkey.  
2. At the Phone (1-4) prompt, enter the phone route  
number you wish to configure and press  
[ENTER]. The current configuration shows.  
3. Press the Edit softkey to change the phone  
format.  
4. Select the softkey for the option to which you  
wish to change. Press the Save softkey  
When the keypad reads Parameter Saved, your  
selection has been configured.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 15  
2.2.1 Special Point/User Reporting  
Table 5: Modem IIIa2 Communication Format  
Independent Zone Control Notice: When using  
Independent Zone Controls (IZC) to send  
Data - User ID Numbers  
Opening/Closing Reports by point, do not duplicate  
reporting independent point numbers with User ID  
Reports (refer to Section 2.1 Passcode or Token  
Worksheet on page 82). For example: If an IZC is  
connected to Point 8, do not use User ID 8.  
Point/User Flag  
NO  
000  
Point/User Flag  
YES  
000  
001 to 005  
006 to 013  
014 to 021  
022 to 029  
030 to 037  
038 to 045  
046 to 053  
054 to 061  
062 to 069  
070 to 249  
001 to 005  
601 to 608  
701 to 708  
801 to 808  
B01 to B08  
C01 to C08  
D01 to D08  
E01 to E08  
F01 to F08  
000  
D6000: Opening/Closing User ID numbers are  
identified at the receiver as zones (same identification  
as independent points). Refer to Table 7.  
Table 7: D6000 User IDs and Zones  
User ID  
Number  
Zone  
User ID  
Number  
Zone  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
B
C
D
E
F
6
91  
92  
93  
04  
95  
96  
1
2
3
4
5
0
Table 6: Modem IIIa2 Communication Format  
Data – Point Numbers  
7
8
Point/User Flag  
NO  
Point/User Flag  
YES  
DTMF Dialing  
001 to 008  
009 to 024  
025 to 040  
041 to 056  
057 to 072  
073 to 088  
089 to 104  
105 to 120  
121 to 136  
153 to 168  
169 to 184  
185 to 200  
201 to 216  
217 to 232  
233 to 247  
100 to 800  
101 to 116  
201 to 216  
301 to 316  
401 to 416  
501 to 516  
601 to 616  
701 to 716  
801 to 816  
217 to 232  
317 to 332  
417 to 432  
517 to 532  
617 to 632  
717 to 731  
Default:  
Yes  
Yes or No  
Selection:  
Yes  
Dials the programmed phone  
number(s) using DTMF.  
No  
Pulse dialing only.  
Use dual-tone multi-frequency (DTMF) to dial the  
central station receiver phone number(s) for event  
reports, or to dial the remote programming software  
(RPS).  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 16  
Phone Supv Time  
Buzz on Fail  
Default:  
0
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Selection:  
0, 10 to 240  
Yes or No  
0
No phone line supervision.  
Yes  
Generate panel-wide trouble tones  
and display PHONE FAIL # at  
keypads when a Phone Fail Event  
occurs.  
10 to 240  
Enter the number of seconds (in 10  
sec increments) you wish to wait  
before indicating trouble. After a  
faulted phone line restores, it takes  
the same amount of time to start  
restoral responses.  
No  
Does not generate trouble tones at  
keypads when a Phone Fail Event  
occurs. PHONE FAIL # still displays.  
Phone line trouble responses: Keypads display  
SERVC PH LINE # to indicate which phone line  
failed. The keypad initiates a trouble tone if Buzz on  
Fail is Yes and CC Trouble Tone is Yes.  
To meet UL 864 requirements, set this  
parameter to Yes.  
With dual phone lines (using the D928 Module), the  
restored phone line handles all messages regardless  
of the phone line’s number.  
Phone Supv Time must be programmed  
to use this feature.  
Phone, Trouble, and Restoral Events report when  
they occur. They report also when a Diagnostic  
Report is initiated from a keypad or by a Sked.  
When Buzz on Fail is Yes, users can disable the  
resulting trouble tone on individual keypads by setting  
CC# Trouble Tone to No.  
To meet UL 864 requirements, set this  
parameter to a non-zero value.  
Two Phone Lines  
Default:  
No  
Alarm On Fail  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Default:  
No  
Yes  
The D928 Dual Phone Line Module  
is installed. The LEDs on the D928  
light to indicate primary or secondary  
line trouble and COMM FAIL.  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes  
Generate alarm responses when a  
phone line fails.  
No  
D928 Dual Phone Line Module is not  
installed.  
No  
Phone failures report as trouble  
responses for Area 1 or the account  
number associated with Area 1.  
When using two telephone lines, set this  
parameter to Yes to meet UL 864  
requirements.  
To meet UL 864 requirements, set this  
parameter to No.  
Program Phone Supv Time when using  
two phone lines.  
Phone Supv Time must be programmed  
to use this feature.  
Phone Failure Alarm Responses: The Alarm Bell  
relay for Area 1 activates. All Phone Event messages  
report as Area 1 and the account number for Area 1.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 17  
2.3 Routing  
Expand Test Report  
Use routing to select full or partial groups of events to  
report to up to eight different destinations (four over  
phone, four over network).Routing includes choosing  
the most important destination (route number),  
reporting the events to a single or multiple destination,  
and selecting a backup destination if the events fail.  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
Off-normal events listed in Routing  
Group Test Reports are reported to  
the central station.  
Event routing can be sent over one of the following:  
Off-normal conditions for the events  
listed in the Routing Group Test  
Reports at test time are not reported.  
Standard telephone lines  
Local-area network (LAN)  
Wide-area network (WAN)  
General Packet Radio System (GPRS)  
Use this program item to add system event  
information to scheduled Test Reports. Refer to  
Section 4.2 Schedules (Skeds) on page 114.  
Sending events over a LAN or WAN requires a  
network interface module (NIM), such as the DX4020.  
Sending events over GPRS requires a special NIM  
(ITS-DX4020-G).  
This parameter relates to Sked Function  
Code 9 (Test Report) because it allows a  
Sked to send Expanded Test Report  
information. Expand Test Report does  
not affect Sked Function Codes 28  
(Expanded Off-Normal Test Report) and  
29 (Non-Expanded Off-Normal Test  
Report).  
2.3.1 Called Party Disconnect  
Telephone companies provide called party disconnect  
to allow the called party to terminate a call. The called  
party must go on hook (hang up) for a fixed interval  
before a dial tone is available for a new call. This  
interval varies with telephone company equipment.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 firmware allows for called party  
disconnect by adding a 35-sec on-hook interval to the  
dial-tone detect function. If the control panel does not  
detect a dial tone in 7 sec, it puts the phone line on  
hook for 35 sec to activate called party disconnect.  
The phone line goes off hook and begins a 7-sec dial  
tone detect. If no dial tone is detected, the control  
panel dials the number anyway. Each time the number  
is dialed, the control panel records this as an attempt.  
After ten attempts, the control panel enters  
communications failure and Comm Fail Route #  
appears on the keypads.  
2.3.2 Route Number Groups: Which Has the  
Highest Priority?  
To program a group, first choose a route number. The  
lower the route number, the higher priority that group  
has (for example, events reported for Route 1 have a  
higher priority than Routes 2, 3, or 4 if each group tries  
to send a message at the same time). The priority of  
the route numbers becomes important when  
programming duplicate reports or choosing the events  
you want to report first regardless of the number of  
events that must report to multiple groups. Route 1  
group primary device is the first destination the control  
panel attempts to dial if an event in that group must be  
reported. If the control panel is idle, any event  
generated for any group starts a dialing sequence.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 18  
2.3.3 Programming Primary and Backup  
Table 8: SDI Path Number by Device  
Destinations  
Each route number has an R# Primary Device and  
an R# Backup Device. For example, if two phone  
numbers are programmed, the R# Primary Device  
destination is the phone number that the route group  
attempts to dial first. If the R# Primary Device  
destination does not connect to the central station  
receiver after two dialing attempts, the control panel  
dials the R# Backup Device destination.  
Path  
1
2
3
4
SDI 88  
SDI 92  
88  
92  
89  
93  
90  
94  
91  
95  
When all attempts to both the R# Primary Device and  
R# Backup Device fail, a COMM FAIL RG# event is  
generated. COMM RESTORE RG# events are  
generated when a successful report (via phone or IP)  
or a successful poll (via IP) is sent over either route  
within the failed Route Group, even if the report is sent  
using a different Route Group.  
You can also program the control panel so that the  
R# Primary Device or the R# Backup Device uses  
an SDI device, such as a Network Interface Module.  
With enhanced communications, the R# Primary  
Device destination can be either the phone number  
or the path number for the SDI device, to which the  
route group first attempts to send the event. If the R#  
Primary Device destination fails to connect to the  
central station receiver after two attempts, the control  
panel attempts to connect with the R# Backup  
Device destination.  
The same COMM TROUBLE conditions occur if the  
control panel does not receive a positive  
acknowledgement to a poll from the central station  
receiver after the configured number of retries. Refer  
to Path # Poll Rate on page 132.  
2.3.7 Message Prioritization within a Route  
Number  
The D9412GV3/D7412GV3 Control Panels meet the  
digital reporting requirements for UL 864. Fire Alarm  
Events have the highest priority and reports are sent  
first for each group. Other events are sent in the  
following order: Panic, Duress, Medical, Intrusion  
Alarm, Supervisory, and all troubles and restorals.  
2.3.4 Enhanced Routing  
The D9412GV3 and D7412GV3 allow events to be  
sent to up to four additional SDI Paths. The network  
interface modules (NIMs) connect directly to the SDI  
Bus and occupy SDI Address 88 or 92. For additional  
information regarding the specific programming  
requirements for enhanced communications, refer to  
Section 5.5 Programming Path Numbers and IP  
Addresses for Enhanced Communications on page  
131.  
To comply with NFPA and UL 864 ,  
program Route 1 to send a report of only  
Fire Alarm Events to ensure the fastest  
reporting time.  
2.3.5 Programming a Duplicate Report  
2.3.8 Communication Attempts  
Select Yes for each available route number to allow  
an event within a group to send a report to multiple  
groups. For instance, if fire alarms are programmed  
for Route Group 1 and Route Group 2, a fire alarm  
sends a report first to Route Group 1, followed by a  
duplicate report to Route Group 2.  
The control panel makes up to ten communication  
attempts using the primary and backup devices within  
a route group. If unsuccessful, it sends a Comm Fail  
Report. The communication attempts occur in the  
following sequence:  
1. Primary device  
2. Primary device  
3. Backup device  
4. Backup device  
5. Primary device  
6. Backup device  
7. Primary device  
8. Backup device  
9. Primary device  
10. Backup device  
2.3.6 Routing Destination Communication  
Failures  
When the R# Primary Device fails to connect to the  
central station receiver after two attempts by phone,  
the R# Backup Device phone number will be dialed.  
The central station will receive the original event with  
a COMM TROUBLE PHONE # = (1, 2, 3, or 4)  
message  
added. This event does not occur if there is no  
backup phone number. If the R# Primary Device is  
an SDI Path, the central station receives the original  
event with a COMM TROUBLE RG8 SDI## event  
modifier. Refer to Table 8 on page 18.  
When only one destination is programmed, the control  
panel makes ten attempts to contact that destination.  
When reporting via phone, each group takes  
approximately 10 min to go into Comm Fail.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 19  
There are four Route Groups which contain a  
Keypad Programming of R# Primary Device  
D1255  
1. Refer to Figure 1 on page 7 to access Keypad  
Programming and navigate to the  
selection of event categorizes and individual events.  
Each group has a primary and a backup device. The  
primary device is the first (most important) destination  
used to reach the programmed route within this  
group. The backup device is used if the primary  
device fails.  
ROUTE GRP 1 - 4 option.  
2. At the ROUTE GRP 1 - 4 prompt, enter the route  
group number you wish to configure and press  
[ENT]. The keypad reads RT GRP 1 PRIMARY,  
and then the current configuration (for example,  
SDI 88 PATH 4).  
R# Primary Device  
Default:  
No Device  
3. To change the configuration, press [ENT] when  
the current configuration shows, and then press  
[NEXT] or [PREV] to scroll through the options, as  
listed in R# Primary Device on page 19.  
4. When the keypad reads the desired configuration  
option, press [ENT] to select it.  
Selection:  
No Device, Phone 1..4, SDI ##  
Path 1..4  
Phone 1  
Phone 2  
Phone 3  
Phone 4  
Phone 1 is this group’s primary  
destination.  
Phone 2 is this group’s primary  
destination.  
When the keypad reads PARAMETER SAVED,  
your selection has been configured.  
Phone 3 is this group’s primary  
destination.  
D1260  
1. Refer to Figure 2 on page 8 to access Keypad  
Programming and navigate to the  
Phone 4 is this group’s primary  
destination.  
Route Group 1 - 4 option.  
2. At the Route Group 1 - 4 prompt, enter the route  
group number you wish to configure and press  
[ENTER]. The keypad reads Rt Group 1 Primary,  
and then the current configuration (for example,  
SDI 88 PATH 4).  
SDI 88 Path 1 Path 1 on SDI 88 is this group's  
primary destination.  
SDI 88 Path 2 Path 2 on SDI 88 is this group's  
primary destination.  
3. To change the configuration, press the Edit  
softkey, and then press the Next or the Previous  
softkey to scroll through the options, as listed in  
R# Primary Device on page 19.  
4. When the keypad reads the desired configuration  
option, press the Save softkey to select it.  
SDI 88 Path 3 Path 3 on SDI 88 is this group's  
primary destination.  
SDI 88 Path 4 Path 4 on SDI 88 is this group's  
primary destination.  
SDI 92 Path 1 Path 1 on SDI 92 is this group's  
primary destination.  
When the keypad reads Parameter Saved, your  
selection has been configured.  
SDI 92 Path 2 Path 2 on SDI 92 is this group's  
primary destination.  
SDI 92 Path 3 Path 3 on SDI 92 is this group's  
primary destination.  
SDI 92 Path 4 Path 4 on SDI 92 is this group's  
primary destination.  
To meet UL 864 requirements for  
Central Station and Remote Station  
applications, program a Primary  
Device.  
Select the communication device and the primary  
destination.  
Refer to Section 5.5  
Programming Path Numbers  
and IP Addresses for Enhanced Communications on  
page on page 131 to enable enhanced  
communication paths.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 20  
Refer to Section 5.5 Programming Path Numbers  
R# Backup Device  
and IP Addresses for Enhanced Communications on  
page on page 131 to enable enhanced communication  
paths.  
Default:  
No Device  
Selection:  
No Device, Phone 1..4, SDI ##  
Path 1..4  
Keypad Programming of R# Backup Device  
Phone 1  
Phone 1 is this group’s backup  
destination if the primary  
destination fails.  
D1255  
1. Refer to Figure 1 on page 7 to access Keypad  
Programming and navigate to the  
ROUTE GRP 1 - 4 option.  
Phone 2  
Phone 2 is this group’s backup  
destination if the primary  
destination fails.  
2. At the ROUTE GRP 1 - 4 prompt, enter the route  
group number you wish to configure and press  
[ENT]. The keypad reads RT GRP 1 PRIMARY,  
and then the current configuration (for example,  
SDI 88 PATH 4).  
3. Press [NEXT] to advance to the RT GRP 1  
BACKUP option. The Primary device cannot be  
set to No Device before setting the Backup  
Destination.  
Phone 3  
Phone 3 is this group’s backup  
destination if the primary  
destination fails.  
Phone 4  
Phone 4 is this group’s backup  
destination if the primary  
destination fails.  
4. To change the configuration, press [ENT] when  
the current configuration shows, and then press  
[NEXT] or [PREV] to scroll through the options, as  
listed in R# Backup Device on page 20.  
5. When the keypad reads the desired configuration  
option, press [ENT] to select it.  
SDI 88 Path 1  
SDI 88 Path 2  
SDI 88 Path 3  
SDI 88 Path 4  
SDI 92 Path 1  
SDI 92 Path 2  
SDI 92 Path 3  
SDI 92 Path 4  
Path 1 on SDI 88 is this group's  
backup destination if the primary  
destination fails.  
Path 2 on SDI 88 is this group's  
backup destination if the primary  
destination fails.  
When the keypad reads Parameter Saved, your  
selection has been configured.  
Path 3 on SDI 88 is this group's  
backup destination if the primary  
destination fails.  
D1260  
1. Refer to Figure 2 on page 8 to access Keypad  
Programming and navigate to the  
Path 4 on SDI 88 is this group's  
backup destination if the primary  
destination fails.  
Route Group 1 - 4 option.  
2. At the Route Group 1 - 4 prompt, enter the route  
group number you wish to configure and press  
[ENTER]. The keypad reads Rt Group 1 Primary,  
and then the current configuration (for example,  
SDI 88 PATH 4).  
3. Press the Backup softkey. The keypad reads Rt  
Group 1 Primary, and then the current  
configuration (for example, SDI 88 PATH 4). The  
Primary device cannot be set to No Device before  
setting the Backup Destination.  
4. To change the configuration, press the Edit  
softkey, and then press the Next or the Previous  
softkey to scroll through the options, as listed in  
R# Backup Device on page 20.  
5. When the keypad reads the desired configuration  
option, press the Save softkey to select it.  
Path 1 on SDI 92 is this group's  
backup destination if the primary  
destination fails.  
Path 2 on SDI 92 is this group's  
backup destination if the primary  
destination fails.  
Path 3 on SDI 92 is this group's  
backup destination if the primary  
destination fails.  
Path 4 on SDI 92 is this group's  
backup destination if the primary  
destination fails.  
When the keypad reads Parameter Saved, your  
selection has been configured.  
To meet UL 864 requirements for  
Central Station and Remote Station  
applications, program a Backup  
Device.  
Select the communication device and the backup  
destination. The backup device is used when the  
primary device fails to reach the programmed  
destination.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 21  
2.3.9 Route Group Categories  
Select Yes to send a report when the event occurs.  
Refer to Table 10 on page 21.  
To meet UL 864 requirements for  
Central Station and Remote Station  
applications, enable Fire Reports.  
Table 10: Burglar Reports  
Report  
Selections Report Description  
Selecting Yes enables a report to be sent when the  
event occurs.  
R# Alarm  
R# Burg  
Restore  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Burglar Alarm Event  
Non-fire restoral from  
trouble, missing, or  
supervisory  
Table 9: Fire Reports  
R# Duress  
R# Missing  
Alarm  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Duress  
Missing Alarm point  
Report  
Selections  
Report  
Description  
Fire Event  
R# Fire Alarm Yes, No  
R# Usr Code  
Tmpr  
R# Trouble  
Report  
R# Missing  
Trbl  
R# Non Fire  
Suprv  
R# Pt Bus  
Fail  
R# Pt Bus  
Rstl  
R# Non Fire  
Cncl  
R# Alarm  
Restore  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
User code tamper  
Trouble Event  
R# Fire  
Restore  
(Alarm)  
R# Fire  
Missing  
R# Fire  
Trouble  
R# Fire  
Yes, No  
Fire restoral from  
alarm  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Missing Fire point  
Fire trouble  
Missing Trouble  
Event  
Non-fire Supervision  
Event  
Fire supervision  
Point bus failure  
Supervis  
R# Fire  
Restore  
(T/M/S)  
R# Fire  
Cancel  
R# Fire Sup  
Miss  
R# Fire Supv  
Rest  
Fire restoral from  
trouble, missing, or  
bypass  
Restoral of point bus  
after failure  
Canceled non-fire  
alarm  
Non-fire restoral from  
alarm  
Supervisory missing  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Canceled fire alarm  
Fire supervisory  
missing  
Restorals from Fire  
Supervision  
R# Sup  
Missing  
R# Unverified  
Evt  
Unverified Events for  
Cross Points  
R# Unverified Evt is sent when a single  
point programmed in Cross Point Group  
faults into an alarm condition, then  
restores before the Cross Point Time  
elapses.  
R# Unverified Evt encompasses both  
Fire and Non-fire points, but is not related  
to the A# Verify Time used for smoke  
detectors.  
The GV3 Series control panels log a  
Ground Fault Event as Trouble Point 256.  
Restoral Reports are not sent if the  
control panel resets after a point is  
bypassed and then unbypassed. This is  
true for both Fire and Non-fire points.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 22  
To meet UL 864 requirements for  
Central Station and Remote Station  
applications, enable Test Reports.  
Selecting Yes enables a report to be sent when the  
event occurs.  
Table 11: User Reports  
Sending Test Reports  
Automatic: To send a single Test Report (R# Test  
Report) automatically, enable Sked Function Code #9  
(Test Report) in the Skeds section of the program.  
Refer to Table 12.  
Report  
Selections  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Report  
Description  
Point Bypass Event  
Forced Point Event  
R# Point  
Bypass  
R# Forced  
Point  
R# Point  
Open  
R# Point  
Close  
R# Forced  
Arm  
R# Fail To  
Open  
R# Fail To  
Close  
R# Ext Clos  
Tm  
R# Opening  
Report  
R# Forced  
Close  
R# Closing  
Report  
R# FC  
Manual: To send a single Test Report manually, enter  
[COMMAND][4][1] at the keypad. Refer to the Send  
Report prompt on page 62.  
Point Opening  
Event  
To expand this Test Report to include any off-normal  
point condition or other off-normal system conditions,  
Expand Test Report (refer to page 14) must be  
programmed Yes. Refer to the footnotes with Table 13  
on page 24 for a list of event types that are included in  
an expanded test report. Additionally, the expanded  
test report includes Summary Fire Supervisory,  
Summary Fire Fault, Summary Controlled Point Fault,  
and Summary Point Device Fault conditions.  
Point Closing Event  
Point Force Armed  
Fail to Open Event  
Fail to Close Event  
The control panel can generate an Expanded Off-  
Normal Test Report by using Sked Function Code 28  
or a Non-Expanded Off-Normal Test Report using  
Sked Function Code 29. To generate this event, one  
or more points must be in an off-normal state at the  
time the Sked executes. Expanded Off-Normal Test  
Reports include the Off Normal Test Report Event as  
well as a panel-wide summary of off-normal point and  
system conditions. Non-Expanded Off-Normal Test  
Report Events are sent only when a point is in the off-  
normal state but sends only the Off-Normal Test  
Report Event.  
Extend Close Time  
Event  
Opening Events  
Point Forced Close  
Event  
Closing Events  
Forced Close  
Perimeter Instant  
Armed Event  
Forced Close  
Perimeter Delay  
Armed Event  
Perimeter Instant  
Armed Event  
Perimeter Delay  
Armed Event  
Perimeter Inst  
Sending Status Reports  
R# FC  
Perimeter  
Delay  
R# Perimeter  
Inst Arm  
R# Perimeter  
Delay Arm  
Yes, No  
Automatic: To send a Status Report automatically  
that includes the events shown in the footnotes in  
Table 12, enable Sked Function Code #10 in the  
Skeds section of the program.  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Manual: To send a Status Report manually that  
includes the events shown in the footnotes in Table  
12, enter [COMMAND][4][2] at the keypad. Refer to  
the Send Report prompt on page 62.  
R# Send User Yes, No  
Text  
User text  
Sending off-normal conditions as a Status Report  
following a Test Report is required by some  
automation systems. Sending off-normal conditions as  
a Non-status Report that follows a Test Report is  
required for other automation systems.  
An off-normal condition is any point that is missing,  
trouble, supervisory, or in alarm. Also, points not  
cleared at the keypad report as off-normal.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 23  
Table 12: Test Reports  
Selecting Yes enables sending a report when the  
event occurs. If the off-normal state of the events  
indicated by footnote 1 in Table 13 on page 24 still  
exists, the events report when a Test Report is  
enabled and Expanded Test Report is programmed  
Yes. Refer to the Test Reports sub-prompt in Section  
2.3.8 Communication Attempts on page 18.  
Report  
Selections Report  
Description  
R# S: Alarm1  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Status Alarm  
Status Trouble  
Status Supervised  
R# S: Trouble1  
R# S:  
Supervised2  
R# Status  
Report  
Yes, No  
Status  
R# S: Open1  
R# S: Close1  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
R# Test Report Yes, No  
Status Open  
Status Close  
Test  
R# S:  
Yes, No  
Status Perimeter  
Instant Arm  
Perimeter Inst1  
R# S:  
Yes, No  
Status Perimeter  
Delay Arm  
Perimeter  
Delay1  
R# S: Fire  
Supv2  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Status Fire  
Supervision  
Status Fire Alarm  
Report  
Status Fire  
Trouble  
R# S: Fire  
Alarm3  
R# S: Fire Trbl2 Yes, No  
R# S: Msng  
Fire2  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Status Fire  
Missing  
Status Burg  
Missing Trouble  
Status Burg  
R# S:  
MsngBurgTr2  
R# S:  
MsngBurgAl2  
Missing Alarm  
R# S:  
Status Fire  
Supervision  
Missing  
FireSpMsng2  
R# S:  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Status Non-fire  
Supervision  
Missing  
Status Door Left  
Open  
SuperMsng2  
R# S:  
DrLeftOpen2  
1
Information about this condition is sent with a Status  
Report.  
2
3
Information about this condition is sent as S: Trouble  
Event with a Status Report.  
Information about this condition is sent as S: Alarm  
Event with a Status Report.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 24  
Table 13: Diagnostic Reports (Continued)  
Table 13: Diagnostic Reports  
Report  
Selections Report  
Description  
Yes, No  
Restoral of  
Report  
Selections Report  
Description  
R# SDI Dev Fail1  
R# SDI Dev Restl  
R# Rt Comm Rstl  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
SDI device  
failure  
communication  
to specific  
route after a  
failure  
Checksum Fail  
Event  
Restoral of SDI  
device failure  
R# Watchdog  
Rset  
Watchdog  
Reset Event  
R# Checksum Fail Yes, No  
R#  
Parameter  
checksum  
failure  
R# Network Fail4  
Yes, No  
Failure of  
network  
ParaChksmFail  
R# Network Rest4  
Yes, No  
Restoral of  
network  
R# Reboot  
R# Ph Line Fail1  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Reboot Event  
Failure of phone  
line  
R# Network Cond4  
Yes, No  
Condition of  
network  
1
R# Ph Line Rstl  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Restoral of  
phone line after  
failure  
This event is included in the Expanded Test Report  
when an off-normal condition exists.  
2
To meet UL 864 requirements for Central Station and  
Remote Station applications, enable AC Fail, Battery  
Missing, Low Battery, Battery Restoral, and AC  
Restoral reports.  
R# AC Fail1, 2  
Failure of AC  
power to control  
panel  
R# AC Restorl 2  
Restoral of AC  
power to control  
panel after  
3
4
This event covers Comm Fail Route Group and Comm  
Fail Phone. If enabled, both events are sent; if  
disabled, neither event is sent.  
failure  
This event is reserved for future use.  
R# Batt Missing1, 2  
Yes, No  
Battery Missing  
Detection Event  
Enable Rt Comm Fail and Rt Comm  
Restore in only one route group.  
R# Battery Low1, 2  
R# Battery Rstl 2  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Low battery  
power  
Restoral of  
battery power to  
control panel  
after Missing or  
Low Event  
Selecting Yes enables sending a report when the  
event occurs.  
Table 14: Relay Reports  
R# Rt Comm Fail1,  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Failure to send  
report to  
specific route  
3
Report  
Selections  
Report  
R# Rt Comm Rstl  
Restoral of  
Description  
Sensor Reset  
Event  
communication  
to specific route  
after a failure  
R# Sensor  
Reset  
Yes, No  
R# Relay Set Yes, No  
Relay Set Event  
R# Relay  
Reset  
Yes, No  
Relay Reset Event  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 25  
Table 16: RPS Reports  
When activating an on-board relay using  
remote automation software, the  
D9412GV3 and D7412GV3 Control  
Panels log and print the resulting event  
as:  
Report  
R# Log  
Threshold  
R# Log  
Overflow  
R# Para  
Changed  
R# RPS OK Yes, No  
R# RPS Fail Yes, No  
Selections  
Yes, No  
Report Description  
Event log threshold  
reached  
Log is full, old events  
are overwritten  
RPS Parameter  
Change Event  
Successful RPS  
Access Event  
Failed Access RPS  
Event  
Relay 250 (Relay A)  
Relay 251 (Relay B)  
Relay 252 (Relay C)  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
The following prompts support customized routing of  
Auto Function Reports. Selecting Yes enables a  
report to be sent when the event occurs.  
R# Remote  
Reset  
Yes, No  
Remote Reset Event  
Table 15: Auto-Function Reports  
R# Program Yes, No  
OK  
Successful Local  
Programming Event  
Report  
Selections  
Report Description  
R# Sked  
Executed  
Yes, No  
Sked Executed  
Event  
R# Program Yes, No  
Fail  
Failed Local  
Programming Event  
R# Sked  
Changed  
R# Execute  
Fail  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Sked Changed  
Event  
Fail to Execute  
Event  
Selecting Yes enables sending a report when the  
RPS Passcode Event occurs.  
"RPS Access Fail" might indicate a  
wrong RPS passcode when  
communicating with the control panel,  
or a valid RPS session was abnormally  
terminated. "Remote Reset" indicates a  
Reset command was issued from RPS.  
"Fail to Call RPS" indicates that control  
panel called RPS, but was unable to  
connect.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 26  
Point Reports  
Selecting Yes enables a report to be sent when the  
event occurs.  
Selecting Yes enables a report to be sent when the  
event occurs.  
Table 18: User Change Reports  
Table 17: Point Reports  
Report  
Selections Report  
Description  
Report  
Selections Report  
Description  
R# Date  
Changed  
R# Time  
Changed  
R# Delete  
User1  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Date Change Event  
R# Service Start  
Yes, No  
Reorts Service  
Walk Test Start  
Event  
Service Walk  
Test End Event  
Fire Walk Start  
Event  
Fire Walk End  
Event  
Walk Test Start  
Event for Walk  
Test and  
Invisible Walk  
Test  
Time Change Event  
R# Service End  
R# Fire Walk St  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Delete User Code  
Event  
R# User Code Yes, No  
User Passcode Add  
or Change Event  
Start and end of  
area watch  
Card Assigned to  
User Event  
Access Control  
Level Change  
Event  
R# Fire Walk End Yes, No  
R# Walk Test St Yes, No  
Chg  
R# Area  
Watch  
R# Card  
Assigned  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
R# Change  
Level  
R# Walk Test End Yes, No  
Walk Test End  
Event for Walk  
Test and  
Invisible Walk  
Test  
1 With R# Delete User Events, the control panel  
always uses the account number from Area 1.  
R# Extra Point  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Extra Point  
Event  
Point Text  
R# Send Point  
Text1  
R# RF Low Bat  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Low battery  
conditions for  
RF points  
Low battery  
restoral  
R# RF Low Bat  
Res  
conditions for  
RF points  
1 Point text is always transmitted when using  
network applications.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 27  
Table 20:Event Descriptions, Priorities, and  
Numbers  
Selecting Yes enables a report to be sent when the  
event occurs.  
Event  
Priority  
Event  
Number  
Access Granted, No Entry, Request to  
Enter (RTE) and Request to Exit (REX)  
Events can be enabled or disabled by  
each D9210B.  
Event Description  
Fire Alarm  
001  
005  
005  
005  
005  
005  
011  
Fire Alarm Restoral  
Fire Missing  
014  
013  
Fire Trouble  
012  
Table 19: Access Reports  
Fire Supervision  
124  
Fire Restoral (after Tbl, Msg,  
Bypass)  
015  
Report  
Selections Report Description  
Fire Cancel  
004  
005  
005  
003  
002  
006  
008  
006  
008  
006  
006  
006  
004  
006  
008  
006  
007  
007  
008  
008  
007  
008  
008  
008  
008  
007  
008  
027  
146  
123  
016  
004  
019  
055  
017  
020  
078  
024  
091  
045  
026  
147  
169  
007  
008  
021  
022  
034  
040  
041  
044  
047  
048  
050  
R# Access  
Granted  
Yes, No  
Access Granted  
Event  
No Entry Event  
Door Left Open  
Event  
Open Door Event  
Unlock Door Event  
Secure Door Event  
RTE or REX Event  
Locked Door Event  
Fire Supervision Missing  
Fire Supervision Restore  
Alarm Report  
R# No Entry Yes, No  
Duress  
R# Door Lt  
Open  
R# Cycle  
Door  
R# Door  
Unlocked  
R# Door  
Secure  
R# Door  
Request  
R# Door  
Locked  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Missing Alarm  
User Code Tamper  
Trouble Report  
Missing Trouble  
Non-Fire Supervision  
Point Bus Fail  
Point Bus Restoral  
Non-Fire Cancel  
Alarm Restore  
Supervision Missing  
Unverified Event  
Point Bypass/Command Bypass  
Forced Point  
Point Opening  
Point Closing  
2.3.10 Event Priority  
Was Force Armed  
Fail To Open  
Table 20 on page 27 shows the description of each  
event, its priority, and event number.  
Fail To Close  
Extend Close Time  
Opening Report  
Forced Close  
Closing Report  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 28  
Table 20: Event Descriptions, Priorities, and  
Numbers (Continued)  
Table 20: Event Descriptions, Priorities, and  
Numbers (Continued)  
Event  
Priority  
Event  
Number  
Event  
Event  
Number  
Event Description  
Forced Close Perimeter Instant  
Forced Close Perimeter Delay  
Perimeter Instant Armed  
Perimeter Delay Armed  
Send User Text  
Event Description  
Parameters Changed  
RPS Access OK  
RPS Access Fail  
Remote Reset  
Program Access OK  
Program Access Fail  
Service Start  
Priority  
008  
008  
008  
008  
n/a  
007  
007  
008  
008  
n/a  
084  
085  
088  
089  
n/a  
054  
064  
065  
079  
n/a  
S: Alarm  
n/a  
n/a  
n/a  
n/a  
S: Trouble  
n/a  
n/a  
008  
008  
008  
008  
008  
008  
008  
n/a  
029  
030  
036  
037  
038  
039  
023  
n/a  
S: Supervision  
n/a  
n/a  
Service End  
Status Report  
008  
n/a  
035  
n/a  
Fire Walk Start  
Fire Walk End  
S: Open  
S: Close  
n/a  
n/a  
Walk Test Start  
Walk Test End  
Extra Point  
Test Report  
008  
n/a  
051  
n/a  
S: Perimeter Instant  
S: Perimeter Delay  
S: Fire Supervision  
S: Fire Alarm  
n/a  
n/a  
Send Point Text  
RF Low Battery  
RF Battery Restore  
Date Changed  
Time Changed  
Delete User  
n/a  
n/a  
006  
006  
008  
008  
008  
008  
008  
008  
007  
008  
008  
008  
008  
008  
008  
008  
008  
002  
002  
093  
094  
059  
060  
090  
056  
042  
110  
061  
003  
115  
116  
112  
113  
114  
117  
145  
005  
006  
n/a  
n/a  
S: Fire Trouble  
n/a  
n/a  
S: Missing Fire (Trouble)  
S: Missing Burglary ((Trouble)  
S: Missing Burglary (Alarm)  
S: Fire Supervision Missing  
S: Burglary Supervision Missing  
S: Door Left Open  
SDI Device Failure*  
SDI Device Restoral*  
Watchdog Reset  
Parameter Checksum Fail  
Reboot  
n/a  
n/a  
n/a  
n/a  
n/a  
n/a  
User Code Change  
Area Watch  
n/a  
n/a  
n/a  
n/a  
Card Assigned  
Change Level  
n/a  
n/a  
004  
008  
004  
n/a  
070  
071  
077  
n/a  
Access Granted  
No Entry  
Door Left Open  
Cycle Door  
008  
004  
008  
004  
008  
004  
004  
008  
004  
008  
n/a  
082  
068  
069  
072  
073  
074  
075  
076  
066  
067  
n/a  
Door Unlocked  
Door Secure  
Phone Line Fail  
Phone Line Restoral  
AC Failure  
Door Request  
Door Locked  
AC Restoral  
User Alarm COMMAND 7  
User Alarm COMMAND 9  
Battery Missing  
Battery Low  
Battery Restoral  
Route Comm Fail  
Route Comm Restore  
Checksum Fail  
Sensor Reset  
007  
007  
007  
007  
007  
008  
008  
008  
031  
032  
033  
057  
058  
151  
052  
053  
Relay Set  
Relay Reset  
Sked Executed  
Sked Changed  
Fail to Execute  
Event Log Threshold  
Event Log Overflow  
0
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 29  
For the following items to be true, AC  
2.4  
Power Supervision  
Fail/Restoral Report must be  
programmed as Yes and AC Tag Along  
must be programmed as No.  
AC Fail Time  
Default:  
1:00  
0:01 to 90:00  
Selection:  
To eliminate AC Reporting, AC Tag  
Along and AC Fail/Restoral Report  
must be programmed as No.  
Program the amount of time that AC power must be  
off before the control panel responds to the AC  
failure. The response to restoral of AC power is  
delayed for the same amount of time. The control  
panel always monitors AC. The response to this  
prompt is the actuation of the relay programmed in  
the Panel-Wide Relays prompt AC Failure (refer to  
Section 2.12.2 Panel-Wide Relays on page 81) and  
the AC Fail report enabled by the AC Fail/Restoral  
Report prompt. Local annunciation of an AC failure is  
controlled by the AC Fail Display prompt.  
AC Fail Display  
Default:  
60 sec  
Selection:  
10 to 300 sec (in 5-sec  
increments)  
Program the length of time the AC power must be off  
before the message SERVC AC FAIL shows on the  
keypads. The response to restoral of AC power is  
delayed for the same amount of time.  
UL 864 requirements, Section 50.2.1.b  
states: “A trouble signal shall be  
transmitted for remote station, central  
station, and proprietary-type protected  
premises units after a delay of between  
60 and 180 min.  
AC Fail/Restoral Report  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Exception: Products are not prohibited  
from providing capability of selecting  
that the primary power failure trouble  
signal transmission be delayed other  
time periods, including no delay,  
provided the 60 – 180 min delay is also  
included.”  
Yes  
Send AC Fail and AC Restoral  
Reports.  
No  
Does not send AC Fail and AC  
Restoral Reports.  
AC Power Supervision Reports are sent to the central  
station and local printer at the time programmed for  
AC Fail Time.  
To meet UL 864 requirements, program  
AC Fail Time with 1:00. Always check  
with the Authority Having Jurisdiction for  
local requirements.  
AC Tag Along  
Default:  
Yes  
Resend AC Fail  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Default:  
No Response  
Yes  
Send AC messages as tag along  
events.  
Selection:  
No Response, 6 hrs, 12 Hrs  
No  
Response  
Only send the AC Fail report upon  
failure.  
No  
Do not send AC messages as tag  
along events.  
6 hr  
Send AC Fail report upon failure and  
every 6 hours after this while the  
failure persists.  
Send AC Reports only if any other event occurs while  
AC is off-normal.  
If AC Tag Along is set to Yes and a  
subsequent event is generated, the AC  
Fail Event is sent first, before sending  
any subsequent events.  
12 hr  
Send AC Fail report upon failure and  
every 12 hours after this while the  
failure persists.  
This prompt controls the repeated transmission of the  
AC Failure report to the central station while the fault  
persists. AC Fail/Restoral Report must be set to  
Yes, and AC Tag Along must be set to No for this  
feature to work.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 30  
2.5  
Printer Parameters  
AC Tag Along is required for NFPA  
and UL 864 Commercial Fire systems.  
Be sure to program AC Fail/Restoral  
Report as No if AC Tag Along is  
programmed Yes.  
Up to three D9131A Parallel Printer Interface Modules  
can be connected to the D9412GV3’s (one printer for  
the D7412GV3’s) SDI bus. Each printer is identified by  
an address of 17, 18, or 19. Options are available for  
Routing Reports and area assignments.  
AC/Battery Buzz  
Printer Address  
Default:  
No  
Default:  
17  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Selection:  
17, 18, or 19 (only 17 is available  
for the D7412GV3)  
Yes  
Initiates panel-wide trouble tone at  
all keypads.  
Enter the printer address you are programming.  
No  
Does not initiate panel-wide trouble  
tone at keypads  
P## Area Assign  
Initiates a panel-wide trouble tone at keypads when  
AC fails or battery is low or missing. This program  
item does not prevent the SERVC AC FAIL or  
SERVC BATT LOW displays.  
Default:  
1
Selection:  
1 to 32 for D9412GV3  
1 to 8 for D7412GV3  
To comply with NFPA standards and  
UL 864 requirements for Commercial Fire  
systems, program this item as Yes.  
Assign an area to the printer programmed in Printer  
Address.  
P## Supervised  
If annunciating panel-wide troubles at a  
keypad with CC# Scope set to Panel  
Wide is undesirable, set CC# Trouble  
Tone to No. Refer to Section 2.9 Keypad  
(Command Center) on page 50 for  
keypad configurations.  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes  
Only one printer can be installed for  
this P## SDI address.  
No  
More than one unsupervised printer  
can be installed using this P## SDI  
address and the same address DIP  
switch setting.  
Bat Fail/Restoral Report  
Default:  
Yes  
Supervise this SDI address. Generate Trouble SDI ##  
Reports and local trouble annunciation if a problem  
occurs with this printer or the SDI bus.  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes Battery Failure and Restoral Reports are  
sent to the central station.  
Unsupervised printers sharing the same  
address setting print the same text.  
BATTERY  
MISSING  
Modem  
Reports shorted  
Missing or  
Trouble SDI ## Reports are always  
reported as Area 1, Account 1 Events  
regardless of where the SDI device is  
assigned.  
BATTERY LOW  
Discharged  
below 12.1  
VDC  
No  
Battery Failure and Restoral Reports are not  
sent to the central station.  
When P## Supervised is set to Yes and  
all Printer Event Groups (such as P##  
Fire Events, P## Burglar Event, or P##  
Usr Chng Evt) are set to No, the control  
panel does not generate Trouble SDI ##  
Reports for the printer if the D9131A  
becomes disconnected.  
To comply with NFPA standards and  
UL 864 requirements for Commercial Fire  
systems, program this item as Yes.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 31  
P## Scope  
P## Fire Events  
Default:  
No Printer  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection:  
Selection:  
No Printer, Area, Account, Panel  
Wide, Custom  
Yes or No  
Yes  
All events in this group print at  
assigned printer.  
Panel  
Wide  
Printer prints all designated events  
that occur panel-wide. A panel-wide  
printer can cross account boundaries.  
No  
No events in this group print at  
assigned printer.  
Account  
Printer prints all designated events  
that occur within any area with the  
same account number in which this  
printer is assigned.  
Use this prompt to determine whether these events  
print at assigned printer.  
P## Burglar Event  
Area  
Printer prints all designated events  
that occur in the area to which this  
printer is assigned.  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Yes or No  
Selection:  
Custom  
Printer prints all events occurring in  
areas programmed Yes for this  
prompt regardless of any boundary  
restrictions.  
P## Access Event  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Yes or No  
Selection:  
No Printer No printer installed at this address. If  
a printer is connected, data does not  
print.  
P## User Event  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Yes or No  
Selection:  
Default:  
No  
P## Test Event  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Yes or No  
Yes  
Include Area # Events in the scope of  
this printer.  
Selection:  
No  
Does not include Area # Events in  
the scope of this printer.  
P## Diag Event  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Yes or No  
Only available if P## Scope is programmed Custom.  
This program item determines if events occurring in  
an area print at this printer.  
Selection:  
Refer to the report tables in Section 2.3  
Routing on page 17 to identify the events  
that print. Events programmed as No in  
Routing still print at the local printer.  
Individual events within the report group  
cannot be suppressed for events printed  
at the local printer.  
P## Auto Functions Event  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Yes or No  
Selection:  
P## RPS Event  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Yes or No  
Selection:  
P## Relay Event  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Yes or No  
Selection:  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 32  
2.6.2 Log Threshold Reports  
When the event log reaches the percentage  
P## Point Event  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Yes or No  
configured in Log % Full and the control panel is  
properly configured, it will contact Unattended RPS  
over phone or network.  
Selection:  
If communication with RPS is unsuccessful, or if not  
properly configured, the control panel generates Log  
Threshold and Fail to Call RPS events.  
P## Usr Chng Evt  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Yes or No  
Fail to Call RPS Events are logged only locally. If  
properly configured, the control panel makes multiple  
attempts to reach RPS before sending the reports. To  
enable transmission of the events when the Log  
Threshold is reached, set a valid phone number in  
RPS Ph (refer to RPS Phone # on page 35)or set a  
valid IP address in RPS IP (refer to RPS IP Address #  
on page 130).  
Selection:  
2.6  
RPS Parameters  
Use these program items to enable remote  
programming software (RPS) functions in the control  
panel using the on-board phone connection or a  
Network Interface Module. Refer to Section 5.4 SDI  
RPS Parameters on page 126 for more information  
on these types of remote programming.  
2.6.3 Panel Initiated Unattended RPS  
2.6.1 Uploading and Downloading Reports  
The control panel will automatically contact  
Unattended RPS when the Log Threshold is reached  
or when the Contact RPS Sked function is executed.  
When the control panel is attempting to contact  
Unattended RPS, it will start with two attempts. If the  
control panel does not reach RPS on the first two  
attempts, it waits 10 min then tries six more times with  
a 10-min interval between each attempt. One hour  
after the last failed attempt, the control panel starts  
contacting Unattended RPS again. It makes two more  
attempts then waits 10 min and tries six more times  
with 10-min intervals between each attempt before  
generating a Fail to Call RPS Report and abandoning  
the effort.  
If the control panel is programmed to send reports in  
ModemIIIa2 reporting format, when RPS contacts the  
control panel and the passcode is incorrect, the  
control panel sends an RPS Access Fail Report to  
the central station receiver. RPS Access Fail might  
indicate a wrong RPS passcode when  
communicating with the control panel, or a valid RPS  
session was abnormally terminated.  
RPS ACCESS OK is sent according to phone routing  
when a Disconnect command is entered from RPS to  
terminate the call.  
When a Reset Panel is used to terminate the call, a  
Remote Reset Report is sent to the central station  
receiver, and an RPS ACCESS OK is placed into the  
control panel’s event log. Reports in the event log  
that were not sent before the Reset Panel are never  
sent to the central station receiver.  
If network RPS is configured, then any control panel  
initiated attempt to contact Unattended RPS will be  
over network. If network RPS is not configured, then  
contact will be attempted over the phone.  
Manually Initiated Unattended RPS: If properly  
configured, an authorized user can initiate contact with  
Unattended RPS by entering [COMMAND][4][3] and  
advancing the menu until RPS via Phoneor RPS  
via Networkshows. After proceeding through one  
of these options, the control panel makes one attempt  
to contact Unattended RPS.  
When RPS programming changes parameters, a  
Parameters Changed Report is sent to the central  
station receiver. If any programming changes are  
made, perform a Reset-bye.  
When RPS contacts the control panel, the RPS  
passcode and DataLock code are verified. If the  
control panel’s passcode matches and the DataLock  
code does not, the control panel still generates a  
RPS Access OK Event; however, the session ends  
immediately.  
RPS Passcode  
Default:  
999999  
To prevent the control panel from answering the  
telephone automatically, enter 0 in the Answer  
Armed and Answer Disarmed prompts in this  
section.  
Selection:  
0 to 9, A to F  
(six characters required)  
Enter six characters. Do not use a space in the  
passcode.  
The control panel verifies the remote programming  
software at the central station has valid access before  
connecting using the RPS passcode.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 33  
The control panel continues to log events after the Log  
Threshold Report is sent. When the event log reaches  
100%, a Log Overflow event is generated and the  
oldest events are overwritten.  
Keypad Programming of RPS Passcode  
D1255  
1. Refer to Figure 1 on page 7 to access Keypad  
Programming and navigate to the RPS  
PASSCODE option. The keypad shows the  
currently configured passcode.  
2. Press [ENT] to change the passcode. An invisible  
editing cursor is enabled.  
The control panel does not call RPS again until it  
downloads the log and the Log % Full percentage is  
reached. These events are also sent to the control  
panel’s event log and to the local printer(s) if installed.  
3. The [PREV] button acts as a [Backspace] key.  
The [COMMAND] key allows you to cycle though  
the special passcode characters (A, B, C, D, E,  
F); the [NEXT] key selects the passcode  
character. Press [PREV] to delete the characters  
of the passcode, and then enter the passcode.  
4. Press [ENT] to save the passcode.  
The Log Overflow Event is not sent to  
the central station unless Expanded  
Test Report is programmed Yes.  
Failure to program the RPS telephone  
number and the RPS IP address number  
results in a FAIL TO CALL RPS trouble  
event sent to the central station when the  
log threshold is reached. Refer to the  
RPS Phone # prompt on page 35 for  
information about programming the RPS  
telephone number. Refer to the RPS IP  
Address # prompt on page 130 for  
information about enabling network RPS.  
When the keypad reads PARAMETER SAVED,  
your selection has been configured.  
D1260  
1. Refer to Figure 2 on page 8 to access Keypad  
Programming and navigate to the RPS  
Parameters option and press [ENTER]. The  
keypad shows the currently configured RPS  
Passcode.  
Contact RPS if Log % Full  
2. Press the Edit softkey to change the passcode.  
An editing cursor is enabled.  
Default:  
No  
3. Use the softkeys and the number buttons on the  
keypad to enter the new passcode. The  
Backspace softkey allows you to erase  
characters. The Clear softkey allows you to clear  
the entire passcode. When entering a letter  
character, press the letter’s softkey to select it.  
The Previous and Next softkeys advance  
through the letter characters (A, B, C, D, E, F).  
4. Press the Save softkey to save the passcode.  
When the keypad reads Parameter Saved, your  
selection has been configured.  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes  
Directs the control panel to  
automatically communicate with  
Unattended RPS over network or  
phone when Log Threshold is  
reached.  
No  
The control panel will not  
automatically contact RPS when Log  
Threshold is reached.  
When the event log reaches the percentage full  
indicated by Log % Full the Log Threshold event is  
put in the event log. If this prompt is set to Yes and  
either the RPS IP address or RPS Phone # are  
programmed, then the control panel will attempt to  
contact Unattended RPS as described in Section 2.6.3  
Panel Initiated Unattended RPS on page 32.  
Log % Full  
Default:  
0
Selection:  
0 to 99  
When the event log reaches the percentage full  
indicated in this prompt, the control panel logs a Log  
Threshold event. If Contact RPS if Log % Full is set  
to Yes, then the control panel will attempt to contact  
Unattended RPS and copy the event log before  
messages are overwritten.  
A setting of 0 disables the Log Threshold and Log  
Overflow Events. These events are not entered in the  
log or reported to the central station receiver or the  
local printer.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 34  
RPS Call Back  
Program this item No if it causes false  
seizures of the phone line or if you do  
not use RPS. This indicates that a  
device using the same frequency tone is  
also using the phone line to which the  
control panel is connected.  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes  
When the control panel hears the  
correct RPS passcode, it hangs up  
the phone, seizes the phone line,  
then dials the programmed RPS  
phone number (refer to the RPS Ph  
prompt on page 35). This ensures  
that the control panel only  
If RPS Call Back is programmed Yes,  
the control panel hangs up the phone  
after the RPS tone and a proper RPS  
passcode is identified. It then calls the  
RPS phone number.  
communicates with RPS units  
connected to the programmed phone  
number.  
Answer Armed  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
If the call is answered manually, the  
call back must be initiated manually.  
Selection:  
0 to 15  
0
No answer.  
No  
The RPS session starts immediately.  
No call back is required. The control  
panel can engage in RPS sessions  
when called from any phone number  
and a proper RPS passcode is  
identified.  
1 to 15  
The control panel answers the phone  
after the specified number of rings  
when all areas are master armed.  
Set the telephone ring counter to answer when all  
areas are master armed. If any area in the control  
panel is perimeter armed or disarmed, the Answer  
Disarmed ring counter is used.  
This function allows the control panel, after it verifies  
the RPS passcode, to provide an additional level of  
security by hanging up and dialing the RPS phone  
number at the central station before allowing any  
upload or download.  
For the purposes of answering the RPS  
phone call, the control panel considers  
Perimeter Armed a disarmed state..  
When using the RPS Call Back feature,  
be sure to program the character “C” as  
the last digit in the RPS phone number  
when using DTMF Dialing.  
Answer Disarmed  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection:  
0 to 15  
RPS Line Monitor  
0
No answer.  
Default:  
Yes  
1 to 15  
The control panel answers the  
phone after the specified number of  
rings when any area in the system is  
in a perimeter armed or disarmed  
state.  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes  
Allows the control panel to  
communicate with RPS after the  
answering machine answers the  
phone.  
Set telephone ring counter to answer when any area is  
in a perimeter armed or disarmed state.  
No  
Use No if the control panel does not  
share the phone line with an  
answering machine.  
For the purposes of answering the RPS  
phone call, the control panel considers  
Perimeter Armed a disarmed state.  
This program item enables a control panel that  
shares a phone line with an answering machine to  
communicate with RPS at the central station, even  
though the answering machine answers the phone.  
You must program Answer Armed or Answer  
Disarmed. The control panel must be in the correct  
armed state.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 35  
Keypad Programming of RPS PHONE #  
RPS Phone #  
D1255  
Default:  
Blank  
1. Refer to Figure 1 on page 7 to access Keypad  
Programming and navigate to the RPS  
PARAMETERS option. Press [ENT]. The keypad  
shows the RPS PASSCODE option and the  
currently configured passcode.  
Selection:  
Blank or up to 24 characters  
Blank  
Control panel does not dial a phone  
number for RPS.  
2. Press [NEXT] to advance to the RPS PHONE  
NUMBER option.  
1 to 24  
Enter up to 24 characters to define  
characters dialing characteristics.  
3. The keypad shows the currently configured phone  
number. Press [ENT] to edit the phone number.  
4. The [PREV] button acts as a [Backspace] key.  
Press [PREV] to delete the characters of the  
phone number, and then enter the new phone  
number.  
5. Press [ENT] to save the phone number.  
When the keypad reads PARAMETER SAVED,  
your selection has been configured.  
This is the phone number the control panel dials to  
contact RPS. Refer to Section 2.6.1 on page 32 for  
instructions on configuring special phone number  
digits to detect dial-tone detect and to pause dialing.  
The control panel dials this number when any of the  
following events occur:  
Log % Full threshold is achieved.  
If Log % Full is programmed with a  
value (1 to 99) and an RPS phone  
number or RPS IP address are  
programmed, the control panel attempts  
to communicate with Unattended RPS  
when the log threshold is reached.  
D1260  
1. Refer to Figure 2 on page 8 to access Keypad  
Programming and navigate to the RPS  
Parameters option. Press [ENTER]. The keypad  
shows the RPS Passcode and the currently  
configured passcode.  
2. Press Phone Number softkey.  
3. The keypad shows the currently configured phone  
number.  
The control panel is contacted by RPS and RPS  
Call Back is programmed Yes.  
The user enters COMMAND 43 and selects the  
call RPS option from the menu. On the D1255:  
4. Press the Edit softkey to change the phone  
number.  
1. Press [COMAND][4][3].  
2. Press [NEXT] until RPS via Phone? appears,  
then press [ENTER].  
5. The Pause and DT Detect (Dialtone Detect)  
softkeys enter special characters. The Backspace  
softkey allows you to erase characters. The Clear  
softkey allows you to clear the entire phone  
number. The [COMMAND] and [ENTER] keys  
allow you to enter an * or a #. Use the softkeys,  
the number buttons, and the [COMMAND] and  
[ENTER] keys on the keypad to enter the new  
phone number.  
The control panel tries to contact RPS  
only once using this method.  
Refer to Section 5.4 SDI RPS Parameters on page  
126 for other connection methods.  
6. Press [ENT] to save the phone number.  
When the keypad reads Parameter Saved, your  
selection has been configured.  
Refer to Phone # in Section 2.1 Phone  
on page 12 for descriptions of special  
programming values for the RPS Phone  
number.  
RPS Modem Speed  
Default:  
1200  
Selection:  
300, 1200, 2400  
Select the baud rate for RPS-to-control panel  
communication when using a PSTN connection.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 36  
2.7  
Miscellaneous  
Cancel Report  
Duress Type  
Default:  
No  
Default:  
0
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Selection:  
0, 1, 2, or 3  
Yes  
Send Cancel and Fire Cancel  
Reports according to routing.  
0
Do not send a duress event with any  
passcode.  
No  
Do not send Cancel and Fire Cancel  
Reports.  
1
Increase the last digit by 1 to generate an  
alarm. For example, if the passcode is 6123,  
6124 activates a duress alarm.  
A Cancel and Fire Cancel Report is created when a  
passcode is entered to silence an Alarm Bell or a Fire  
Bell before the bell time expires.  
If the last digit of the passcode is 0, a duress  
alarm occurs when the user enters 1 as the  
last digit of the passcode.  
For SIA CP-01 Compliance  
This prompt must be set to Yes.  
If the last digit of the passcode is 9, a duress  
alarm occurs when the user enters 0 as the  
last digit of the passcode.  
Call for Service Text  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Twenty alphanumeric characters  
2
Increase the last digit by 2 to generate an  
alarm. For example, if the passcode is 6123,  
6125 activates a duress alarm.  
Selection:  
Enter the text to display on a D1260 series keypad  
when the control panel is out of service.  
If the last digit of the passcode is 8, a duress  
alarm occurs when the user enters 0 as the  
last digit of the passcode.  
2.8  
Area Parameters  
This programming module contains three  
programming categories: Area Parameters, Bell  
Parameters, and Open/Close Options.  
If the last digit of the passcode is 9, a duress  
alarm occurs when the user enters 1 as the  
last digit of the passcode.  
2.8.1 Area Parameters  
3
Send a Duress event when any Passcode with  
L# Send Duress set to Yes is entered.  
Enter the area number you are programming.  
This program item determines when a passcode  
entry with L# Send Duress authority should produce  
a duress alarm.  
Area# Area On  
Default:  
Yes (Area 1 only)  
Yes or No  
Selection:  
Duress is enabled in Area Parameters by  
setting A# Duress Enable to Yes.  
Yes  
No  
Enable area.  
Disable area.  
Use this program item to enable or disable the area  
specified.  
The duress alarm activates when a user  
enters the duress passcode followed by  
the termination keys ([ESC] or [ENT]).  
Refer to Keypad Programming of Area # On and  
Area# Account Number on page 37.  
For SIA CP-01 Compliance  
Duress Type must be set to 3.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 37  
When the keypad reads PARAMETER SAVED, your  
selection is configured.  
Area 1 must be enabled:  
System events such as power and  
phone supervision do not send a  
report correctly if Area 1 is disabled.  
6. When the keypad reads AREA STATUS, press  
[NEXT] to advance to the A# ACCOUNT  
NUMBER option. The keypad shows the currently  
configured account number.  
7. Press [ENT] to change the account number.  
8. The [PREV] button acts as a [Backspace] key.  
The [COMMAND] key cycles though the special  
account number characters (B, C, D, E, F);  
[NEXT] select the account number character.  
Press [PREV] to delete the characters of the  
account number and then enter the new account  
number.  
When programmed No, points  
assigned to this area do not generate  
events, show at the keypad when  
arming and disarming, or send status  
reports. All user authority in this area  
is turned off while the area is  
disabled.  
To meet UL 864 requirements, set A#  
Area On to Yes.  
9. Press [ENT] to save the changes.  
When the keypad reads Parameter Saved, your  
selection is configured.  
Area# Account Number  
D1260  
Default:  
0000  
1. Refer to Figure 2 on page 8 to access Keypad  
Programming and navigate to the Area  
Selection:  
For Modem and Contact ID (four-  
digit account numbers): 0000 to  
9999,  
Parameters option. Press [ENT].  
2. The keypad reads Area Number 1 – 8.  
3. Enter the area number you wish to configure and  
press [Enter]. The current area status shows (for  
example, Area 1 On: Yes).  
4. Press the Edit softkey to change the area’s status.  
5. Press the Yes or No softkey, and then press the  
Save softkey to save the changes.  
BBBB to FFFF  
For Modem (ten-digit account  
numbers): 0000000000 to  
9999999999, BBBBBBBBBB to  
FFFFFFFFFF  
Determines the account number for this area. An  
account number must be assigned to each active  
area.  
When the keypad reads Parameter Saved, your  
selection is configured.  
6. When the keypad reads Area Status, press the  
Account Number softkey. The keypad shows the  
currently configured account number.  
7. Press the Edit softkey to change the account  
number.  
8. Use the softkeys and the number buttons on the  
keypad to enter the new account number. The  
Backspace softkey allows you to erase  
Account numbers are used to group areas together.  
Each area can have a different account number, or  
several areas can share the same account number.  
The control panel uses the account number as a  
reference for arming and keypad text displays.  
Contact ID: Only the last four digits are sent.  
Modem IIIa2: Enter a four-digit or ten-digit number.  
characters. The Clear softkey allows you to clear  
the entire account number. When entering a letter  
character, press the letter's softkey to select it.  
The Previous and Next softkeys advance through  
the letter characters (A, B, C, D, E, F).  
Keypad Programming of Area # On and Area#  
Account Number  
D1255  
1. Refer to Figure 1 on page 7 to access Keypad  
Programming and navigate to the AREA  
PARAMETERS option. Press [ENT].  
9. Press the Save softkey to save the changes.  
When the keypad reads Parameter Saved, your  
2. The keypad reads AREA NUM 1 – 32 (1 – 8 for  
the D7412GV3).  
3. Enter the area number you wish to configure and  
press [ENT]. The current area status shows (for  
example, AREA 1 ON: YES).  
selection is configured.  
A# Force Arm/Bypass Max  
Default:  
1
4. Press [ENT] to change the area’s status.  
5. Press the [PREV] or [NEXT] button to toggle  
between YES and NO, and then press [ENT]  
when the desired configuration option shows.  
Selection:  
0 to 99  
Specify the maximum number of combined Controlled  
points that can be faulted or bypassed when arming  
this area.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 38  
Refer to the prompts P## Force Arm Returnable  
and P## Bypass Returnable in Section 3.2 Point  
A# Auto Watch  
Responses on page 91 for returning a point to the  
system when the point returns to normal or when the  
area is disarmed.  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes  
When the area is disarmed, Watch  
Mode turns on automatically.  
Users can bypass more points than the  
number entered here during the  
disarmed state. It is only when the user  
attempts to Bypass Arm an area (or  
areas) that this restriction is enforced.  
No  
When the area is disarmed, Watch  
Mode must be turned on or off  
manually.  
A# Delay Restorals  
Controlled points must be programmed  
as P## Watch Point to generate a  
watch tone.  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
A# Verify Time  
Yes  
Point Restoral Report is not sent until  
the bell time expires or user  
acknowledges alarm condition.  
Default:  
60  
Selection:  
10 to 60 (in 1-sec increments)  
No  
Restoral Reports are sent when point  
restores, regardless of bell time.  
Use alarm verification with smoke detectors to reduce  
the number of false fire alarms. When Verify Time is  
programmed, the control panel can check smoke  
detector point activations before generating alarm  
signals.  
A# Exit Tone  
Default:  
Yes  
Do not enable the Cross Point feature  
in point indexes designated for Fire  
points.  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Sounds an exit tone during exit delay at all keypads  
assigned to this area.  
Check with your authority having  
jurisdiction (AHJ) to determine the  
maximum verification time allowed.  
You can turn off exit tones for individual  
keypads by programming the  
appropriate CC# 1 to 8 as No in CC#  
Exit Tone.  
Points are programmed individually to activate the  
verification feature. Refer to Section 3.1 Point Index  
on page 87. Any resettable Fire point can activate  
alarm verification for the area to which it is assigned.  
Use separate area alarm-verification relays.  
A# Exit Dly Time  
Default:  
60  
Selection:  
To enable alarm verification on a point, program Point  
Index, Fire Point, Alarm Verify, and Resettable as  
Yes.  
0 to 600 ( in 5 sec increments)  
Exit delay time for this area when Master Exit or  
Perimeter Exit arming.  
When an Alarm Verification point senses an alarm, the  
control panel automatically removes power to all  
Resettable points connected to the area’s Reset  
Sensors relay. The sensor reset removes power to the  
sensors for the amount of time programmed in Verify  
Time. When power is reapplied, a 60-sec confirmation  
window begins. If the detector is still in alarm and  
experiences another alarm during the confirmation  
window, or a different Resettable Verification point in  
the area senses an alarm, an alarm occurs.  
Points programmed for instant alarm  
response generate alarms immediately,  
even during exit delay. To avoid instant  
alarms on points adjacent to the  
perimeter when leaving the area,  
program P## Type as 3 (Interior  
Follower).  
For SIA CP-01 Compliance  
Example: Verify Time is set for 20 sec. The alarm  
verification cycle starts when the detector senses  
smoke or fire. No report occurs.  
The Exit Delay Time must be between 45 sec and  
255 sec.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 39  
When the detector senses smoke or fire, the area’s  
sensor reset relay interrupts power to points  
connected to it for the time in Verify Time.  
When power restores to the points, the 60-sec  
confirmation window starts. If any detector, reset  
during the verification time, experiences another alarm  
during the confirmation window, an alarm occurs. If no  
activity occurs during this period, no alarm occurs and  
the verification window ends. If a Verification point  
senses another alarm after the window ends, a new  
verification cycle begins. Refer to Table 21 on page  
39 for an example of Verify Time.  
To meet UL 864 requirements, set A#  
Verify Time to 60 sec.  
Table 21: Verify Time  
Verification  
Point Activation Sensors  
Power removed,  
Verify Time/Reset 60 sec Confirmation Restart Alarm  
Verification Cycle if  
an Alarm Verification  
point activates.  
Generate alarm if  
additional activity  
received.  
ignore activity  
Example: Total  
Cycle time 80 sec  
20 sec  
60 sec  
A# Duress Enable  
Default:  
No  
Yes or No  
Selection:  
Yes  
No  
Enable Duress alarm for this area.  
Disable Duress alarm for this area.  
Refer to Duress Type in Section 2.7 Miscellaneous  
on page 36 for an explanation of duress.  
For SIA CP-01 Compliance:  
A# Duress Enable must be set to Yes.  
The passcode you normally use for  
duress is not valid in an area with A#  
Duress Enable set to No.  
If a passcode with the appropriate  
L# Disarm authority is used to duress  
disarm an area with A# Duress Enable  
set to No, NO AUTHORITY appears in  
the display. Also, if the keypad display is  
moved to an area with A# Duress  
Enable set to No using  
[COMMAND][5][0], a valid duress disarm  
passcode does not send a duress report.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 40  
A# Area Type  
Default:  
Regular  
Selection:  
Regular, Master, Associate, or Shared  
Arms or disarms as an independent area.  
Does not allow arming for this area unless all associate areas with the same A# account  
Regular  
Master  
number are master exit delay armed or master armed. CHK AREA displays if the associate  
areas are not armed. Exception: RPS allows master areas to be armed without all associate  
areas being in the armed state.  
A master area can be disarmed regardless of the armed state of the other areas in the account.  
Multiple master areas can be programmed in a single account.  
CC# Scope affects master arming.  
Area: When arming a master area that has CC# Scope set to Area for all  
keypads, all associate areas within the same account must first be armed  
independently by other means.  
Panel Wide or Account Wide: When arming a master area from a keypad  
with CC# Scope set to Panel Wide or Account Wide, all associate areas  
enters exit delay as soon as the master area is armed. If there is a shared  
area within the same account, it begins its exit delay after all associate  
areas are armed.  
Using the arming sked (S## Function 1) requires that you first use an  
arming sked to arm the associate areas before using an arming sked to  
arm the master area. Arming master areas with RPS, Keyswitch, or Auto  
Close parameters (refer to Section 2.8.4 Open/Close Options on page 43)  
occurs before all associate areas are armed  
Associate  
Allows arming and disarming regardless of the armed state of the other areas with the same A#  
account number. Use this area type with a master area and associate it by using the same  
account number.  
Keypads assigned to associate areas, when used with shared areas, must  
have CC# Scope programmed.  
Shared areas:  
Shared  
do not associate to other areas by account number  
are armed when all Associate areas in the control panel are Master Delay armed  
are disarmed when at least one Associate area in the control panel is not Master Delay  
armed  
cannot be individually armed using a passcode, key switch, token or card, sked, or RPS  
Arming commands intended for a shared area must be executed on a  
keypad with Panel Wide scope by a user with appropriate authority in all  
Associate areas. Shared areas associate with all Associate areas  
regardless of their account assignments.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 41  
2.8.2 Shared-Area Characteristics  
Arming a Shared Area  
Silencing Sounders in the Shared Area  
Silence shared area alarms and troubles from any  
keypad.  
A shared area arms automatically when all associate  
areas are armed. As soon as the last associate area  
is armed, the shared area automatically begins its  
arming sequence. Passcode, key switch, sub-  
controls, or RPS cannot arm shared areas. To  
display faulted points at associate areas, the shared  
and associate areas must have the same account  
number.  
To silence sounders, the user needs an authority  
level assigned to the shared area. If the user also has  
the authority to arm or disarm the area, then  
ALREADY ARMED or ALREADY DISARMED  
momentarily appears.  
Access Control Readers Assigned to the Shared  
Area  
Disarming a Shared Area  
The shared area restarts the exit delay sequence  
allowing a user to walk to an associate area and  
disarm. If the token or card reader assigned to the  
shared area includes any associate area in the D##  
CC# Scope (in the access control section), both the  
associate area and shared area disarms when the  
token or card is presented. (Refer to Access Control  
Readers Assigned to the Shared Area on page 41.)  
Shared areas automatically disarm when any  
associate area in the control panel is disarmed.  
Passcode, tokens, cards, key switch, sub-controls, or  
RPS cannot disarm shared areas.  
Shared Area Arming Sequence  
When shared areas automatically begin to arm, the  
arming is based on the A# Exit Dly Time is based on  
the A# Exit Dly Time of the Shared Area.  
Closing Reports for Shared Areas  
If Closing Reports for shared areas are needed,  
assign passcodes a valid authority level in the shared  
area.  
Shared Area Not Ready  
If a point is faulted in the shared area, CHK AREA  
appears on the associate keypad that is arming the  
last associate area. Associate area keypads can  
show faults from shared areas as long as the shared  
areas fall within the scope of the associate area.  
2.8.3 Bell Parameters  
The D9412GV3 and the D7412GV3 have two main  
types of annunciation: Fire Bell and Burg Bell. Both  
Fire and Burg Bells share the same terminal  
(Terminal 6) on the control panel as shipped from the  
factory.  
Force Arming a Shared Area  
When CHK AREA appears, press [ESC] to show  
FORCE ARM at the associate keypad. Pressing  
[ENTER] force arms the shared area if:  
If a simultaneous Fire Bell and Burg Bell occur, the  
Fire Bell takes precedence over the Burg Bell  
regardless of which relay or terminal output they  
share.  
the user has authority to bypass points,  
the point is bypassable, and  
the number of faulted points does not exceed the  
force arm maximum amount for the shared area.  
When the Fire and Burg Bells share the same output  
and a Fire Bell occurs while the Burg Bell is ringing,  
the Fire Bell pattern overrides the Burg Bell pattern.  
At the end of the fire time, the burg pattern resumes.  
Remember to include the shared area  
in the associate area’s scope.  
When the Fire and Burg Bells share the same output  
and a Burg Bell occurs while a Fire Bell sounds, the  
control panel waits until the Fire time expires before  
starting the Burg Bell.  
Viewing Shared Area Armed Status  
View Area Status can be used from a keypad outside  
of the shared area to view the shared area’s armed  
state.  
Either a single bell (panel-wide) or a number of bells  
(area-wide) can be used on the control panel. For  
programming these applications, refer to Section  
2.12.1 Area Relays on page 79.  
When both Fire and Burg Bells occur simultaneously  
and a user enters a valid passcode, a Fire Cancel  
Report for the fire alarm and a Cancel Report for the  
burg alarm is sent to the central station if Cancel  
Reports is programmed Yes.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 42  
Select the bell pattern this area uses to signal an  
alarm on a Fire point.  
A# Fire Time  
Default:  
6 min  
When an alarm occurs on two Fire  
points sharing the same relay, the bell  
pattern of the most recent fire event  
takes precedence.  
Selection:  
1 min to 90 min  
Enter the number of minutes the bell rings for Fire  
Alarm points. The relay activated for this time is  
programmed in A# Fire Bell in Area Relays.  
A# Burg Time  
The bell output begins as soon as the fire alarm  
occurs. It shuts off the bell when the programmed  
number of minutes expires.  
Default:  
6 min  
Selection:  
1 to 90 min (in one-minute  
increments)  
If programmed for 1 min, the output can be anywhere  
from 0 to 60 sec of bell time. Program Fire Time for 2  
min or more to ensure you have ample output time.  
4 min for UL  
To meet UL 864 requirements, program  
A# Fire Time for at least 5 min. Check  
with your AHJ to determine the  
appropriate bell time for your  
geographical area.  
5 min for ULC  
Enter the number of minutes the bell rings for  
Burglary Alarm points. The relay activated for this  
time is programmed in A# Alarm Bell in Area Relays.  
The bell output begins as soon as the burglary alarm  
occurs. It shuts off the bell when the programmed  
number of minutes expires.  
A# Fire Pattern  
Default:  
Pulse  
When the control panel’s internal clock begins a new  
minute, it considers the first minute expired. Program  
Burg Time for 2 min or more.  
Selection:  
Steady, Pulse, CaStnd, TmCod3  
Steady Output  
Steady  
Pulse  
Check with your AHJ to determine the  
appropriate bell time for your  
geographical area.  
Pulse March Time  
120 beats per minute, at an even  
tempo  
For SIA CP-01 Compliance:  
CaStnd  
California Standard  
A# Burg Time must be 6 min or more.  
10 sec On + 5 sec Off + 10 sec On +  
5 sec Off. This sequence repeats  
until bell time expires.  
A# Burg Pattern  
Default:  
Steady  
TmCod3  
Temporal Code 3  
Selection:  
Steady, Pulse, CaStnd, TmCod3  
0.5 sec On, 0.5 sec Off, 0.5 sec On,  
0.5 sec Off, 0.5 sec On, 1.5 sec Off;  
pattern repeats. This sequence  
repeats for a minimum of 3 min and  
with a ± 10% tolerance.  
Select the bell pattern this area uses to signal an  
alarm on a Non-fire point.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 43  
Bell Test After Confirmation  
A# Single Ring  
In areas that send Opening and Closing Reports, the  
Bell Test occurs after the control panel sends the  
Closing Report and receives an acknowledgment  
from the central station receiver. For proper operation  
of the Bell Test after closing confirmation, the  
following rules apply:  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes  
One bell output per arming period.  
After one alarm, alarms on any Non-  
fire points in the same area cannot  
restart the bell until the armed state  
changes. An alarm on a different  
point in same area restarts bell  
output.  
The control panel must send Opening and  
Closing Reports to the central station.  
Do not use restricted openings and closings or  
Opening and Closing Windows.  
Area Armed Confirmation  
No  
Restart bell output with each alarm  
event.  
In areas that do not report opening and closing  
activity, the alarm bell relay output for this area  
activates for 2 sec after exit time expires.  
Determines if an alarm from a non-fire point can  
restart the alarm bell time with each Alarm Event, or  
only start alarm output once per arming period.  
Multiple Bell Tests occur: When more  
than one area is armed at the same time  
(such as using the ARM ALL AREAS?  
function), the bell rings for 2 sec with a  
2 sec pause between each bell activation  
if all areas have the same exit delay time  
programmed. Otherwise, the Bell Test  
occurs as each area arms and it  
This does not silence the keypad alarm bell tone, or  
prevent any reports. This feature does not affect Fire  
points. Fire points restart bell time with each new  
alarm.  
If an alarm occurs on a 24-hour point  
while the area is disarmed, arming that  
area with a key switch does not clear  
the A# Single Ring flag.  
completes its exit delay time.  
When areas arm simultaneously and  
report to the central station, the Bell  
Test occurs as the central station  
receiver confirms each area.  
Silencing the bell resets A# Single  
Ring.  
2.8.4 Open/Close Options  
A# Bell Test  
Programming determines if Opening, All Normal  
Closing, and Force Arm/Bypass Closing Events are  
sent to the remote central station. Without remote  
reports, all control panel and area arming (Closing  
Events) and disarming (Opening Events) default to  
local events.  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
Start Bell Test.  
Do not start Bell Test.  
Use this programming category to determine which  
opening and closing supervision characteristics are  
needed.  
Provides alarm output from the relay programmed at  
A# Alarm Bell after the Closing Report is confirmed  
or the exit delay time expires.  
There are three ways to generate reports from the  
control panel. You can generate reports by account,  
by area, or a combination of both.  
Opening and Closing Events are sent  
only by users with the proper authority  
settings.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
To suppress reports:  
EN | 44  
A# Account O/C  
Use Opening/Closing Windows to suppress  
reports for a specified period of time and then  
automatically turn them on again.  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Use the Restricted O/C options. A Closing Report  
is sent if the user is force arming, sending  
duress, or bypass arming. An Opening Report is  
sent if the user is disarming during an alarm  
condition or unbypasses points when disarming.  
If the system is normal, no Opening or Closing  
Report is sent.  
Yes  
Send Opening and Closing Reports  
by account.  
Use this selection if the control panel  
sends reports to an automation  
system that cannot interpret multiple  
Area Opening and Closing Reports.  
An Account Opening Report is  
generated when the first area in an  
account is opened (disarmed). After  
the Account Opening Report is sent,  
disarming other areas in the account  
does not generate another Account  
Opening Report. An Account Closing  
Report is generated only when the  
last area in an account is closed  
(armed). Opening and Closing  
For the scheduled suppression of  
Opening and Closing Reports, refer to  
Section 4.1.1 Opening and Closing) to  
define Opening and Closing Windows.  
Account Opening and Closing Reports  
Opening and Closing Reports are sent by account  
when the last area in a group of areas with the same  
account number(s) is armed.  
Area Opening and Closing Reports  
Reports for accounts do not contain  
any area information.  
Closing Reports are sent for each area as it is armed.  
The account number is also sent for each area.  
Opening and Closing Windows  
affect Account Opening and  
Closing Reports: If an account  
opening or closing is generated while  
an Opening or Closing Window for  
this area is in effect, and Disable O/C  
in Window is programmed Yes, the  
report is not sent. Use the same  
opening and closing window times for  
all areas sharing the same account  
number.  
Customizing Account Opening and Closing  
Reports  
You can eliminate area Opening and Closing Reports  
from selected areas in the account by programming  
A# Area O/C as No for those areas.  
Combination Account and Area Opening and  
Closing Reports  
To send both account openings and closings, and  
individual area openings and closings for all areas in  
the account, you must:  
No  
Do not send Opening and Closing  
Reports by account.  
Program A# Account O/C as Yes for all areas in  
the account.  
Determines if this area generates Account Opening  
and Closing Reports. Program this item the same for  
all areas in the account.  
Program A# Area O/C as Yes for all areas in the  
account.  
Closing Reports: When areas in the account are  
independently armed, each area generates an Area  
Closing Report. When the last area is armed, it also  
generates an Account Closing Report.  
Opening Reports: When the first area in the account  
is disarmed, it generates an Account Opening Report  
along with an Area Opening Report. When the  
remaining areas in the account are disarmed, each  
area generates an Area Opening Report.  
Area Only Opening Closing Supervision Features  
Use these features to supervise opening and closing  
activity by area. Auto Close, Fail To Open, and Fail  
To Close all work independently of the A# Account  
O/C feature. To use these features, program O/C  
Windows.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 45  
Determines if opening and closing activity is reported  
when it occurs inside an Opening or Closing Window,  
as programmed in O/C Windows.  
A# Area O/C  
Default:  
Yes  
Reports are always logged and printed on a local  
printer, if installed.  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes Include the Area # and generate Opening  
and Closing Reports for this area when it is  
armed.  
A# Auto Close  
Default:  
No  
No  
Do not include the Area # or generate  
Opening and Closing Reports for this area.  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes The area automatically master arms at the  
end of the Close Window.  
Determines if the area number and the account  
number are reported at arming and disarming. As  
long as Account O/C is No, the account number  
sends a report when arming this area individually. If  
Account O/C is Yes, all areas with the same account  
number must also be armed.  
When the area is armed automatically, a  
Closing Report is sent if the Area or  
Account Reports are programmed to do so.  
No  
Do not automatically arm the area at the  
end of the Close Window.  
An Area Opening Report is generated when each  
area is opened (disarmed). An Area Closing Report is  
generated when each individual area is closed  
(armed).  
With this program item, the control panel can  
automatically master arm the area at the end of the  
Closing Window regardless of the previous armed  
state.  
Do not program this item as Yes if the  
control panel reports to an automation  
system that cannot interpret multiple Area  
Opening and Closing Reports.  
When an area master arms automatically  
at the end of a Close window, the system  
disregards the settings in A# Force Arm  
Max and P## Bypassable for any faulted  
points. The faulted points arm when they  
return to normal state.  
A# Disable O/C in Window  
Default:  
Yes  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
A# Fail to Open  
Yes  
Do not send Opening and Closing Reports  
to the central station if they occur inside an  
active window.  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
If an Opening or Closing Report occurs  
outside a window, send it with an early or  
late modifier. Refer to Section 4.1.1  
Opening and Closing on page 105.  
Yes  
Fail to Open Report is sent for this  
area if the area was not disarmed  
when the Opening Window stop time  
occurred.  
The active window must be a Closing  
Window for Closing Reports. It must be an  
Opening Window for Opening Reports.  
No  
Fail to Open Report is not sent for  
this area.  
Use to determine if a Fail to Open Report is sent for  
this area. This can determine if a user failed to  
disarm the area before the Opening Window expiring.  
Normal Opening and Closing Reports do not need to  
be programmed to use this feature.  
No  
Send Opening and Closing Reports to the  
central station even when they occur inside  
a programmed window. If an opening or  
closing occurs outside of the appropriate  
window, it reports but does not have an  
early or late modifier.  
If you want to monitor all opening and  
closing activity and use features provided  
by Opening and Closing Windows, program  
this item as No, and program the  
appropriate O/C Windows.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 46  
A# Fail to Close  
A# Restrictd O/C  
Default:  
No  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes or No  
Yes  
Fail to Close Report is sent for this  
area if the area is not armed when  
the Closing Window stop time occurs.  
Yes  
Restrict Opening and Closing  
Reports for this area. A# Area O/C  
must be programmed Yes to  
generate Restricted Opening and  
Closing Reports.  
Note:  
Program an exit delay time in  
Exit Dly Time.  
Note:  
If a passcode is not required for  
arming or disarming and this item  
is Yes, the area sends only  
No  
Fail to Close Report is not sent for  
this area.  
If Auto Close is programmed  
Yes, a Fail to Close Report is  
sent because it occurs when the  
Closing Window stop time  
occurred.  
Restricted Opening and Closing  
Reports. In this case, Restricted  
Reports are sent without User ID.  
Opening/Closing Window does not  
affect this report. Windows do not  
prevent sending Restricted Opening  
and Closing Reports from being sent.  
Early or late designations are not  
added to Opening or Closing Reports  
when they are sent according to the  
rules for Restricted Opening or  
Closing Reports.  
If Disable O/C in Window is  
Yes, the Fail to Close Report is  
followed by Closing Late or  
Force) Close Late.  
This item determines if a Fail to Close Report is sent  
for this area. Use to determine if a user failed to arm  
the area before the Closing Window expires. Normal  
Opening and Closing Reports do not need to be  
programmed to use this feature.  
No  
Do not Restrict Opening and Closing  
Reports for this area.  
Regardless of programming in  
Authority Levels L## Restricted O/C,  
reports are not restricted in this area  
when this item is programmed as No.  
Note:  
Was Force Armed and Forced  
Close Events can still be sent to  
the central station if enabled in  
Routing when force arming the  
system.  
This item determines if this area can restrict Opening  
and Closing Report activity.  
A Restricted Opening Report refers to the control  
panel sending an Area Opening Report only when  
the area is disarmed after a non-fire alarm.  
A Restricted Closing Report refers to the control  
panel sending a Force Closed Report only when the  
area was master armed with Controlled points that  
were faulted during the arming sequence. The  
sequence of reports generated by a restricted closing  
is: Was Force Armed, Forced Point, and Force  
Closed.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 47  
To extend across midnight, you must use two  
windows:  
A# Perimeter O/C  
Default:  
No  
To suppress reports before midnight, use one  
window (for example, 20:00 start to 23:59 stop).  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
To suppress reports immediately after midnight,  
use another window (for example, 00:01 start to  
02:00 stop).  
Yes This area can send Perimeter Opening and  
Closing Reports.  
No  
This area cannot send Perimeter Opening  
and Closing Reports.  
2.8.5 Arming Features  
A# Two Man Rule  
This item determines if this area can send Perimeter  
Instant and Perimeter Delay Closing Reports and  
normal Opening Reports to the central station.  
Opening and Closing Windows do not suppress this  
event. Refer to the L## Perimeter O/C prompt on  
page 75.  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes  
Two valid unique passcodes are  
required to disarm the area.  
This reporting requires ModemIIIa2  
reporting format reporting. Some central  
station automation systems cannot  
process these reports.  
No  
A single passcode with a valid  
authority level can disarm the area.  
The D720 Keypad does not support the  
Two-Man Rule feature.  
A# Latest Close Time  
Default:  
00:00  
Use this parameter when disarming an area that is  
Master Armed. After recognizing the first valid  
passcode, the system requests a second passcode  
to disarm the area. If the entry delay expires before  
the entry of a second valid unique passcode, an  
alarm condition occurs. This function works only  
when you use Passcode Disarm.  
Selection:  
00:00 to 24:00  
Use to set a Latest Close Time boundary value for  
this area. If the Latest Close Time value is non-zero,  
the time of day specified with the Extend Close  
feature cannot be greater than or equal to this value.  
A zero value for A# Latest Close Time disables the  
feature for the area.  
When you are disarming an area with A#  
Two Man Rule set to Yes, the keypad  
waits for the time equal to the A# Exit  
Delay Time. If the second passcode is  
not entered before the prompt times out,  
the rule resets and waits for the first  
passcode again.  
Example: If A# Latest Close Time is set for 17:30,  
the user can extend the close time to as late as  
17:29.  
This prompt is used only when an O/C Window is  
assigned to an area. Make entries in 30-min  
increments using a 24-hour format. Use times that  
begin on the hour or the half-hour only. For example,  
enter 2:30 PM as 14:30. Enter 1:00 AM as 01:00. To  
set the Latest Close Time for midnight, use a value of  
24:00. The latest close time allowed by the Extend  
Close feature is 24:58, because of internal limitations  
in the control panel.  
If the area is already in an alarm  
condition, the first valid passcode entered  
after the alarm occurs silences the bell  
but does not disarm the area. Enter  
Code 2 appears on the display. A second  
valid unique passcode is necessary to  
disarm the area.  
The default entry of 00:00 disables the  
Latest Close Time feature for this area.  
This feature is not allowed for use with  
SIA CP-01 compliant installations.  
Consult the local authority having  
jurisdiction (AHJ) for proper usage. Refer  
to your control panel’s program entry  
guide for programming information.  
The control panel sets all windows for the next day  
when the control panel clock turns to midnight. The  
control panel must cross the midnight boundary  
before any changes in that default setting occur.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 48  
Parameter Setup Requirement:  
When the first digit of the second code is pressed,  
the following message appears. As each digit is  
pressed, an additional asterisk appears.  
Two Man Rule can be completed only by entering  
two valid unique passcodes with L## Passcode  
Disarm authority.  
To avoid unintended results for the end  
user of the system:  
Set CC# Scope to Area Wide for  
keypads assigned to areas with the  
Two Man Rule feature.  
A# Early Ambush  
Avoid setting the A# Two Man Rule  
to Yes in an area where A# Early  
Ambush is set to Yes.  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Use this feature in banks or other facilities  
that might require a higher level of  
security to gain access to a vault or other  
protected area.  
Yes  
Two valid passcodes are required to  
disarm the area within the time period  
specified in Early Ambush Timer. The  
second valid disarm passcode must  
be entered within a time limit. Refer  
to Early Ambush Timer on page  
137.  
D1255 Keypad  
After the first valid passcode is entered, the D1255  
replaces the scrolling DISARM NOW and the Point  
Text display with the SECOND CODE:.display  
If the second passcode is not entered  
within the time limit, the system  
generates a Duress Event based  
upon the primary user.  
When the user presses the first digit of the second  
code, the display changes to SECOND CODE: *.  
SECOND CODE: appears for 19 sec. If no digits are  
pressed, the display returns to normal and the area  
does not disarm. If a second code is entered, the  
area disarms and an Opening report is sent with the  
User ID of the first user. If the second code entered is  
the same as the first code, is invalid, or does not  
have L## Disarm authority, the keypad shows NO  
AUTHORITY and returns to idle text or entry delay.  
No  
A single passcode with a valid  
authority level can disarm the area.  
The Early Ambush disarming feature is intended for  
use when you disarm an area that is in the Master  
Armed state, but it can also be used with the  
Perimeter and Instant Armed states. After the first  
valid passcode is entered, the area is disarmed and  
the keypad displays the disarmed idle text normally.  
This function operates only when you use Passcode  
Disarm.  
D1260 Keypad  
In the D1260, after the first valid passcode is entered,  
the following message appears for 3 sec.  
If the second valid disarm passcode is entered, the  
D1255 Keypad shows CODE 2 VALIDATE and  
sounds the Watch Mode tone. Only the Watch Mode  
tone appears on the D720 Keypad.  
The D1260 Keypad sounds the Watch Mode tone  
and the following text appears.  
Then the next message appears requesting a second  
code.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 49  
Parameter Setup Requirement:  
To avoid the possibility of false alarms in  
Associate areas, do not use the A# Exit  
Restart feature in areas with A# Area  
Type set to Shared.  
The Early Ambush timer can be started and stopped  
only by passcodes with the L## Passcode Disarm  
authority.  
For SIA CP-01 Compliance  
To avoid unintended results for the end  
user of the system:  
This prompt can be set to Yes or No.  
When a keypad is assigned to an area  
that has the Early Ambush feature  
enabled, set the CC# Scope value to  
Area Wide.  
A# Arm No Exit  
Default:  
Yes  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
If an area has A# Two Man Rule set  
to Yes, do not set A# Early Ambush  
to Yes.  
Yes  
No  
Switch the arming state to Perimeter  
if no Perimeter Delay point faults  
occurred.  
During an alarm, after the first passcode is entered,  
the Early Ambush timer still begins. A Cancel Report  
might be generated, depending upon the bell time,  
and the keypad displays Alarm Silenced normally. If  
the second valid disarm passcode is entered, the  
keypads indicate that the second passcode is valid.  
Refer to the Secondary Ambush Code prompt on  
page 137 for information about the unique behavior  
of the two passcodes.  
Keep the area in Master Arm if no  
Perimeter Delay point faults  
occurred.  
This parameter switches the arming state of an area  
from Master Armed to Perimeter Armed if no  
perimeter points with delay response were activated  
during the exit delay time. Only the final armed state  
is reported and displayed at the keypads.  
For SIA CP-01 Compliance:  
The A# Arm No Exit feature does not  
operate in areas with A# Area Type set  
to Shared.  
This feature is not allowed for use with  
SIA CP-01 compliant installations.  
For SIA CP-01 Compliance:  
A# Exit Restart  
A# Exit Restart can be set to Yes or No.  
A# Exit Warning  
Default:  
Yes  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Default:  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
Delay armed points in this area  
restart the exit delay timer if violated  
during the exit delay time.  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes  
Pulse the alarm output for the last 10  
sec of the Exit Delay time.  
Delay armed points continue to count  
down normally if violated during the  
exit delay time.  
No  
Do not pulse the Alarm Bell output  
during the Exit Delay time.  
When enabled, the Alarm Bell output pulses on and  
off every 2 sec for the remaining 10 sec of the Exit  
Delay time.  
This feature must be disabled for UL Line  
Security/Encryption applications.  
For SIA CP-01 Compliance  
A# Exit Warning must be set to Yes.  
When enabled, this feature activates when a  
controlled point with delay alarm response changes  
from normal to faulted and back to normal during the  
exit delay. When activated, if any controlled point in  
the same area with delay alarm response is faulted,  
the exit delay time restarts. The exit delay continues  
until it expires or the area changes arming states.  
This operation can occur only once in an arming  
cycle.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 50  
2.9  
Keypad (Command Center)  
A# Entry Warning  
This programming module contains three  
programming categories: Cmd Cntr Assignment,  
Area Text, and Custom Function.  
Default:  
Yes  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
2.9.1 Keypad (Command Center) Assignment  
Yes  
Pulse the alarm output for the last 10  
sec of the Entry Delay time.  
This programming category assigns a keypad to an  
area and determines if the keypad is supervised. The  
keypads are connected to the control panel using a  
two-wire serial data interface (SDI) bus.  
No  
Do not pulse the Alarm Bell output  
during the Entry Delay time.  
When enabled, the Alarm Bell output pulses on and  
off every 2 sec for the remaining 10 sec of the Entry  
Delay time.  
This bus can support up to sixteen supervised  
keypads, each with its own unique keypad address  
(CC) and corresponding DIP switch address settings.  
If the keypads are not supervised, you can install  
multiple keypads with the same DIP switch address  
setting for up to 32 unsupervised keypads.  
For SIA CP-01 Compliance  
A# Entry Warning must be set to Yes.  
Enhanced keypads (D1260 Series) and standard  
keypads (D1255 Series) cannot share the same SDI  
Address.  
Cmd Center  
DIP Switch Setting  
SDI Address (CC#)  
1
2
3
4
5
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
6
1
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
2
OFF  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
3
OFF  
OFF  
ON  
ON  
ON  
4
OFF  
ON  
ON  
ON  
5
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
ON  
ON  
6
OFF  
ON  
ON  
ON  
7
OFF  
OFF  
ON  
ON  
8
OFF  
ON  
ON  
9
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
OFF  
ON  
ON  
ON  
OFF  
OFF  
ON  
ON  
OFF  
ON  
ON  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
ON  
ON  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
Enter the keypad (CC) number for the SDI address you are programming. This number corresponds to the DIP  
switch address settings shown.  
Switch 5: On=Encoding Tone On (default), Off=Encoding Tone Off  
The D1255 can be addressed as 1 through 16. The D1260 can be addressed only as 1 – 8.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 51  
4. Press [NEXT]. The current keypad type shows  
CC# Supervised  
(for example, CC - 1 TYPE ENHANCED: YES).  
5. Press [ENT] to change the keypad’s type.  
6. Press [NEXT] or [PREV] to toggle to No to  
indicate that the D1255 is not an enhanced  
keypad, and then press [ENT] to save the  
changes.  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Yes or No  
Selection:  
Yes Only one keypad can be installed for this  
CC SDI address.  
When the keypad reads PARAMETER SAVED, your  
selection has been configured.  
No  
More than one keypad can be installed  
using this CC SDI address with the same  
address DIP switch setting.  
D1260  
1. Refer to Figure 2 on page 8 to access Keypad  
Programming and navigate to the Command  
Center option.  
2. Press [ENTER]. The CC Num 1 – 16 option  
shows.  
3. Enter the keypad number you wish to configure  
and press [ENTER]. The keypad reads CC#  
Scope, and then the current configuration (for  
example, Panel Wide).  
4. Press the Type softkey. The current keypad type  
shows (for example, CC (1) Type Enhanced:  
Yes).  
Supervise this SDI address and generate Trouble  
SDI Reports and local trouble annunciation if a  
problem occurs with this keypad or the SDI bus.  
To meet UL 864 requirements, set CC#  
Supervised to Yes for the fire  
annunciation keypad.  
Keypads that share the same address  
setting display the same text and emit the  
same tones, regardless of which keypad’s  
keys are pressed.  
5. Press the Edit softkey to change the keypad’s  
type.  
6. Press the Yes or No softkey, and then press the  
Save softkey to save the changes.  
Trouble SDI # Reports are always  
reported as Area 1, Account 1 Events  
regardless of the area the SDI device is  
assigned.  
When the keypad reads Parameter Saved, your  
selection has been configured.  
When this prompt is Yes, you cannot  
have duplicate DIP switch settings.  
Reboot the system to enable a D1260  
Series Keypad.  
To reboot the system, close and open the  
reset switch, labeled “S1 RESET,”  
located in the upper right corner of the  
control panel.  
CC# Enhanced Command Center  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
CC# Area Assign  
Yes  
This keypad is a D1260 Series  
Keypad.  
Default:  
1
Selection:  
No  
This keypad is not a D1260 Series  
Keypad.  
1 to 32 on D9412GV3  
1 to 8 on D7412GV3  
When a D1260 Series Keypad is installed at this  
keypad address, this item must be set to Yes.  
Enter the area number where you are installing this  
keypad or keypads with this address and the same  
DIP switch settings.  
Keypad Programming of CC# EnhancCMDCTR  
D1255  
1. Refer to Figure 1 on page 7 to access Keypad  
Programming and navigate to the COMMAND  
CENTER option.  
2. Press [ENT]. The CC NUM 1 – 16 option shows.  
3. Enter the keypad number you wish to configure  
and press [ENT]. The keypad reads CC#  
SCOPE, and then the current configuration (for  
example, PANEL WIDE).  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 52  
CC# Scope  
Default:  
Refer to the preceding important  
note  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection:  
Panel Wide, Custom, No Keypad,  
Area, and Account  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes  
Include this area in the scope of this  
keypad.  
Panel  
Wide  
A panel-wide keypad can view  
information and perform Arming and  
Disarming functions for all areas in  
the control panel. A panel-wide  
keypad can cross account  
No  
Do not include this area in the scope  
of this keypad.  
Determines whether any of the areas and doors are  
included in the scope of this keypad for viewing  
status, arming or disarming, and controlling doors  
from the keypad.  
boundaries. This is normally used  
with a master area.  
Account  
An Account keypad can view  
information, and perform Arming and  
Disarming functions for all areas with  
the same A# Account Number, in  
Area Parameters. This is normally  
used for an associate area.  
Keypad Programming of CC# Scope  
D1255  
1. Refer to Figure 1 on page 7 to access Keypad  
Programming and navigate to the COMMAND  
CENTER option.  
2. Press [ENT]. The CC NUM 1 – 16 option shows.  
3. Enter the keypad number you wish to configure  
and press [ENT]. The keypad reads CC#  
SCOPE, and then the current configuration (for  
example, PANEL WIDE).  
4. To change the configuration, press [ENT] when  
the current configuration shows, and then press  
[NEXT] or [PREV] to scroll through the options,  
as listed in CC# Scope on page 52 .  
Area  
An area keypad is restricted to  
viewing information and Arming or  
Disarming functions for the area to  
which it is assigned.  
Custom  
A custom keypad shows information  
and allows arming and disarming for  
specific areas you select. (This option  
is not available through Keypad  
Programming.)  
5. When the keypad reads the desired configuration  
option, press [ENT] to select it.  
No  
Keypad  
No keypad installed at this address.  
CALL FOR SERVICE display shows,  
indicating the control panel is not  
polling this address.  
When the keypad reads PARAMETER SAVED,  
your selection has been configured.  
This program item is used to define the areas  
affected when an arming command is executed on  
this keypad, the areas this keypad can view, and the  
areas to which this keypad can move.  
D1260  
1. Refer to Figure 2 on page 8 to access Keypad  
Programming and navigate to the Command  
Center option.  
2. Press [ENTER]. The CC Num 1 – 16 option  
shows.  
3. Enter the keypad number you wish to configure  
and press [ENT]. The keypad reads CC# Scope,  
and then the current configuration (for example,  
Panel Wide).  
4. To change the configuration, press the Edit  
softkey, and then press the Next or Previous  
sofkeys to scroll through the options, as listed in  
CC# Scope on page 52 .  
5. When the keypad reads the desired configuration  
option, Save to select it.  
In applications where keypads include  
more than one area, active alarms in  
remote areas must be acknowledged  
before arming or disarming the local area.  
The following prompt is visible only when  
you program CC## Scope to Custom. If  
you change the keypad scope selection  
to Custom from Panel Wide, Account, or  
Area, the settings from the previous CC#  
Scope selection become the default  
settings for the custom parameters in  
CC# A1 [through A#] in Scope. Before  
exiting from a custom program, check  
each area and ensure that it is enabled  
and disabled correctly.  
When the keypad reads Parameter Saved, your  
selection has been configured.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 53  
CC# Enter Key Relay  
The service passcode cannot be used  
for the CC# Enter Key Cycle Door  
application.  
Default:  
0
Selection:  
0 to 128, A, B, C (0 to 64, A, B, C  
for the D7412GV3)  
When programmed to activate a relay,  
the [ENTER] key cannot be used for  
any other function.  
0
The [ENTER] key is not used to  
activate a relay.  
Relays used for this function must not  
be shared with any other point, sensor  
reset, control panel, or bell functions.  
Sharing can cause errors in relay  
operation.  
1 to 128 (64), Assign the relay number that  
A, B, C  
activates when [ENTER] is pressed  
at this keypad after the user enters  
a valid passcode.  
The door does not cycle if Enter Key  
Relay is programmed.  
Enter Key Relay: Program the relay number that  
activates momentarily for 10 sec when a user enters  
a valid passcode and presses the [ENTER] key on  
the keypad. Two events are generated when this  
function is used: RELAY ### SET with User ID, and  
RELAY ### RESET without User ID. The system  
logs this action as two events.  
9210 NOT READY appears at this  
keypad when you press [ENTER] if the  
D9210B is not programmed with a D#  
Entry Area (in the Access Control  
section) or if CC Assign Door does not  
have a door number assigned.  
Entering a valid code and pressing [ENTER] at a  
keypad silences a ringing bell.  
CC# Assign Door  
Using CC# Enter Key Relay for a low-level  
access control strike on a door does not shunt a  
point.  
Default:  
No Door  
Selection:  
No Door, 1 to 8 on D9412GV3.  
(No Door, 1, 2 on D7412GV3)  
When programmed to activate a relay, the  
[ENTER] key cannot be used for any  
other function.  
No  
No door controller is assigned for adding  
Relays used for this function must not be  
shared with any other point, sensor reset,  
control panel, or bell functions. Sharing  
can cause errors in relay operation.  
Door tokens.  
1 to 8 The door controller assigned to this keypad  
is used to read new tokens when the Add  
User Mode is initiated.  
If the assigned door remains open and this keypad  
has the CC# Close Door Warning Tone set to Yes,  
the CLOSE DOOR # message appears on this  
keypad.  
CC# Enter Key Cycle Door  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
The [ENTER] key is used to cycle the  
door programmed for CC Assign  
Door.  
The [ENTER] key is not used to cycle  
the door.  
Enter Key Cycle Door: Program this prompt as Yes  
to start the door cycle sequence for the door number  
programmed in CC# Assign Door when a user  
enters a valid passcode and presses [ENTER]. This  
includes shunting the point assigned to the door.  
ACCESS GRANTED prints on the local printer and at  
the central station receiver, if programmed.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 54  
CC# Entry Tone  
If a door is not programmed for this  
prompt and a door is not assigned to  
Default:  
Yes  
the area using the D# Entry Area in  
the Access Control section, 9210 NOT  
READY appears at this keypad when  
you attempt to add a user. The  
message indicates that the control  
panel cannot start the Add User Mode  
until a door is assigned to this keypad.  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
This keypad sounds entry tones.  
This keypad does not sound entry  
tones.  
Determines whether this keypad, or any keypad with  
the same address setting, emits the entry delay tone.  
Any Delay point within the area scope of this keypad  
starts the entry sequence.  
Assigning a door to a keypad is not  
necessary for the user to control the  
door(s) using the Door Control  
function. Any door that is active can be  
controlled by a user who has the  
appropriate door control authority. The  
door control functions are available to  
a valid user at any keypad with access  
to the area where the door is  
This prompt allows you to manage the  
tone by keypad. Entry Tone can also be  
turned off when programming your P##  
Entry Tone off in Point Index.  
Assign two CCs to the same area so one  
keypad emits the tone and another does  
not.  
assigned.  
During the Add User Mode, tokens or  
cards, door control requests, and  
RTE/REX do not function. Put the Door  
Mode into an unlocked state before  
adding users if there is heavy activity for  
this door.  
For SIA CP-01 Compliance  
CC# Entry Tone can be set to Yes or No.  
CC# Exit Tone  
CC# Trouble Tone  
Default:  
Yes  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Default:  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
This keypad sounds exit tones.  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
This keypad does not sound exit  
tones.  
Yes  
Panel-wide trouble tones sound and  
visual displays show at this keypad.  
Determines whether this keypad, or any keypad with  
the same address setting, emits the exit delay tone  
during the delay arming of an area(s). Any keypad  
with a scope to arm this area can initiate the exit tone  
sequence.  
No  
Panel-wide troubles do not sound.  
Visual displays still show.  
Determines whether this keypad, or any keypad with  
the same address setting, emits the panel-wide  
trouble tones (power, phone, SDI bus, and Zonex  
bus).  
This prompt allows you to manage the tone by  
keypad. Exit Tone can also be turned off when  
programming A# Exit Tone in Area Parameters.  
To meet UL 864 requirements, set CC#  
Trouble Tone to Yes.  
The cadence and pitch of the exit tone increase for  
the last 10 sec of the exit delay time.  
This SIA CP-01 required feature is not  
supported on the D720 Series Keypads.  
Panel-wide trouble tones do not include  
Point Troubles, Buzz on Fault, or Close  
Door Now.  
Assign two CCs to the same area so one  
keypad emits the tone and another does  
not. Set one keypad for CC EXIT TONE =  
YES, and one to EXIT TONE = NO.  
Assign two CCs to the same area so one  
keypad emits the tone and another does  
not.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 55  
For SIA CP-01 Compliance  
CC# Passcode Follows Scope  
CC# Exit Tone can be set to Yes or No.  
Default:  
Yes  
CC# Arm Now Warning  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Default:  
No  
Yes  
Master Arming allows a user to  
change the armed state of the areas  
within the scope of this keypad. If the  
areas in the scope are already at the  
intended armed state, they remain in  
that state.  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes  
This keypad activates a tone and  
displays PLEASE CLOSE NOW.  
No  
This keypad does not activate the  
tone or display PLEASE CLOSE  
NOW.  
If the area to which this keypad is  
assigned is armed, entering a  
valid passcode disarms this area  
and all other areas assigned to  
the scope of this keypad.  
Determines whether this keypad sounds a tone and  
displays the PLEASE CLOSE NOW warning on the  
keypad when a Closing Window activates, indicating  
the area automatically arms soon.  
If the area to which this keypad is  
assigned is disarmed, entering a  
valid passcode arms this area  
and all other areas assigned to  
the scope of this keypad.  
CC# Close Door  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
No  
Restricts the scope of the keypad to  
the Area programmed in CC# Area  
Assign for the purpose of executing  
L## Passcode Arm and  
Yes  
This keypad sounds a tone and  
displays CLOSE DOOR #.  
No  
This keypad does not sound the  
tone or activate the display.  
L## Passcode Disarm only.  
Use this program to determine if this keypad follows  
CC# Scope or if it only arms or disarms the area to  
which it is assigned. The user must have authority  
enabled in L## Passcode Arm and L## Passcode  
Disarm. This feature does not affect the Function List  
arming and disarming commands.  
Determines whether this keypad sounds an audible  
tone and displays the CLOSE DOOR # warning on  
the keypad. This occurs when the door is physically  
held open past the shunt time and the extend time  
has a value greater than zero for the door assigned  
to this area in CC# Assign Door. Refer to the  
D9210B Program Entry Guide (P/N: 32207).  
Tokens and cards disarm according to  
this prompt. If this prompt is No, tokens  
disarm only the Area to which the CC# is  
assigned. The user must have disarming  
rights for tokens and cards programmed  
at the Disarm Level. The user does not  
need disarming and arming authority for  
the keypad.  
You can use this prompt for a group of  
account-wide keypads that only arm the  
area to which they are assigned, even if  
the user has a passcode with arming  
authority rights in all areas.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 56  
CC# Scroll Lock  
CC# Abort Display  
Default:  
No  
Default:  
Yes  
Selection:  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes or No  
Yes  
Prevents the idle system status text  
from scrolling automatically.  
Requires user intervention to  
advance.  
Yes  
No  
This keypad shows the Alarm  
Aborted message for all aborted  
alarms within its scope.  
This keypad does not show the  
Alarm Aborted message for all  
aborted alarms within its scope.  
No  
Allows the idle system status text to  
scroll automatically without user  
intervention  
This parameter enables or disables the ALARM NOT  
SENT message when an alarm is aborted before  
transmission occurs.  
Use this parameter to enable a special non-scrolling  
option for the idle system status display text on a  
keypad. This keypad mode requires the user to press  
the PREV or NEXT key on the keypad to unlock the  
display and begin scrolling through the system status  
displays.  
For SIA CP-01 Compliance  
CC# Abort Display can be set to Yes or No.  
CC# Cancel Display  
CC# Menu Key Lock  
Default:  
Yes  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
This keypad shows the Cancel  
Report Sent message for all canceled  
alarms within its scope.  
Yes  
If set to Yes, the user is prompted to  
enter a passcode after pressing the  
Menu key on the keypad. The items  
programmed in the Menu List for this  
specific keypad are filtered by the  
user’s authority level. Only those  
items in the menu list for which the  
user has authority appear.  
This keypad does not show the  
Cancel Report Sent message for all  
canceled alarms within its scope.  
This parameter enables or disables the CANCEL  
REPORT SENT display message when an alarm is  
canceled after transmission occurs. To show this  
message, Cancel Report must be set to Yes. Refer to  
Cancel Report on page 36.  
No  
If set to No, when the user presses  
the Menu key, all items that are  
programmed in the Menu List for the  
Command Center Address (Keypad  
Address) appear, regardless of the  
user’s authority level.  
For SIA CP-01 Compliance  
CC# Cancel Display can be set to Yes or No.  
2.9.2 Area Text  
Determines if the Menu Key, when pressed, requires  
a passcode to access the functions.  
Use this programming category to create custom Idle  
Text displays for the keypads.  
If this parameter is set to Yes, users must  
enter a passcode after pressing the Menu  
key. When the passcode is validated,  
only those functions for which the user  
has authority appear in the list. If a  
function in the Menu List is passcode  
protected (refer to Keypad Functions in  
Section 2.11.2 User Interface on page)  
the user does not need to enter the  
passcode again.  
Each display can be programmed with up  
to sixteen alphanumeric characters,  
including: A to Z, 0 to 9, ?, &, @, -, *,  
+, $, #, _, /.  
Characters not listed are invalid and  
cannot be used for text.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 57  
D1260 Series Keypad  
Area# Is On  
Although it is not programmed in this area, the D1260  
Series keypad can display up to sixteen characters  
for an Area Name on line 1 of its display. The Area  
Text (Area # Is Off, Area # Not Ready, Area # Is  
On, and Account # Is On) programmed in this  
module appears on line 2 of the D1260 Alpha V  
Keypad. When programming custom text, it should  
be logical to users viewing it on the D1260. For  
example, the Area Name Text can be programmed to  
display Front Office and the Area # Is Off text  
(programmed in this section) could be programmed  
to display Ready To Arm. The D1260 would then  
show on line 1 Front Office and on line 2, Ready To  
Arm.  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Sixteen alphanumeric characters  
Selection:  
Enter the text for this area that appears when the  
area is master armed or master instant armed and  
other areas sharing the same account number are  
not yet master armed. This display does not appear  
when the area is perimeter armed.  
Area# Not Ready  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Sixteen alphanumeric characters  
Selection:  
2.9.3 Custom Function  
Enter the text for this area that displays when the  
area is disarmed but points are faulted.  
Use custom functions to simplify complex keystroke  
sequences entered at the keypad. These items are  
similar to speed dialing on a telephone. When the  
custom function appears on the keypad, a user can  
execute a request by pressing [ENTER]. You can  
have up to sixteen custom functions and restrict their  
use by area and authority level.  
Area# Is Off  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Sixteen alphanumeric characters  
Selection:  
Enter the text for this area that displays when the  
area is disarmed and no points are faulted.  
Each Custom Function ### item has sixteen  
characters of programmable text (CF### Text).  
When the Custom Function is assigned to the menu  
M## Function (refer to Section 2.11 Function List on  
page 77) the user can press [PREV] or [NEXT] to  
scroll to CF### Text. The user accesses the menu  
by pressing [MENU] on the keypad.  
Area# Account Is On  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Sixteen alphanumeric characters  
Selection:  
Enter the text that appears when all areas sharing the  
same account number are master armed. The  
ACCOUNT IS ON text appears at all keypads  
assigned to these areas, if more than one area has  
the same account number. The ACCOUNT IS ON  
text also appears if only one area in the system is  
used. Refer to the prompts CC# Area Assign and  
Area # Account Is On in Section 2.9.1 Keypad  
(Command Center) Assignment on page 50. When  
all areas in the account are master armed, the Area #  
Is On text is replaced by the ACCOUNT IS ON text if  
the area is armed before all other areas with the  
same account number.  
The user needs the appropriate authority level  
enabled for the L## C Function 128 to 143 in  
Section 2.10 User Interface on page 59, to use the  
custom function.  
Consider the scope of the keypad used to access the  
Custom Function. Each Custom Function is enabled  
in the function menu by M## CC Address 1  
[through 8] (refer to M## CC Address 1 [through  
16] on page 78). If the Custom Function is not  
assigned to a specific keypad address, it does not  
appear in the menu.  
Area # Name Text  
Blank Entry  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Sixteen alphanumeric characters  
A blank entry disables the ACCOUNT IS ON display  
for this area. An account wide area shows the AREA  
# IS ON text instead of the ACCOUNT IS ON text.  
Selection:  
Enter the text for this area's name. This text only  
displays on the D1260 series keypads.  
Unique ACCOUNT IS ON Text  
Each area can have unique ACCOUNT IS ON text, or  
you can program the same text in each area of the  
account so when all the areas in the account are  
armed, they all show the same text.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 58  
Custom Function  
Figure 3: Softkey Locations on the D1260  
Keypad  
Default:  
128  
Selection:  
128 to 143  
Enter the Custom Function number you want to  
program. You can program up to sixteen Custom  
Functions, which are numbered 128 to 143.  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
CF### Text  
8
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection:  
Sixteen alphanumeric characters.  
See Section 2.9.2 Area Text on  
page 56 for valid character entries.  
1
ABC  
JKL  
TUV  
0
DEF  
2
5
8
3
6
9
GHI  
MNO  
4
7
Determines the menu text displayed at the keypad for  
the custom function item. Use this text to represent  
the functions performed by this menu item.  
WXY  
PRS  
#
*
COMMAND  
ENTER  
CF### Key Strokes  
1 - Softkey 1 (C1)  
2 - Softkey 2 (C2)  
3 - Softkey 3 (C3)  
4 - Softkey 4 (C4)  
5 - Softkey 5 (C5)  
6 - Softkey 6 (C6)  
7 - Softkey 7 (C7)  
8 - Softkey 8 (C8)  
Table 22: CF### Key Strokes  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection:  
Up to 32 characters: 0 to 9, A, B, C, D, E  
D1255  
Faceplate  
D1255 Key Label  
Programming Custom Function Keystrokes  
Selection  
0 to 9  
D1260 Key  
0 to 9  
[COMMAND*]  
Find the command you want to execute in the  
User Interface section of the program record  
sheet. Single digit commands must be  
programmed with 9 as the second digit.  
0 to 9  
A
B
[COMMAND]  
[PREV]  
(previous)  
NA  
C
[ESC]  
(escape)  
MENU  
YES  
NA  
Table 23: CF### Custom Function Keystrokes  
D
[NEXT]  
NA  
E
[ENT] {enter}  
[#ENTER]  
(softkey 1)  
(softkey 2)  
(softkey 3)  
(softkey 4)  
(softkey 5)  
(softkey 6)  
(softkey 7)  
(softkey 8)  
Command  
Keystroke  
A19  
C1*  
C2*  
C3*  
C4*  
C5*  
C6*  
C7*  
C8*  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
1 (Master arm area)  
2 (Perimeter instant arm)  
3 (Perimeter delay arm)  
6 (Watch Mode)  
A29  
A39  
A69  
7 (Special alert)  
A79  
8 (Perimeter partial arm)  
9 ( Special alert)  
A89  
A99  
0 (Bypass a point)  
A09  
*
Softkey selections are stored as two keystrokes.  
When CF### Custom Function is programmed  
with P, the corresponding custom function  
number is passcode protected. The CF###  
Custom Function prompt is under User  
The keystrokes simulate any sequence of keystrokes  
the user can perform at a keypad. You can program  
up to 32 keystrokes for each Custom Function.  
Interface > Cmd Center Functions. The passcode  
protected custom function can be added to a  
keypad’s function list by programming its number  
in the Function List > M# Function prompt.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 59  
128 to 143 Enable Custom Function 128  
through 143 (Menu Function only): This  
function determines if a passcode is needed to  
access a Custom Function from the menu list.  
ENTER PASSCODE (or Enter Passcode + Enter  
Key on the D1260) appears when this function is  
passcode protected.  
Custom function cannot be used to  
change time (such as Daylight Saving  
Time). Use Skeds S## Function Codes  
13 and 14 to adjust for Daylight Saving  
Time (refer to S## Custom Function  
prompt in Section 4.2 Schedules (Skeds)  
on page 114.  
Example 1  
If a command within the Custom Function  
is passcode protected, ENTER  
Execute the third function in a keypad menu function  
list:  
PASSCODE appears at the keypad. The  
user must enter a valid passcode before  
proceeding with the rest of the Custom  
Function. If a passcode is not entered  
within 10 sec, the Custom Function times  
out and the display returns to idle text.  
D1255 CDDE  
D1260 C8C7C5  
The custom functions in Example 1 are  
not compatible between keypad types.  
Skeds cannot execute Custom Functions  
that are passcode protected. The D720  
LED keypad does not support Custom  
Functions that are passcode protected.  
Example 2  
Instant master Arm (CMD 11):  
D1255 A11  
Some functions cannot be entered directly  
because they are nested inside a higher-level  
function. To automatically execute these  
functions, you must add the appropriate  
keystrokes.  
D1260 A11  
The custom functions in Example 2 are  
compatible between keypad types.  
For example: The Change Display (COMMAND  
49) function has three sub-functions: Bright  
Display, Dim Display, and Date/Time Display.  
The GV3 control panel series uses  
separate keystrokes to program the  
custom functions that accurately  
represent the two separate user  
interfaces, the D1255 and D1260  
keypads.  
-
-
-
To turn up the display, enter:  
[A][4][9][E]  
To dim the display, enter:  
[A][4][9][D][E]  
To display time and date, enter:  
[A][4][9][B][E]  
Custom functions written for the D1255  
that use the [PREV], [ESC], and [NEXT]  
keys do not work on the D1260.  
Custom Functions can perform several tasks at  
one time. For example:  
Custom function written for the D1260  
that use the softkeys (located on the  
sides of the keypad display) do not work  
when executed from the D1255 keypad.  
To toggle relays 7, 8, and 9 in one Custom  
Function enter:  
[A] [5] [4] [7] [E] [E] [8] [E] [E] [9] [E] [E] [C]  
To add a temporary passcode, enter:  
[A] [5] [6] [3] [0] [E] [E] [9] [8] [7] [E] [E] [D] [E]  
[1] [E] [1] [E] [1] [E] [1] [E] [1] [E] [1] [E] [1] [E]  
[1] [E] [C]  
This adds user 30, passcode 987 with  
authority level 1 in all areas.  
2.10 User Interface  
Define which functions can be used by each of the  
fourteen user authority levels. Each user can be  
assigned the same or different authority level by  
area. The user has rights in the area where the  
keypad is assigned, based on the authority level  
assigned to the user’s passcode for that area.  
To delete the passcode, enter:  
[A] [5] [3] [3] [0] [E] [E] [E] [C]  
When the passcode is entered at the keypad, the  
control panel checks the authority level. The control  
panel executes the function only in areas where the  
passcode has the authority to use the function.  
To program multiple-area Arming or Disarming  
functions, use keystroke sequences including  
COMMAND 50 (Move to Area) and  
COMMAND 1.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 60  
2.10.1 Commands  
Master Arm Delay  
Similar to command initiation used in other Bosch  
Default:  
P
Security Systems, Inc. products, the Commands  
method provides continuity in the arming commands  
across product lines and makes an easy transition for  
dealers using other Bosch Security Systems, Inc.  
products. With commands, the end user presses  
[COMMAND] and then the numeral of the command  
to initiate. For example, [COMMAND][2] arms the  
perimeter of the area. Some prompts can be  
accessed only from a menu. These prompts are  
indicated by (Menu Function only). To access these  
functions, press [MENU], enter the function number,  
and use the [PREV] and [NEXT] keys to scroll  
through the choices.  
Selection:  
-, E, or P  
P
Passcode: Required for all users with  
Master Arm Delay enabled for their  
authority level.  
E
-
Enable: A user does not need a  
passcode to use [COMMAND][1].  
Disable Master Arm Delay cannot be  
accessed in the function menu or  
started with a command even if this  
function is enabled for the user’s  
authority level.  
The D9412GV3/D7412GV3 Program Record Sheet  
(P/N: F01U170809) lists the commands available  
with the system. Command numbers are shown in  
the column labeled Command. If a particular function  
does not have a command number, it can be  
accessed only through the Function List.  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
2
Master Arm Delay [COMMAND][1]  
Use this arming function to master arm disarmed  
areas. If enabled, the following arming choices are  
available to the user with this authority.  
If you plan to use only commands to operate the  
system, and to arm and disarm by entering a  
passcode, you do not need to program Custom  
Function or Function List.  
Master Arm Instant  
Default:  
- (Disabled)  
-, E, or P  
2.10.2 Command Authorization  
Selection:  
Programming choices in this section determine if  
keypad functions are disabled (-), enabled (E), or  
passcode (P) restricted.  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
3
Master Arm  
Instant  
[COMMAND][1][1]  
Table 24: Keypad Programming Choices  
Use this arming function to master arm instant areas  
that are disarmed. Entry and exit delays are not  
provided with this arming function. This causes a  
Perimeter and Interior Delay point to act as an Instant  
point.  
Selection  
Description  
-
Disable the function panel-wide.  
The keypad shows NO  
AUTHORITY if you access the  
function using a command or the  
Function List.  
For SIA CP-01 Compliance  
E
P
Enable the function panel-wide.  
The function can be executed  
without entering a passcode.  
Passcode required. When the  
passcode is entered at the  
This feature is not allowed to be used  
with SIA CP-01 compliant installations.  
keypad, the control panel checks  
the user’s authority level. Refer to  
Section 2.10.6 Authority Level  
Selections on page 66.  
Perimeter Instant  
Default:  
- (Disabled)  
-, E, or P  
Selection:  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
Refer to Section 2.10.6 Authority Level  
Selections on page 66 for a detailed  
description of the functions on the  
following pages. These parameters  
determine only if the authority level  
functions are passcode protected.  
4
Perimeter Instant  
Arm  
[COMMAND][2]  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 61  
Instant arms all perimeter points with point response  
that starts an instant alarm (refer to P## Pt  
Use this function to arm normal perimeter points and  
force-bypass faulted perimeter points, regardless of  
their P## Bypassable setting. When these force-  
bypassed perimeter points return to normal, they  
automatically return to service, even if P## FA  
Returnable is set to No.  
Response in Section 3.2 Point Responses on page  
91) in the area where the keypad is assigned. Entry  
and exit delays are not provided with this arming  
function. This function causes a Perimeter Delay  
point to act as a Perimeter Instant point.  
Perimeter Partial arming has entry and exit delays.  
For SIA CP-01 Compliance  
Perimeter Partial ignores the A# Force  
Arm/Bypass Max entry in Section 2.8  
Area Parameters on page 36.  
This feature is not allowed in SIA CP-01  
compliant installations.  
Local Only Reporting: No Closing  
Report is sent to the central station, but a  
Perimeter Delay Closing Event is  
generated in the event log.  
Perimeter Delay  
Default:  
P
Selection:  
-, E, or P  
View Area Stat  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
Default:  
P
5
Perimeter Delay  
Arm  
[COMMAND][3]  
Selection: -, E, or P  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
Delay arms all Perimeter points in the area where the  
keypad is assigned. Entry and exit delays are  
provided with this Arming function. This function does  
not cause a Perimeter Instant point to act as a Delay  
point.  
8
View Area Status (Menu function  
only)  
Use this function to view the armed status of all areas  
within the scope of the keypad assigned to this area.  
The armed states include A# AREA # IS OFF  
(disarmed), A# AREA # IS ON (master delay armed),  
ALL ON INSTANT (master instant armed), and AREA  
# PERIMETER ON (perimeter instant armed or  
perimeter delay armed). All area types, master,  
associate, regular, and shared can be viewed using  
this function.  
Watch Mode  
Default:  
E
Selection:  
-, E, or P  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
6
Watch Mode  
[COMMAND][6]  
This function informs you when a perimeter point or  
interior point that is programmed as P## Watch  
Point is faulted while the area is disarmed. Interior  
points do not emit a Watch Tone if the area is  
perimeter armed. This function provides keypad  
audible or visual and optional relay activation (refer to  
A # Watch Mode in Section 2.12.1 Area Relays on  
page 79).  
Perimeter Partial  
Default:  
P
Selection:  
-, E, or P  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
7
Perimeter Partial  
Arm  
[COMMAND][8]  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 62  
View Memory  
Send Report  
Default:  
E
Default:  
P
Selection:  
Selection:  
-, E, or P  
-, E, or P  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
9
View Event  
Memory  
[COMMAND][4][0]  
13  
Send Report  
[COMMAND][4][1]  
or  
[COMMAND][4][2]  
Use this function to view prior alarm, trouble, and  
supervisory activity occurring since the last time the  
system armed. Event memory is not cleared until the  
area re-arms.  
Use this function to test the communication link  
between the control panel and the central station  
receiver(s). It can send a Test Report or a Status  
Report to the phone numbers programmed in  
Routing. The Test Report includes additional  
information if Expand Test Report is enabled in  
Section 2.1 Phone on page 12.  
View Point Status  
Default:  
E
Selection:  
-, E, or P  
2.10.3 Access Control Functions  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
Door Control  
10  
View Point Status (Menu function  
only)  
Default:  
P
Selection:  
-, E, or P  
Use this function to view points assigned to the area  
where the keypad is assigned. This function shows  
point text and the electrical condition (normal, open,  
short, and missing) of each point in the area.  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
14  
Door Control  
[COMMAND][4][6]  
#14 Door Control [COMMAND][4][6])  
Walk Test  
This top level display must be enabled for the user to  
access the cycle door, unlock door, and secure door  
functions (refer to Section 2.10.6 Authority Level  
Selections on page 66). Use this item when  
Default:  
E
Selection:  
-, E, or P  
programming door control in your function menu.  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
Access Ctl Level  
11  
Walk Test  
[COMMAND][4][4]  
Use this function to test Controlled points in areas  
within the keypad’s scope without sending reports to  
the central station. 24-hour points cannot be tested  
using this Walk Test Mode.  
Default:  
P
Selection:  
-, E, or P  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
Fire Test  
37  
Access Control  
Levels  
(Menu function  
only)  
Default:  
P
Shows the current on or off state of control levels 1  
through 14, pertaining to Access Control Only, (L##  
Access Level and L## Disarm Level). The user can  
toggle levels on and off and invalidate access control  
levels during an extended period. This change only  
affects the user’s token or cards; it does not affect  
keypad Door Control functions.  
Selection:  
-, E, or P  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
12  
Fire Test  
[COMMAND][5][8]  
Use this function to test 24-hour points in areas within  
the scope of the keypad where the function is  
entered. Controlled points, P## Type 1, 2, 3, cannot  
be tested using the Fire Walk Test Mode.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 63  
Change Display  
Add User  
Default:  
E
Default:  
P
Selection:  
Selection:  
-, E, or P  
-, E, or P  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
15  
Change Display  
[COMMAND][4][9]  
18  
Add User  
[COMMAND][5][6]  
Use this function to select either a bright or dim  
display with loud or soft keypad warning tones. You  
can also choose the time and date display.  
Use this function to add or change passcodes, add or  
change tokens or cards and Sub-users, and add or  
change control panel authority levels (L##) by area.  
Change Time/Date  
Del User  
Default:  
E
Default:  
P
Selection:  
-, E, or P  
Selection:  
-, E, or P  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
16  
Change Time  
and Date  
[COMMAND][4][5]  
19  
Delete User  
[COMMAND][5][3]  
Use this function to delete a user’s passcode and  
tokens or cards. It does not delete user names.  
Use this function to set the time and date in the  
control panel.  
This function deletes the passcode,  
master user, and all sub-users  
associated with the user number.  
Change Passcode  
Default:  
P
Selection:  
-, E, or P  
Extend Close  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
Default:  
P
17  
Change  
Passcodes  
[COMMAND][5][5]  
Selection:  
-, E, or P  
Use this function to change your passcode. This is a  
panel-wide function that can be executed from any  
keypad assigned to an area where the user has  
authority.  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
20  
Extend Close  
[COMMAND][5][1]  
Use this function to change the expected closing time  
for the area. The window cannot be adjusted until the  
Close Early Begin time passes and the Closing  
Window is active.  
Refer to Section 2.10.6 Authority Level  
Selections on page 66 for a detailed  
description of the functions on the  
following pages. These parameters  
determine only if the authority level  
functions are passcode protected.  
Regardless of whether an E or a P is  
entered when a COMMAND 55 is  
performed, the keypad asks for the user’s  
current passcode first.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 64  
View Log  
User Cmd 9  
Default:  
E
Default:  
P
Selection:  
Selection:  
-, E, or P  
-, E, or P  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
21  
View Log  
(Menu function  
only)  
24  
User COMMAND [COMMAND][9]  
9
Use this function to activate an alarm programmed in  
COMMAND 9 in the POINTS > Command 7 /  
Command 9 section.  
Use this function to view all of the system events,  
their time stamps, User IDs, or point numbers. User  
Name and Point Text are not stored in the event log,  
but they appear when the control panel matches  
them with the User ID ### and the Point ###.  
Bypass a Point  
Each event appears on one line in the log. Any  
information related to that event appears on a  
separate line in the log.  
Default:  
P
Selection:  
-, E, or P  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
Because events in the log are not uniform in length,  
the control panel can store from 500 to 1000 events.  
25  
Bypass a Point  
[COMMAND][0]  
Print Log  
Use this function to bypass individual points that have  
P## Bypassable enabled. Points within the scope of  
the keypad can be bypassed where the function is  
entered (refer to Section 2.9.1 Keypad (Command  
Center) Assignment) on page 50.  
Default:  
P
Selection:  
-, E, or P  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
The control panel ignores alarms and troubles, and  
does not display point faults when a point is  
bypassed.  
22  
Print Event Log  
(Menu function  
only)  
Unbypass a Point  
Use this function to print all the events stored in the  
control panel beginning at the start date and ending  
with the last event in the log.  
Default:  
P
Selection:  
-, E, or P  
User Cmd 7  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
Default:  
P
26  
Unbypass a Point [COMMAND][0][0]  
Selection:  
-, E, or P  
Use this function to unbypass individual points that  
are programmed either P## Force Arm Returnable  
or P## Bypass Returnable. Points within the scope  
of the keypad can be unbypassed where the function  
is entered (refer to Section 2.9.1 Keypad (Command  
Center) Assignment) on page 50. The control panel  
responds to alarms and troubles, and displays point  
faults when a point is unbypassed.  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
23  
User COMMAND [COMMAND][7]  
7
Use this function to activate an alarm programmed in  
COMMAND 7 in the POINTS > Command 7 /  
Command 9 section.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 65  
Reset Sensors  
Move to Area  
Default:  
E
Default:  
P
Selection:  
Selection:  
-, E, or P  
-, E, or P  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
27  
Reset Sensors  
[COMMAND][4][7]  
30  
Move to Area  
[COMMAND][5][0]  
Use this function to activate the Reset Sensors  
function for Fire or Intrusion points programmed as  
P## Resettable in Section 3.1 Point Index on page  
100. Points within the scope of the keypad where the  
function is entered reset. Refer to Section 2.9.1  
Keypad (Command Center) Assignment on page 50.  
Use this function to switch the keypad’s assignment  
temporarily to a different area. This command can be  
used to perform any function that can be performed  
by a keypad assigned to the area in programming.  
Users are limited to performing functions enabled by  
the authority level they have in the area to which the  
keypad is moved. After 15 sec of no activity at the  
keypad, the keypad reverts back to the originally  
programmed area.  
Change Relay  
Default:  
P
Selection:  
Display Rev  
-, E, or P  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
Default:  
E
Selection:  
-, E, or P  
28  
Change Relays  
[COMMAND][5][4]  
Use this function to manually set and reset Relays 1  
through 128 (1 through 64 in a D7412GV3) that are  
installed in the system.  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
32  
Display Software  
Revision  
[COMMAND][5][9]  
Remote Program  
Use this function to show the control panel’s software  
revision number in the keypad display.  
Default:  
P
Service Walk  
Selection:  
-, E, or P  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
Default:  
P
Selection:  
-, E, or P  
29  
Remote  
[COMMAND][4][3]  
Programming  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
Use this function to start remote programming  
software (RPS) sessions. When the phone is ringing  
at the control panel, starting this function causes the  
control panel to seize the line.  
33  
Service Walk  
Test  
(Menu function  
only)  
Use this function to Walk Test all 246 points in the  
entire control panel regardless of the P## Type.  
The Service Walk Test is available on the  
D9412GV3 using the Service Menu  
[9][9][ENT]. The D7412GV3 does not  
include the Service Walk Test in the  
Service Menu. In the D7412GV3, the  
Service Walk Test function must be  
enabled in the Function List to access the  
Service Walk Test.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 66  
2.10.4 Custom Functions  
Default Text  
C Function 128 [through 143]  
Default:  
P
Default:  
E
Selection:  
-, E, or P  
Selection:  
-, E, or P  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
34  
Default Text  
[COMMAND][5][7]  
Determining the armed state of an area using the  
programmed custom text might be difficult. Use this  
function to switch temporarily to the control panel  
default text, shown on the program record sheet.  
128 through  
143  
Enable Custom  
Functions 128  
through 143  
(Menu function  
only)  
When enabled, Custom Function determines if a  
passcode is required when accessing a custom  
function from the menu list. ENTER PASSCODE (or  
Enter Passcode + Enter Key on the D1260) appears  
when this function is passcode protected. If a  
Change Skeds  
Default:  
P
Selection:  
command within the Custom Function is passcode  
protected, the keypad displays ENTER PASSCODE  
(or Enter Passcode + Enter Key on the D1260) and  
waits for the user to enter a valid passcode before  
proceeding with the rest of the Custom Function. If a  
passcode is not entered within 10 sec, the Custom  
Function times out and the display returns to idle text.  
-, E, or P  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
35  
Change Skeds  
[COMMAND][5][2]  
Execute this panel-wide function from any keypad  
assigned to an area where the user has authority.  
Use this function to change the S## Time from the  
keypad to make adjustments to Skeds.  
2.10.5 Configuration Authority  
Keypad Programming  
Invisible Walk Test  
Default:  
P
Default:  
P
Selection:  
- or P  
Selection:  
-, E, or P  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
N/A  
Keypad  
Programming  
Service Menu only  
36  
Invisible Walk Test  
(Menu function only)  
Use this function to make system programming  
changes. When enabled, only the Service User  
(Authority Level 15) has authority to access this  
menu. When disabled (set to -), the programming  
menu cannot be accessed through the Service User  
menu.  
This function allows a user with the L## Invisible  
Walk Test authority to test invisible interior or  
perimeter controlled points that are within the scope  
of the keypad, without sending reports to the central  
station. Invisible points must have the P## Invisible  
Point function programmed Yes.  
If at least one area is armed or the control  
panel is communicating with RPS, you  
cannot access keypad programming.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 67  
Keypad Programming of the Keypad Programming  
Option  
Table 25: Authority Level Selections  
D1255  
Authority  
Level  
Description  
1. Refer to Figure 1 on page 7 to access Keypad  
Programming and navigate to the DISABLE KP  
PROG option. Press [ENT].  
2. The current keypad programming configuration  
shows (for example, ALLOWED: YES).  
3. Press [ENT] to change the configuration. The  
keypad reads PRG ALLOWED: followed by YES  
or NO.  
-
Disabled: This function is not  
authorized for the user who is  
assigned this authority level.  
Enabled: This function is  
authorized for the user who is  
assigned this authority level.  
E
4. Press [NEXT] or [PREV] to toggle to YES to allow  
keypad programming or No to disable keypad  
programming, and then press [ENT] to save the  
changes.  
Authority Level  
Default:  
1
When the keypad reads PARAMETER SAVED, your  
selection has been configured.  
Selection:  
1 to 14  
You can continue using the current  
programming session. Keypad  
programming is disabled once you exit  
the current session.  
Enter the number of the authority level you want to  
program. Authority Level 15 (Service Passcode)  
cannot be edited.  
To determine the L## default values on  
pages 67 through 76, refer to the User  
Interface section in the program record  
sheet.  
D1260  
1. Refer to Figure 2 on page 8 to access Keypad  
Programming and navigate to the Disable  
Keypad Prog option.  
L## Disarm  
2. The current keypad programming configuration  
shows (for example, Keypad Programming  
Allowed: Yes).  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection: - or E  
3. Press the Edit softkey to change the area’s  
status.  
4. Press the Yes or No softkey, and then press the  
Save softkey to save the changes.  
5. Press the Save softkey to save the changes.  
6. When the keypad reads Parameter Saved, your  
selection has been configured.  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Disarm  
1
Use the disarming function to disarm areas that are  
master armed or perimeter armed. If enabled, the  
following disarming choices are available to the user  
with this authority:  
You can continue using the current  
programming session. Keypad  
programming is disabled once you exit  
the current session.  
DISARM ALL: Disarms all areas within the CC#  
Scope of the keypad being used by accessing  
the Function Menu and the authority level of the  
user performing the function.  
2.10.6 Authority Level Selections  
DISARM AREA: Disarms only the displayed  
area.  
Use Section 2.10.6 Authority Level Selections on  
page 66 to determine which Authority Level can  
access keypad functions that are passcode  
protected. Selecting Enable items in the Authority  
Level section is not necessary if the keypad function  
is disabled or enabled. Each individual function has  
two selections you can use for the authority level you  
are programming.  
Many options are available for arming  
and disarming. Selecting an option  
depends on A# Area Type and CC#  
Scope. Read the definitions of area type  
in Section 2.8 Area Parameters on page  
5 and CC# Scope in Section 2.9.1  
Keypad (Command Center) Assignment  
on page 50.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 68  
L## Perimeter Delay  
L## Master Arm Delay  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
- or E  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
- or E  
Selection:  
Selection:  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
5
Perimeter Delay  
Arm  
[COMMAND][3]  
2
Master Arm  
Delay  
[COMMAND][1]  
Delay arm all Perimeter Delay point responses only  
in the area where the keypad is assigned.  
Master arms areas based on the CC# Scope of the  
keypad using an exit delay time.  
When this item is accessed through the Function List,  
Master Arm All allows the user to arm all areas  
according to the authority level of the user and within  
the CC# Scope of the keypad using an exit delay  
time.  
L## Watch Mode  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
- or E  
Selection:  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
Arm Area arms only the area displayed. If  
COMMAND 1 is used, it arms only the area where  
the keypad is assigned.  
6
Watch Mode  
[COMMAND][6]  
Initiate the Watch Mode in the area to which this  
keypad is assigned.  
L## Master Arm Instant  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
L## Perimeter Partial  
Selection: - or E  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
- or E  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
Selection:  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
3
Master Arm  
Instant  
[COMMAND][1][1]  
7
Perimeter Partial  
Arm  
[COMMAND][8]  
This authority level permission allows a user to  
execute the Master Arm Instant function. Refer to  
Master Arm Instant on page 60.  
Partially arms only the area where the keypad is  
assigned.  
Arm Area arms only the area to which the keypad is  
assigned.  
This function ignores the A# Force  
Arm/Bypass Max entry in Area  
Parameters.  
If COMMAND 11 is used, it arms only the area where  
the keypad is assigned.  
Use COMMAND 11 carefully because all  
Perimeter and Interior points become  
Instant Armed.  
Local Only Reporting: No Closing  
Report is sent to the central station, but a  
Perimeter Delay Closing Event is  
generated in the event log.  
L## Perimeter Instant  
L## View Area Stat  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection: - or E  
Selection: - or E  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
4
Perimeter Instant [COMMAND][2]  
Arm  
8
View Area Status (Menu function  
only)  
Instant arm all Perimeter points, including Delayed  
points, only in the area where the keypad is  
assigned.  
View the current arm or disarm status and the not  
ready to arm status of all areas within the scope of  
the keypad in this area. The user needs arming and  
disarming authority.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 69  
If enabled in Routing, Walk Start and Walk End  
Reports are sent to the central station receiver at  
the beginning and end of the test.  
L## View Memory  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection: - or E  
To Walk Test a Door point connected to a  
D9210B Access Interface Module, open  
the door without activating the door  
sequence or allowing it to time out past  
the extended shunt time.  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
9
View Event  
Memory  
[COMMAND][4][0]  
View all memory events that occurred since the last  
time the system was armed for all areas within the  
scope of the keypad in this area.  
L## Fire Test  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection: - or E  
L## View Point Status  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection: - or E  
12  
Fire Test  
[COMMAND][5][8]  
Fire Walk Test all 24-hour points in the area where  
this keypad is assigned.  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
10  
View Point Status (Menu function  
only)  
One person can perform a Fire Walk Test without  
assistance. The following features come with the Fire  
Test Mode:  
View the current status of all points in the area to  
which this keypad is assigned.  
Battery powered control panel only. A Battery  
Test runs during the whole test to ensure that the  
battery capacity is capable of supporting the full  
load of the control panel if AC fails.  
L## Walk Test  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
- or E  
-
This test includes a 2-sec Bell Test (Fire Bell  
relay) for each Fire point that is tested.  
Selection:  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
-
The test ends when all points are tested or  
the test times out after 20 min of no activity.  
11  
Walk Test  
[COMMAND][4][4]  
Local alarm annunciation and event printing; no  
reports are sent to the central station receiver.  
Walk Test all Interior or Perimeter Controlled points in  
the area to which this keypad is assigned.  
Automatic smoke detectors reset for all Fire  
points programmed with P## Resettable as Yes.  
The following features come with the Walk Test  
Mode:  
D1255 Keypad displays a sequential count and  
the text for the point after each point is activated  
and restored.  
Battery powered control panel only. A Battery  
Test runs during the whole test to ensure that the  
battery capacity is capable of supporting the full  
load of the control panel if AC fails.  
If enabled in Routing, Walk Start and Walk End  
Reports are sent to the central station receiver at  
the beginning and end of the test.  
-
This test includes 2-sec Bell Test when the  
Walk Test starts.  
A# Verify Time for Fire points that is  
programmed with Yes for P## Alarm  
Verify is ignored during the Fire Walk  
Test.  
-
The test ends when all points are tested or  
the test times out after 20 min of no activity.  
Local alarm annunciation and event printing; no  
reports are sent to the central station receiver.  
D1255 Keypad displays a sequential count, and  
text after each point is activated and restored.  
The keypad displays ALL PTS TESTED and an  
All Points Tested Event is sent to the central  
station receiver (if programmed) when the last  
point is tested.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 70  
Default: Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection: - or E  
L## Send Report  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection:  
- or E  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Cycle Door  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
(None)  
(Menu function  
only)  
13  
Send Report  
[COMMAND][4][1]  
or  
[COMMAND][4][2]  
Cycle Door (Menu Function only)  
Send a Test Report from any keypad assigned to an  
area where the user has authority.  
To cycle the doors, press number [1] through [8] on  
the keypad, corresponding to the door number. For  
example, pressing [2] and [ENTER] cycles door  
number 2, which is indicated by C in the display.  
Refer to “Cycle Door” in Table 26 on page 71.  
Access Control Functions  
Use the following functions to control the doors from  
the keypad. Users can have authority to access the  
Door Control and can use all or part of the functions  
within.  
Cycle Door allows the user with this authority level to  
access the CYCLE? 12345678 function.  
All doors display when this function is  
selected. This function does not follow  
the scope of the keypad.  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection: - or E  
L## Door Control  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Unlock Door  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
(None)  
(Menu function  
only)  
Selection: - or E  
To unlock or relock a door, press number [1] through  
[8] on the keypad, corresponding to the door number  
(refer to “Unlock Door” in Table 26 on page 71). For  
example, pressing [2] and [ENTER] unlocks door  
number 2. The display indicates “U’ (for unlock door)  
with the door number. Select the same door number  
again and press [Enter] to relock the door.  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Door Control  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
14  
[COMMAND][4][6]  
This item only allows programming access to the  
following three sub-prompts. It does not affect the  
user’s access to Cycle Door, Unlock Door, and  
Secure Door.  
Unlock Door allows the user with this authority level  
to access the UNLOCK? 12345678 function.  
Cycle Door, Unlock Door, and Secure  
Door cannot be accessed through the  
Function List. Door Control must be  
added to the Function List to access the  
door control functions, or COMMAND 46  
can be used.  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
- or E  
Selection:  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
The following prompts are sub-functions of Door  
Control.  
(None)  
Secure Door  
(Menu function  
only)  
Cycle Door must be enabled for all three  
sub-functions to operate. If Cycle Door is  
disabled, all three sub-functions do not  
operate.  
Press number [1] through [8] on the keypad,  
corresponding to the door number to secure or  
unsecure a door (refer to “Secure Door” in Table 26  
on page 71).For example, pressing [2] and [ENTER]  
secures door number 2, which is indicated by an X in  
the display.  
Secure Door allows the user with this authority level  
to access the SECURE? 12345678 function.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 71  
L## Access Control Level  
Table 26: L## Secure Door-Door Mode  
Definitions  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
- or E  
Selection:  
Door State Definition  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
Lock Door  
Normal Door: When a door is in the  
Lock Door state, one can initiate the  
door sequence using Skeds, CYCLE  
DOOR?, keypad functions, door  
requests, and valid token or card  
requests.  
No Access Allowed: When a door is  
in the Secure Door state, no access  
is allowed through the door until it is  
returned to the Lock Door state. The  
Secure Door state includes Sked and  
keypad functions.  
37  
Access Control  
Levels  
(Menu function  
only)  
Changing the Access Control Level in  
any area affects all users and all doors  
associated with that level for all areas.  
Secure  
Door  
General Functions  
L## Change Display  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Unlock  
Door  
Free Access: When a door is in the  
Unlocked Door state, the door is  
already shunted and the door strike  
does not prevent the door from  
opening. In this state, the user does  
not need to activate a door request or  
present a valid token or card.  
Selection:  
- or E  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
15  
Change Display  
[COMMAND][4][9]  
Change the display (bright display, dim display, and  
time display) in the area where this keypad is  
assigned.  
Cycle Door Momentary Access: This is a  
temporary Door Mode in which the  
door initiates the door sequence as if  
a valid token or card was read. This  
state occurs using the keypad and  
remote programming software (RPS).  
A sked cannot activate this state.  
L## Change Time/Date  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
- or E  
Selection:  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
16  
Change Time  
and Date  
[COMMAND][4][5]  
Change the date and time for the control panel in this  
area.  
L## Change Passcode  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
- or E  
Selection:  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
17  
Change  
[COMMAND][5][5]  
Passcodes  
Change a user passcode.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 72  
L## Add User  
L## View Log  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
- or E  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
- or E  
Selection:  
Selection:  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
18  
Add User  
[COMMAND][5][6]  
21  
View Log  
(Menu function  
only)  
Add or change users, add or change authority levels,  
add or change tokens or cards.  
View all panel-wide events in the control panel’s  
memory log.  
9210 NOT READY appears if a door  
controller is not assigned to the keypad  
used to add or change tokens or cards.  
Refer to CC# Assign Door in Section  
2.9.1 Keypad (Command Center)  
Assignment on page 53.  
L## Print Log  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection: - or E  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Print Event Log  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
L## Del User  
22  
(Menu function  
only)  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection: - or E  
Print all panel-wide events from the log to the printer  
in the area where the user is executing this function.  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Delete User  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
This item can also be accessed using the  
Service Menu ([9][9][ENT]).  
19  
[COMMAND][5][3]  
Delete users.  
Although an individual user (001 through  
249) can be deleted separately, use  
caution with this function. User  
L## User Cmd 7  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
passcodes, tokens or cards cannot be  
deleted individually within a group. (For  
example, User 001 has three additional  
sub-users that use the same authority  
levels for that group.) When dealing with  
an individual user, change that user’s  
token or passcode so that other users in  
the group do not need to be added again.  
Selection: - or E  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
23  
User Command 7 [COMMAND][7]  
This command can be used in Function Menu.  
Generate the alarm programmed at COMMAND 7 in  
the POINTS > Command 7 / Command 9 section..  
L## Extend Close  
L## User Cmd 9  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
- or E  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection:  
Selection: - or E  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
20  
Extend Close  
[COMMAND][5][1]  
24  
User Command 9 [COMMAND][9]  
Change the closing time in the area where the  
function is entered.  
This command can be used in Function Menu.  
Generate the alarm programmed at COMMAND 9 in  
the POINTS > Command 7 / Command 9 section.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 73  
L## Bypass a Point  
L## Move to Area  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection: - or E  
Selection: - or E  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Bypass a Point  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
25  
[COMMAND][0]  
30  
Move to Area  
[COMMAND][5][0]  
Bypass points with this authority level.  
Temporarily switch to a different area and perform  
keypad functions related to that area.  
L## Unbypass a Point  
L## Display Rev  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection: - or E  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection: - or E  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
26  
Unbypass a Point [COMMAND][0][0]  
Unbypass points with this authority level.  
32  
Display Software  
Revision  
[COMMAND][5][9]  
L## Reset Sensors  
Display the control panel model name and software  
revision. For example:  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
9412GV3 REV ##.##  
Selection: - or E  
L## Service Walk  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
27  
Reset Sensors  
[COMMAND][4][7]  
Selection: - or E  
Reset sensors with this authority level.  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
L## Change Relay  
33  
Service Walk  
Test  
(Menu function  
only)  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection: - or E  
Start a Service Walk Test for all 24-hour Interior or  
Perimeter Controlled points in the control panel.  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
Points are not included in this test if:  
28  
Change Relays  
[COMMAND][5][4]  
Points are in an area that is already in a Walk  
Test Mode.  
Manually activate or reset a system relay.  
Do not use the Change Relays function  
to toggle relays reserved for special  
functions. Special function relays are  
Area and Panel Wide Relay functions as  
well as relays assigned to CC# Enter  
Key Relay?  
Points are assigned to an area that is not  
enabled A# Area On.  
Points are in an area that is Master or Perimeter  
armed.  
When a Service Walk Test is initiated, one person  
can test all the points in the control panel without  
assistance. The following features are provided with  
the Service Test Mode:  
L## Remote Program  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Display indicates exactly how many points can be  
tested.  
Selection: - or E  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Battery and bell tests do not occur during this  
Walk Test.  
Keystroke  
29  
Remote  
[COMMAND][4][3]  
The test ends when all points are tested or the  
test times out after 20 min of inactivity.  
Programming  
Start a remote programming software (RPS) session  
when the phone rings at the control panel.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 74  
Events print locally without alarm annunciation or  
reporting to the central station receiver.  
L## Invisible Walk Test  
D1255 Keypad displays a sequential count and  
the text for the point after each point is activated  
and restored.  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
-, or E  
Selection:  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
The D1255 Keypad displays ALL PNTS  
TESTED.  
36  
Invisible Walk Test  
(Menu function only)  
If enabled in Routing, Service Start and Service  
End are reported at the central station receiver  
for the beginning and end of the test.  
Test all points that are programmed to be invisible  
and that are within the scope of the keypad without  
sending reports to the central station. Invisible points  
must be programmed P## Invisible Point as Yes.  
This walk test mode can test 24-hour points and  
controlled points.  
Point 128 and Point 248 appear as missing. This is  
normal. These points are used for supervising the  
Zonex 1 bus (Point 128) and Zonex 2 bus (Point  
248). If the Zonex bus has a fault, these points  
indicate a short.  
Invisible Test? allows the user with this L## to start  
an invisible walk test for all 24-hour interior and  
posterior controlled points in the area to which this  
keypad is assigned. When an invisible test is started,  
one person can test invisible points without  
assistance.  
This function allows viewing of extra points. Extra  
points occur under two conditions: an extra point is  
wired electrically to the Zonex bus with P### Point  
Index set to 0, or two Zonex devices exist for the  
same Zonex address.  
The following features are provided with the Invisible  
Test Mode:  
L## Default Text  
The display indicates exactly how many invisible  
points are assigned to the area.  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection: - or E  
Battery and bell tests do not occur during this  
walk test.  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Default Text  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
The keypad shows point text when invisible  
points are tested.  
34  
[COMMAND][5][7]  
Temporarily show the armed state of the area using  
control panel default text, A# AREA # IS ON, A# NOT  
READY, A# AREA # IS OFF, and A# ACCOUNT IS  
ON.  
The test ends when all points are tested, or if the  
test times out after 10 min of no activity.  
Local event printing occurs without alarm  
annunciation or reports sent to the central station  
receiver.  
L## Change Skeds  
The D1255 Keypad shows a sequential count  
and text related to the point after each point is  
activated and restored.  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection: - or E  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Change Skeds  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
The keypad shows All PTS TESTED. An All  
Points Tested Event is sent to the central station  
receiver (if programmed) when the last point is  
tested.  
35  
[COMMAND][5][2]  
Change skeds that can be edited.  
Walk Start and Walk End Reports are sent to the  
central station receiver for the beginning and end  
of the test (if programmed in phone routing).  
Editing of skeds can be restricted by  
programming S## Time Edit? to No.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 75  
Custom Functions  
L## Send Duress  
L## C Function 128 [through 143]  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection: - or E  
Selection: - or E  
Generates a Duress Report if the area where this  
authority level is assigned sends duress. (Refer to  
the A# Duress Enable prompt on page 39 in Section  
2.8.4 Open/Close Options.)  
Function  
No.  
Function Name  
Alternate  
Keystroke  
128 through  
143  
Enable Custom  
Function 128  
through 143  
(Menu function  
only)  
L## Passcode Arm  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Execute the desired Custom Function.  
Selection: - or E  
Report Levels  
Arm an area by entering a passcode and pressing  
[ENTER].  
L## Force Arm  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
L## Passcode Disarm  
Selection: - or E  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
A user with this authority level can Force Arm.  
Selection: - or E  
L## Area O/C  
Disarm an area by entering a passcode and pressing  
[ENTER].  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
2.10.7 Access Control Levels  
Selection: - or E  
Generates Opening and Closing Reports if the area  
where this authority level is assigned sends Opening  
and Closing Reports.  
L## Security Level  
Default:  
Selection:  
M
Refer to the program record sheet  
M, P, D, or -  
L## Restricted O/C  
Users have access rights for this  
area when the area is in any armed  
state.  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection: - or E  
P
Users have access rights for this  
area when the area is Perimeter  
Armed or Disarmed but not while the  
area is Master Armed.  
Generates an Opening Report if a bell is ringing or a  
Closing Report when force or bypass arming. The  
area where this authority level is assigned must be  
programmed for restricted openings and closings  
(refer to the A# Restrictd O/C prompt in Section  
2.8.4 Open/Close Options on page 43.  
D
-
Users have access rights for this  
area only while it is disarmed.  
L## Perimeter O/C  
Users do not have access rights to  
this area.  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Security Level [TOKEN FUNCTION]  
Selection: - or E  
When the user presents a token or card at the  
reader, access is granted only when the user has the  
authority to enter the area under certain armed  
conditions.  
Generates Perimeter Opening and Closing Reports if  
the area where this authority level is assigned sends  
Perimeter Opening and Closing Reports. Refer to the  
A# Perimeter O/C prompt on page 47 in Section  
2.8.4 Open/Close Options.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 76  
L## Disarm Level  
L## Function Level  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
I, D, or -  
Default:  
Selection:  
M
Refer to the program record sheet  
M, D, C, or -  
Selection:  
I
Users change the Master Armed  
state and Perimeter Armed state to  
Perimeter Instant. The armed state  
does not change in other areas, and  
the armed state does not change if  
the area is already in the perimeter  
instant or disarmed state. User  
needs access level for Master  
Armed (M) state.  
Activate the custom function  
assigned to the door in this area  
while the area is Master Armed or  
Disarmed only.  
D
C
Activate the custom function  
assigned to the door in this area  
while the area is Disarmed only.  
User can activate the custom  
function assigned to the door in this  
area while the area is Master Armed,  
Perimeter Armed or Disarmed.  
D
Users change the local area’s  
Master Armed state and Perimeter  
Armed state to the Disarm state.  
User needs access level for Master  
Armed (M) or Perimeter Armed (P)  
state. All areas within the scope of  
the keypad assigned to the D# CC#  
Scope in the access handler, and  
areas to which the user has disarm  
rights, disarm as programmed.  
-
User cannot activate the custom  
function assigned to the door in this  
area.  
When a token or card can also disarm an  
area, the custom function starts after the  
area disarms.  
-
Users do not have disarm rights in  
this area.  
A user does not require L## Security  
Level or L## Disarm Level authority to  
activate a custom function with a token or  
card.  
Burglar bells are silenced in the local area  
when a user disarms with a token or card  
or presents the token or card during an  
alarm. The user must use a passcode to  
silence a Fire Bell. Cancel Reports are  
sent after a valid passcode or token or  
card silences the bell.  
Tokens or cards that are used to execute  
Custom Functions must have a passcode  
assigned to the corresponding User###.  
Opening and Closing Reports are sent to  
the central station receiver if programmed.  
For more information on programming  
this prompt for a shared area, refer to  
Access Control Readers Assigned to the  
Shared Area in Section 2.8.2 Shared-  
Area Characteristics on page 41.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 77  
2.10.8 SIA Duress Passcode Options  
2.11 Function List  
USER INTERFACEAuthority Levels L##  
The Function List is accessed when the user presses  
[MENU] (or the key corresponding to menu on the  
D1260) while the keypad shows the idle text.  
Program as many as 32 M### Function(s).  
Disarm  
USER INTERFACEAuthority Levels L## Send  
Duress  
Each CC # keypad address can display a  
USER INTERFACEAuthority Levels L##  
combination of any of the 32 menu items. The D1255  
displays one menu item at a time. The D1260  
displays up to two menu items at a time. Each  
keypad address has one Function List. The function  
name shown in the Functions column in the program  
record sheet appears in the keypad display in capital  
letters. For example, WATCH MODE appears when  
you select #6 Watch Mode.  
Passcode Disarm  
General Programming Information  
User Authority Index 14 is programmed by default as  
a duress disarm profile. When Duress Option is  
configured with a value of 3, the SIA CP-01 compliant  
Duress Passcode feature is enabled. With Authority  
Index 14 assigned to a user passcode in an area,  
that user has the authority to disarm and send a  
duress event from that area.  
Menu Item  
A Duress Disarm user authority index requires:  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
L## Disarm set to E  
L## Send Duress set to E  
L## Passcode Disarm set to E  
Selection: 1 to 32  
Enter the menu item number you are programming.  
The M## Function displays items sequentially in the  
order they are programmed. The M1 Function is the  
first function that appears in the menu and M32  
Function is the last function that appears when  
scrolling through the menu.  
For SIA CP-01 Compliance  
Duress Types 1 and 2 (refer to Duress Type on page  
36) are not allowed for use in SIA CP-01 compliant  
installations. All duress-capable passcodes must be  
unique and cannot be derived from other passcodes.  
To facilitate this uniqueness, user Authority Index 14  
is preprogrammed from the factory as an example of  
duress disarm authority.  
Failing to program Menu Item 1 causes  
COMMAND DISABLED to appear in the  
keypad display.  
M## Function  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection: 0 to 30, 32 to 37, and 128 to 143  
(131 on D7412GV3)  
Enter the function number indicated in the “#” column  
of the program record sheet or next to the function in  
Section 2.10 User Interface on page 59.  
Function numbers 128 to 143 are custom  
functions and show the text programmed  
for CF ### Text.  
There is no restriction on how many times  
you can assign a specific function to the  
menu. By assigning a specific function  
more than once, you can assign the same  
function at different keypads so that their  
order is different in different areas.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 78  
Relay Reports: When relay activity is reported to  
the receiver (refer to Section 2.3 Routing on  
page 17), on-board relays are reported as  
follows:  
M## CC Address 1 [through 16]  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection: Yes or No  
A = 253  
B = 254  
C = 255  
Yes  
This menu item appears at this  
keypad address.  
No  
This menu item does not appear at  
this keypad address.  
The others report as 001 to 128. The Relay  
Report is RELAY SET RELAY # rrr when the  
relay is turned on and RELAY RESET RELAY #  
rrr when the relay is turned off. Relay Reports are  
also printed on the local printer and stored in the  
control panel memory log.  
Programming this prompt determines at which CC  
address setting this menu item appears.  
2.12 Relay Parameters  
Relays provide dry contact (normally open or  
normally closed) outputs for LED annunciation and  
other applications as well as wet voltage outputs  
(12 VDC on or off) for basic alarm system functions  
(such as Bell Output or Reset Sensors). The  
applications are endless, but mainly, relays enhance  
a system’s capacity to perform output functions.  
Controlling Relays: Relays can activate  
depending upon conditions that exist with the  
control panel. In addition, the user can control  
relays by using the Change Relay? function,  
Relay On/Relay Off skeds, and the Remote  
Account Manager.  
Before programming your relays:  
Panel-Wide Relays: These relays provide an  
output related to a panel-wide indication. For  
annunciation, these relays can indicate system-  
wide troubles for power and phone. They also  
provide an overall control panel summary of  
alarms, troubles, and supervisory conditions.  
Do not use the CHANGE RELAYS? function to  
toggle relays reserved for special functions.  
Special function relays are Area and Panel Wide  
Relay functions as well as relays assigned to CC  
Enter Key Relay and P## Relay Response  
Type.  
Area Relays: These relays provide an output by  
the area to which the relay is assigned. An area  
can have its own bell and sensor reset  
indications. Relays can also indicate the area  
armed state and whether any off-normal  
conditions, such as a Force Arm, occurred.  
Relay C is always on. Assigning any other relay  
(1 to 128, A or B) deactivates Relay C so this  
output can be used for other functions. When  
Relay C is programmed for A# Rest Sensors,  
power is always supplied from Terminal 8 of the  
control panel.  
On Board Relays: Three on-board 12 VDC  
voltage outputs provide power when activated on  
the control panel. These outputs are programmed  
at the factory as Relays A, B, and C. Typically,  
Relay A (Terminal 6) is used for the bell, Relay B  
(Terminal 7) is used for an alternate alarm output  
(such as another bell), and Relay C (Terminal 8)  
is used for Sensor Reset (Relays B and C require  
the optional D136 Relays).  
Relay Restoration: The status of relays after  
programming or resetting the control panel might  
restore automatically or require manual  
restoration. All relays are turned off after the  
control panel resets. The control panel checks  
certain relay functions every minute and resumes  
the correct state after the reset. Other relays  
must be manually set to the correct state using  
the Change Relay Function (COMMAND 54).  
Off-Board Relays: The D9412GV3 can also  
control 128 (64 for the D7412GV3) dry-contact  
form C relays when up to sixteen optional D8129  
OctoRelay Modules are installed. These relays  
are used for Area Relay, Panel-Wide Relay, and  
Individual Point Fault Relays.  
Relay Follows Point: Relays can also be used  
to activate when a point programmed for P##  
Relay Response Type (refer to P## Relay  
Response Type on page 96) is off-normal or in  
an alarm condition.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 79  
Relay functions that resume the proper state  
A# Fire Bell  
within one minute:  
Default:  
A
Alarm Bell  
Perimeter Fault  
Summary Trouble  
Reset Sensors  
AC Fail  
Summary Fire  
Area Armed  
Fire Bell  
Selection:  
0, 1 to 128 for D9412GV3, 1 to 64  
for D7412GV3, A, B, or C  
This voltage output relay activates and provides  
12 VDC output when a Fire point (P## Fire is Yes)  
assigned to this area activates an alarm.  
Summary Alarm  
Silent Alarm  
Area Fault  
Phone Fail  
Summary SupBurg  
Battery Trouble  
Summary Fire Trouble Communications Fail  
Watch Mode Summary SupFire  
Fire Time and Fire Pattern must be  
programmed in Bell Parameters. This  
relay activates according to the bell  
pattern and remains active until the bell  
time expires. P## Silent Bell must be No  
in order for the bell to ring upon alarm.  
Relay functions that must be reset manually  
with Change Relay function (COMMAND 54):  
Fail To Close  
Duress  
Force Armed  
Log % Full  
2.12.1 Area Relays  
Although Relay C is a valid entry for A#  
Fire Bell, do not program Relay C for this  
entry. Use Relay A for the A# Fire Bell.  
Each area can be assigned a unique relay number  
for each of the events listed in this section.  
A# Alarm Bell  
To meet UL 864 requirements, set A#  
Fire Bell to a value other than 0.  
Default:  
A
Selection:  
0, 1 to 128 for D9412GV3 (1 to 64  
for D7412GV3), A, B, or C  
A# Reset Sensors  
This voltage output relay activates and provides  
12 VDC output when a Non-fire point (P## Fire is  
No) assigned to this area activates an alarm.  
Default:  
C
Selection: 0, 1 to 128 for D9412GV3, 1 to 64  
for D7412GV3,A, B, or C  
A# Burg Time and A# Burg Pattern  
must be programmed in Area or Bell  
Parameters. This relay activates  
according to the bell pattern and remains  
active until the bell time expires or a valid  
passcode is entered. P## Silent Bell  
must be No for the bell to ring upon  
alarm.  
Unlike the default relay for Alarm Bell and Fire Bell,  
this voltage-output relay (Relay C) de-activates for  
5 sec when the Reset Sensors? function is activated  
from the keypad or during a Fire Walk Test.  
The Reset Sensors time converts from  
the  
5 sec default time to the time  
programmed in A# Verify Time (Section  
2.8 Area Parameters on page 5) when a  
point programmed for P## Alarm Verify  
(Section 3.1 Point Index on page 87)  
enters an alarm condition.  
For SIA CP-01 Compliance:  
Do not set A# Alarm Bell to 0. This feature is  
required for SIA CP-01 compliance.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 80  
A# Watch Mode  
Default:  
When sharing one relay to reset sensors  
in two or more areas, you must program  
the following. Failure to do so causes  
TROUBLE PT ### for all point types  
programmed as P## Resettable.  
0
Selection: 0, 1 to 128 for D9412GV3, 1 to 64  
for D7412GV3, A, B, or C  
This relay activates when a Controlled point  
programmed for P## Watch Point is faulted in the  
specified area while the area is in Watch Mode and  
the point is not armed. It remains active for 2 sec  
after each point is faulted.  
CC # Scope must include all areas  
that share the relay.  
L## Reset Sensors authority must be  
assigned to the passcode that  
activates the COMMAND 47 or Reset  
Sensor function.  
A# Area Armed  
A# Verify Time must be the same  
number of seconds for all areas that  
share the relay.  
Default:  
0
Selection: 0, 1 to 128 for D9412GV3, 1 to 64  
for D7412GV3, A, B, or C  
To meet UL 864 requirements, set A#  
Reset Sensors to a value other than 0.  
This relay activates when the specified area becomes  
Master Armed. The exit delay must expire before the  
relay activates. The relay remains active until the  
area disarms. It does not deactivate during the entry  
delay time.  
A# Fail to Close  
Default:  
0
If multiple areas use the same relay, the relay  
activates when all areas are armed. It deactivates  
when the first area disarms.  
Selection: 0, 1 to 128 for D9412GV3, 1 to 64  
for D7412GV3, A, B, or C  
The A# Area Armed relay function can provide visual  
feedback at a key switch station. Attach a LED to the  
output of a D8129 Module programmed for this  
function.  
This relay activates when the Closing Window  
expires for the specified area. It remains active until  
midnight, another Closing Window starts, or the  
control panel resets, whichever occurs first. When  
Perimeter Relay (refer to page 139) is set to Yes,  
the A# Fail to Close prompt becomes A# Perimeter  
Relay.  
A# Area Fault  
Default:  
0
Selection:  
0, 1 to 128 for D9412GV3, 1 to 64  
for D7412GV3, A, B, or C  
A# Force Armed  
Default:  
0
Activates whenever a controlled (P## Type 1, 2, 3  
only) Perimeter or Interior point is faulted. The relay  
remains active until all Perimeter and Interior points  
in the area are normal.  
Selection: 0, 1 to 128 for D9412GV3, 1 to 64  
for D7412GV3, A, B, or C  
This relay activates when this area is Force Armed. It  
remains active until the area disarms or the control  
panel resets.  
Keyswitch area armed status with  
LEDs: Use a D8129 Module and connect  
an LED to indicate that the area is not  
ready to arm.  
If Force Bypassing is required during  
Perimeter Arming, this relay does not  
activate.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 81  
2.12.2 Panel-Wide Relays  
A# Duress Relay  
The following eleven relay options activate when they  
occur anywhere in the control panel. They are not  
restricted by area boundaries.  
Default:  
0
Selection:  
0, 1 to 128 for D9412GV3, 1 to 64  
for D7412GV3, A, B, or C  
AC Failure  
Activates when a Duress alarm is generated from a  
keypad assigned to the specified area.  
Default:  
0
Burg Time needs a bell period  
programmed and A# Duress Enable  
must be Yes. This relay activates when  
the Burg Bell starts and deactivates when  
the Burg Bell time ends. The Burg Bell  
pattern has no effect on this relay  
function.  
Selection: 0, 1 to 128 for D9412GV3, 1 to 64  
for D7412GV3, A, B, or C  
Activates when the control panel responds to an AC  
power failure as programmed in AC Fail Time in  
Section 2.4 Power Supervision on page 29. This  
relay automatically resets when AC power restores.  
Use this relay to create audible  
annunciation. Enable the keypad’s  
trouble sounders for all applications  
except commercial fire systems.  
A# Perimeter Fault  
Default:  
0
Selection:  
0, 1 to 128 for D9412GV3, 1 to 64  
for D7412GV3, A, B, or C  
Battery Trouble  
Activates when a Controlled Perimeter point (P##  
Type 1) assigned to the specified area is faulted,  
regardless of the armed state of the area. This relay  
provides a steady output until all Perimeter points in  
the area return to normal.  
Default:  
0
Selection: 0, 1 to 128 for D9412GV3, 1 to 64  
for D7412GV3, A, B, or C  
Activates when battery voltage falls below 85% of  
capacity (12.1 VDC) for a fully charged (13.8 VDC)  
battery, or when the battery is in a missing condition.  
This relay automatically resets when battery power  
restores.  
This relay does not activate on interior  
faults. To detect all area point faults,  
program all points as Perimeter points in  
the area where this relay is assigned.  
Use this relay to create audible  
annunciation. Enable the keypad’s  
trouble sounders for all applications  
except commercial fire systems.  
A# Silent Alarm  
Default:  
0
Selection:  
0, 1 to 128 for D9412GV3, 1 to 64  
for D7412GV3, A, B, or C  
Phone Fail  
This relay activates when a point assigned to the  
specified area and programmed for P## Silent Bell  
goes into alarm.  
Default:  
0
Selection: 0, 1 to 128 for D9412GV3, 1 to 64  
for D7412GV3, A, B, or C  
Activates when a telephone line failure occurs. A time  
must be entered in Ph Supv Time (refer to Section  
2.2 Phone Parameters on page 14) for this relay to  
activate. This relay resets automatically when restoral  
of the phone line(s) occurs.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 82  
Summary Fire Trouble  
Comm Fail  
Default:  
0
Default:  
0
Selection: 0, 1 to 128 for D9412GV3, 1 to 64  
for D7412GV3, A, B, or C  
Selection: 0, 1 to 128 for D9412GV3, 1 to 64  
for D7412GV3, A, B, or C  
Activates when any Fire point in the control panel is  
in trouble, or if a Fire Supervision point is missing.  
This relay provides a steady output until all Fire  
points restore to a normal condition.  
Activates when a control panel cannot communicate  
a report after making ten attempts to each routing  
destination. At the same time, COMM FAIL RG  
displays at the keypad. This relay automatically  
resets when a report is sent successfully.  
Summary SupFire  
Use this relay to report primary digital  
report failure to an alternate  
communication device.  
Default:  
0
Selection: 0, 1 to 128 for D9412GV3, 1 to 64  
for D7412GV3, A, B, or C  
Activates when any Fire Supervisory point in the  
control panel is in a supervisory condition (off-  
normal). This relay provides a steady output until all  
Fire Supervisory points are restored to a normal  
condition.  
Log % Full  
Default:  
0
Selection:  
0, 1 to 128 for D9412GV3, 1 to 64  
for D7412GV3, A, B, or C  
Enter the number of the relay that activates when the  
log reaches the programmed percentage of its  
capacity as programmed in the Log % Full prompt  
under PANEL WIDE PARAMETERS >RPS  
Parameters. This relay provides a steady output until  
a Get Log and Set Pointer is executed from the  
remote programming software (RPS).  
Summary Trouble  
Default:  
0
Selection: 0, 1 to 128 for D9412GV3, 1 to 64  
for D7412GV3, A, B, or C  
Activates when any Non-fire point in the control panel  
is in a trouble condition. This relay provides a steady  
output until the user at the keypad acknowledges the  
trouble.  
Summary Fire  
Default:  
0
Summary SupBurg  
Selection:  
0, 1 to 128 for D9412GV3, 1 to 64  
for D7412GV3, A, B, or C  
Default:  
0
Enter the number of the relay that activates when any  
Fire point in the system (P## Type 0, P## Fire Yes)  
enters into alarm. This relay provides a steady output  
until all Fire points in the system return to normal.  
Refer to Fire Summary Sustain on page 137 for  
details on alternate operation.  
Selection: 0, 1 to 128 for D9412GV3, 1 to 64  
for D7412GV3, A, B, or C  
Activates when any Non-fire Supervisory point in the  
control panel is in a supervisory condition, or if a  
Supervisory Burg point is missing. This relay provides  
a steady output until the user at the keypad  
acknowledges the condition.  
Summary Alarm  
Default:  
0
2.1  
Passcode or Token Worksheet  
Selection:  
0, 1 to 128 for D9412GV3, 1 to 64  
for D7412GV3, A, B, or C  
These programming items assign:  
a passcode to user groups 001 to 249,  
areas by authority level, and  
a User Group Window.  
Enter the number of the relay that activates when a  
Non-fire point enters into alarm. This relay provides a  
steady output until the alarm is acknowledged by a  
valid passcode, then cleared from alarm memory with  
an acknowledgment at the keypad.  
This relay does not activate for silent and  
invisible alarms.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 83  
2.1.1 User Groups  
When using the Add/Change User  
function at the keypad, the authority levels  
and the changes made affect the master  
user’s passcode and the entire group’s  
token or cards.  
For the D9412GV3, there are 249 groups (99 groups  
for the D7412GV3) consisting of one user with a  
passcode and token (master) and three users with  
tokens or cards but not a passcode (sub-user). All  
users in the group share the same authority level as  
the master user.  
When using the ACCESS CONTROL  
LEVEL function at the keypad, the whole  
group is affected by whether or not the  
level is on or off for access control  
functions only.  
2.1.2 Passcodes  
In a control panel with factory default settings, only  
the master user has an assigned passcode. A  
passcode can be three to six digits. Entering three  
digits in User ### chooses the user. Programming  
the U001 Passcode assigns a passcode to the  
master user. Sub-users cannot use the passcode. Do  
not assign tokens or cards to User ID 0 (zero), which  
is reserved for the service passcode.  
When using the DELETE USER?  
function, the whole group is deleted. You  
cannot delete each user within the group  
individually. Use the ADD/CHG USER?  
function to change a user token or card  
instead of deleting the whole group.  
Passcode Tamper  
2.1.4 User Name  
If a user enters six consecutive invalid passcodes at  
the same keypad, the control panel sends a User  
Code Tamper report to the central station. The invalid  
passcode count resets when a valid passcode is  
entered at the same keypad. Refer to R# Usr Code  
Tamper in Table 10 on page 21 for information on  
enabling this report.  
Each user group can be assigned one U### Name.  
This name is logged and sent to the central station  
for all the users in the group. The user ID is used to  
differentiate which user’s token or card was  
executed.  
When using a D1260 Keypad, User 249  
text is used for contact information text  
(such as telephone numbers). If a D1260  
is installed on the system, do not use  
User 249 for user ID information.  
The passcode tamper condition is also reported in a  
manually initiated Extended Test Report and to RPS  
through control panel diagnostics. As a result, the  
tamper condition is reset after the successful  
completion of a manual report or when disconnecting  
from an RPS session. The tamper condition is not  
reset when the control panel reboots.  
2.1.5 Tokens and Cards  
The master user assigned the passcode can also be  
assigned a token or card by programming the U###  
Mstr Site and U### Mstr Crd Data.  
2.1.3 User Group Window  
Use U### User Group to enable and disable the  
U### Passcode for up to eight different time periods  
throughout the day. Assign the number (1 to 8)  
programmed in U### User Group to a User  
Windows #. If the user is outside a window,  
Three more tokens or cards are assigned to the user  
group for sub-users using the U### SU# Site and  
U### SU# C/D.  
COMMAND DISABLED appears on the keypad after  
the user enters the passcode and presses [ENTER].  
This window does not affect tokens and  
cards. It only affects the passcode of the  
master user.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 84  
2.1.6 Reporting and Logging  
Phone # Format must be ModemIIIa2 for the following reports sent to the central station. Regardless of the  
reporting format, they log and print at the local printer as shown in Figure 4. Each sub-user is identified by the  
master user’s three-digit number plus an extension of 0, 1, 2, or 3. These numbers are called Sub-user ID  
Codes. shows all the users for User Group 122 as they would appear.  
Figure 4: User Group 122 Example  
Master User:  
ID 122.  
1
CRD ID 122-0  
Sub User -1: ID 122-1  
CRD ID 122-1  
2
Sub User -2: ID 122-2.  
CRD ID 122-2  
Sub User -3: ID 122-3.  
CRD ID 122-3  
1 - User passcode  
2 - User token or card  
In reporting systems using ModemIIIa2 reporting format, all three digits of the User ID Code are  
transmitted to the central station with appropriate reports. Central station automation computer  
systems can accept only Zonex and Comex style User IDs. Refer to Point/User Flag in Section  
2.1 Phone on page 12.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 85  
User ###  
U### User Group  
Default:  
0
Default:  
001  
Selection:  
0, 1 to 8  
Selection: 000 or 001 to 249 (001 to 099 for  
the D7412GV3)  
Create a group of up to 249 users (99 for the  
D7412GV3) whose combinations can be enabled and  
disabled using an automatic user window. This is the  
number entered into the W# User Group for any  
active W# User Window. Multiple windows can be  
programmed for one user group (up to eight) within  
one 24-hour period. For example, if User Group 1  
has a window running from 8:00 AM (start time) to  
4:00 PM (stop time), the users for that group can use  
their passcodes only between that time. Between  
4:00 PM that day and 8:00 AM the next day, the  
users cannot use their passcodes.  
Enter the User number you are programming.  
User 000 is the Service Authority Level  
(Level 15). You cannot change the  
programming for user 000.  
Only the Service Authority Level (User  
000) can delete User 000. When a user  
other than User 000 tries to delete the  
passcode for User 000, the keypad  
displays NOT IN USE.  
User 000 cannot be added or changed  
at the keypad whether it exists or not.  
To enable this user’s passcode at all  
times, leave U### User Group 0.  
U### Passcode  
User Group Window times cannot be changed from  
the keypad. When a window is assigned to a user  
group, the users in that group rely on the window to  
be active (within the start and stop times) for their  
passcodes to function. The only way to disable the  
window is by reprogramming the control panel from  
the remote programming software (RPS).  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection: Three to six digits ( 0 to 9)  
Enter three to six digits to enable a passcode for the  
master user in this group.  
To meet UL 864 requirements, enter at  
least one Passcode.  
U### Area 1 [through Area #] Auth  
User I.D.000 is the reserved user for  
service personnel. The default service  
passcode is 123.  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection: 0 to 14  
The programmer does not allow you to  
enter any passcode number that might  
conflict with a duress passcode. The  
programmer reserves the passcode  
number plus 1, duress passcode number  
plus 2, passcode-number minus 1, and  
passcode number minus 2.  
Assign an authority level to the user for this area.  
A setting of 0 means the user has no authority in this  
area.  
To meet UL 864 requirements, assign a  
valid authority level to the Passcode to  
silence bells.  
For example, when a passcode of  
654321 is entered, 654322, 654323,  
654320, and 654329 are reserved and  
are not available to other users.  
The authority to silence a bell is granted  
to all passcodes regardless of their  
authority level assignments. A user  
passcode can silence a Fire or Burg bell  
as long as any authority level is assigned  
to the area where the bell can be  
silenced.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 Panel and Area Wide Parameters  
EN | 86  
Converting hexadecimal to decimal: If  
U### Name  
your card label contains letters as well as  
numbers, the number is hexadecimal.*  
Convert the hexadecimal number to  
decimal using your calculator. If you  
cannot convert in this way, use the reader  
and the Add/Chg User? Function to add  
the tokens or cards.  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Sixteen alphanumeric characters  
Selection:  
Enter Alphabetic-characters A to Z in capital letters  
Period (.), comma (,), percent (%), parentheses [()],  
equal (=), greater or less than (< >), exclamation (!),  
braces ({}), apostrophe (’), carat (^), grave accent (`),  
tilde (~), semi-colon (;), and colon (:) are not allowed.  
Perform the following test to confirm that  
you can convert properly:  
Enter up to sixteen characters of text for this user  
group.  
Use 319EB0 as the hexadecimal number.  
On your calculator, press [HEX]. Enter all  
the hexadecimal characters into the  
calculator. Press [DEC] and your  
hexadecimal characters convert to the  
following eight digits: 03251888. The site  
number is 032. Enter it in U### Mstr  
Site. Your card data is 51888. Enter it into  
U### Mstr Crd Data.  
Programming this group with a  
departmental, team, or function name  
identifies all the users in this group in a  
function related manner, such as  
ENGINEERING.  
Card Data Format  
The D9412GV3/D7412GV3 and D9210B Controller  
comply with the 26-bit Wiegand card data format. In  
essence, the format consists of 26 bits (3.2 bytes) of  
data. The first bit is used for the even parity. The next  
8 bits (first byte) is used for the U### Site Code. The  
next 16 bits (second and third byte) are used for the  
U### Card Data. The last bit is used for the odd  
parity.  
*
A hexadecimal number can contain all numerals. If the  
code does not work, try converting the number from  
hexadecimal to decimal.  
Always tag your tokens before adding  
them to the system so you do not mix  
them up. Use the CRD ID ###-# number  
to index them.  
As long as the reader and the tokens or cards you  
use are compatible with 26-bit Wiegand format, they  
function with this system.  
U### Mstr Crd Data  
Default: Blank  
Use only the readers identified as being compatible  
with the D9210B door control module. Refer to the  
D9210B Operation and Installation Guide  
Selection: 00000 = (0) to 65534 or Blank  
(65535)  
(P/N: 32206) for information on these readers.  
Master User ### Card Data: Enter the remaining  
five decimal numbers on the back of the token or  
card. This is the second and third byte (bits 10  
through 25) of data for a 26-bit Wiegand card. This is  
called the card data.  
For more information, refer to the Security Industry  
Association (SIA) Access Control 26-bit Wiegand  
Reader Interface Standard.  
U### Mstr Site  
You must program U### Mstr Site before  
programming this prompt.  
Default:  
255  
U### SU1 through SU3 Site  
Selection:  
0 to 255  
Master User ### Site Data: Enter the first three  
decimal numbers on the back of the token or card.  
This is the first byte (bits 2 through 9) of data for a  
26-bit Wiegand card. This is called the site number.  
Tokens and cards with a site code of 255 are not  
compatible with the D9412GV3/D7412GV3 Control  
Panels.  
Default:  
255  
Selection: 0 to 255  
Sub-users one through three site data.  
U### SU1 through SU3 C/D  
Default:  
Blank  
Selection:  
00000 = (0) to 65534 or Blank  
(65535)  
Card data for sub-users one through three.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 3.0 Points  
EN | 87  
Point Index  
Default:  
3.0 Points  
1
3.1  
Point Index  
Selection: 1 to 31  
Use the point indexes to construct personality types  
for points used in the system. The Index numbers are  
used in Point Assignments. Each unique point index  
number determines the control panel’s responses to  
specific conditions occurring on the Protective points.  
The number of the point personality you are  
programming. You can define up to 31 individual  
personalities.  
The D9412GV3/D7412GV3 Program Record Sheet  
(P/N: F01U170809) and RPS contain the default  
settings and descriptions for point indexes.  
P## Type  
Default:  
Selection:  
P ## Type  
0
Refer to the program record sheet  
0 to 9, or 11  
Description  
24-hour: A 24-hour point is not turned on and off from a keypad. 24-hour points are armed all  
the time, and can be used for fire protection (refer to the P ## Fire Point prompt in Section 3.2  
Point Responses on page 91), panic, medical, and police alerts.  
24-hour protection for fire doors, roof hatches, and so on. Instead of programming this type of  
protection as a 24-hour point, consider using a Perimeter point type with a Point Response of  
9 to E. 24-hour points do not show faults when an arming function is entered, but Perimeter  
points do. When programming this type of protection, consider also using the Buzz on Fault  
and Local While Disarmed options.  
1
Perimeter: Perimeter points are armed with all arming functions. Points programmed as  
perimeter can also be armed as a group (using Perimeter-Arming functions) separately from  
points programmed as interior. This lets the user partially arm the system to establish  
Perimeter protection while occupying the interior of the protected premises.  
Perimeter points can be programmed to activate entry delay time. If the point activates entry  
delay, it can also activate an entry tone.  
When a Perimeter point is programmed for entry delay, entry delay time is always provided. If  
the area is in entry delay when a second Perimeter point is faulted, the control panel  
compares the remaining entry delay time to the time programmed for the second Perimeter  
point. If the second Perimeter point’s entry delay time is less than the remaining time, it  
shortens the entry delay time.  
Perimeter points programmed for an instant point response, generate an alarm immediately  
when faulted, even during entry or exit delay.  
(Continued on next page.)  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 3.0 Points  
EN | 88  
P ## Type  
Description  
2
Interior: Interior points are armed only by master arming the area. They are not armed when  
using Perimeter Arming functions. These points are typically used to monitor interior detection  
devices such as interior doors, motion detectors, photoelectric beams, and carpet mats.  
Instant Interior Points: Interior points are usually programmed for an instant alarm (refer to  
Section 3.2 Point Responses on page 91). Points programmed for instant alarms generate  
alarms immediately, even during entry or exit delay.  
Delayed Interior Points: Interior points can be programmed for a delayed point response. A  
delayed response means that if the point is faulted while the area is armed, it activates entry  
delay. It does not generate an alarm until entry delay expires.  
When an Interior point is programmed for entry delay, entry delay time is always provided. If  
the area is in entry delay when a fault occurs for the Interior point, the control panel compares  
the remaining entry delay time to the time programmed for the Interior point. If the Interior  
point’s entry delay time is less than the remaining time, it shortens the entry delay time.  
Delayed points can also activate an entry tone at the keypad (refer to the P## Entry Tone Off  
prompt in Section 3.2 Point Responses on page 91).  
In some cases, you might need to create an Interior point that causes an instant alarm if the  
entry delay is not started first. Use Interior Follower to create this type of protection.  
Interior Follower: Interior Follower points are armed only by master arming the area. They are  
not armed when using Perimeter-Arming functions.  
3
An Interior Follower point does not create an alarm if it has a fault while the area is in entry  
delay. An Interior Follower does not change the amount of remaining entry delay time.  
If no entry delay is in effect when a fault occurs for the Interior Follower, it creates an instant  
alarm.  
You must program a delayed Point Response (4, 5, 6, 7, or 8) for an Interior Follower point.  
The control panel ignores the entry in P## Entry Delay for an Interior Follower point.  
Increasing the debounce count for Interior Follower points might be  
necessary to prevent Interior Follower points from entering into alarm  
before the control panel recognizes that a Perimeter Delay point was  
faulted. Program the Interior Follower’s debounce for one number higher  
than the debounce count on Perimeter delay.  
(Continued on next page.)  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 3.0 Points  
EN | 89  
P ## Type  
Description  
4*  
Keyswitch Maintained: Program P## Pt Response as 1. Do not connect initiating devices to  
a Keyswitch point.  
Normal:  
Short:  
The area is disarmed.  
A short is a trouble when the area is disarmed. A short is an alarm when the  
area is armed. When this point changes from shorted to normal or open, it  
restores.  
Open:  
When this point changes from normal to open, the area arms.  
Program Point Response as 2, the point responds as follows:  
Normal:  
Open:  
When this point changes from open to normal, the area arms.  
The area is disarmed.  
Short:  
A short is a trouble when the area is disarmed. A short is an alarm when the  
area is armed. When this point changes from shorted to normal or open, it  
restores.  
Trouble and Restoral Reports are not sent if Local While Disarmed is Yes.  
Alarm and Restoral Reports are not sent if Local While Armed is Yes.  
5*  
Keyswitch Momentary: Used for area arming and disarming. Point Response must be  
programmed 1. Do not connect initiating devices to a Keyswitch point.  
When this point momentarily changes from normal to shorted to normal, it  
toggles the armed state of the area.  
NSN:  
Open:  
An open is a trouble while the point is disarmed. An open is an alarm while  
the point is armed.  
When this point changes from open to normal, it restores.  
Trouble and Restoral Reports are not sent if Local Disarmed is Yes.  
6*  
Open/Close Point: Used for point arming and disarming. Point Response must be  
programmed 1. Local bells are silenced through the keypad.  
Normal:  
Open:  
The point is armed and sends a Point Closing Report. A Point Closing Report  
is not sent if Local Armed is Yes.  
An open is an alarm when the point is armed. An open is a trouble when the  
point is disarmed. Alarm and Restoral Reports are not sent if Local  
Disarmed is Yes.  
Short:  
The point is disarmed and sends a Point Opening Report. A Point Opening  
Report is not sent if Local Armed is Yes.  
* Keyswitch Points: Special rules apply to points used for Keyswitch functions. These special point types do not  
respond the same way to the point response entry as Point Types 1, 2, and 3.  
(Continued on next page.)  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 3.0 Points  
EN | 90  
P ## Type  
Selection  
Description  
7*  
D279 (O/C Non-Priority): The D279 provides point arming and disarming independent of the  
area arm state. A non-priority D279 point arm state does not affect the area arm state. Point  
Response must be programmed 1. Local bells are silenced through the keypad. For bell  
control at the D279, use P## Type 8.  
Open the W1 jumper on the D279 to send Point Opening and Point Closing Reports. If the  
D279’s W1 jumper is closed, no Open or Close Report is sent, regardless of control panel  
programming.  
Normal:  
The point is armed and sends a Point Closing Report. Point Closing Report is  
not sent if Local Armed is Yes.  
Open:  
The point is disarmed and sends a Point Opening Report. A Point Opening  
Report is not sent if Local Armed is Yes.  
Short:  
A short is an alarm when the point is armed. A short is a trouble when the  
point is disarmed. Alarm and Restoral Reports are not sent if Local  
Disarmed is Yes.  
8*  
D279 (O/C Priority): The D279 provides point arming and disarming independent of the  
area’s arming state. A priority D279 point must be armed before an area can be armed.  
Program Point Response as 2.  
Open the W1 jumper on the D279 to send area Opening and Closing Reports as programmed  
in Area Parameters and to provide bell control. If the D279’s W1 jumper is closed, no Area  
Open or Area Close Report is sent, and alarm bells can only be silenced from a keypad, no  
matter how the control panel is programmed.  
Normal:  
Open:  
When this point changes from open to normal, the area arms.  
The area is disarmed. The alarm bell silences if an alarm occurred while the  
area was armed.  
Short:  
A short is a trouble while the area is disarmed. A short is an alarm while the  
area is armed. When this point changes from shorted to normal or open, it  
restores.  
9*  
Easikey: This point is programmed for access. Program Point Response as 1. If the system  
is Master Armed or Perimeter Armed (with or without delays), presenting a valid token to the  
Easikey reader shorts the point and disarms its assigned area. Presenting a valid token in a  
disarmed state does not clear trouble or alarm memory or rearm the area.  
11  
Aux AC Supervision: This point type monitors the AC power of an auxiliary power supply.  
When the point is in an off-normal state, the control panel waits for the time programmed in  
AC Fail Time before generating a Point Trouble. If P## Fire Point is set to Yes, the off-  
normal condition results in a Fire Trouble. This point type does not use P## Point Response;  
therefore, no alarm condition occurs. If this point type is bypassed, 24 HOUR PT BYPASSED  
is shown on the keypads.  
* Keyswitch Points. Special rules apply to points used for Keyswitch functions. These special point types do not  
respond the same way to the point response entry as Point Types 1, 2, and 3.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 3.0 Points  
EN | 91  
Alarm Verification: A Fire point can delay an alarm  
by the length of time programmed in A# Verify Time  
in the Area Parameters. Combined with A#  
Resettable, a Fire point also resets the electrical  
circuit for the amount of time programmed.  
3.2  
Point Responses  
3.2.1 Applications for Point Responses 9,  
D, and E:  
Combine Point Responses 9, D, and E with  
Perimeter point types to create more flexible 24-hour  
protection. Unlike 24-hour points, a faulted Perimeter  
point with a Point Response of D and E displays at  
the keypad when arming. Like a 24-hour point, a  
point programmed this way can generate alarms  
whether the area is armed or disarmed.  
Reset Sensor: A fire device that requires resetting  
can be manually reset using the reset sensor relay  
for the area to which it is assigned.  
Fire Walk: Use the Fire Walk function to test Fire  
points in the system. The Fire Walk Test  
automatically resets each point for 5 sec when the  
point is activated, and rings the Fire Bell for 2 sec.  
Combining Point Response 9 with the Local While  
Disarmed feature provides off-site reporting when the  
area is armed, but only local alarm annunciation  
when the area is disarmed.  
To provide an audible tone for a restored  
Fire Supervisory point, use P## Relay  
Response Type set to 1 and connect the  
corresponding relay to a visual  
annunciator.  
Combining Point Response 9 with the Local While  
Armed feature provides off-site reporting when the  
area is disarmed, but only local alarm annunciation  
when the area is armed.  
Point Response E: Use this setting for Zonex or  
ASIC motion detectors. The control panel can report  
troubles while Master Armed.  
Point Response F: Does not sound at local keypads  
but activates a relay when P## Relay Response  
Type is set to 1 and annunciates a fault at the  
keypads. To annunciate the off-normal state at a  
keypad, program P## Display as Device as Yes or  
optionally set P## BuzzOn Fault as 1 or 2. This point  
response does not generate alarms nor does it  
activate the Alarm Bell.  
Point Response 8, 9, A, B, and C: These point  
responses provide supervisory (24-hour) reporting.  
3.2.2 Characteristics of a Fire Point:  
Reporting: When a group of events occurs, the  
control panel routes and prints out Fire Reports first.  
Visual Annunciation: FIRE TROUBLES continues  
to scroll until the trouble clears. When acknowledged,  
a FIRE TROUBLE scroll notifies the end user that a  
Fire point, or group of Fire points, is still in trouble.  
Panel-Wide Relays, Summary Fire, and Summary  
Fire Trouble activate if a relay is assigned when any  
Fire point enters into alarm or is in trouble.  
Audible Annunciation: A Fire point activates the  
A# Fire Bell relay programmed in Relay Parameters.  
The amount of time and the pattern of the relay  
activation is programmed by area in Bell  
Parameters, A# Fire Time, and A# Fire Pattern.  
Supervisory: A Fire point can send a Fire  
Supervisory Report and activate the Summary Fire  
Sup and Summary Fire Trouble, Panel-Wide  
Relays with a P## Response of 8-9-A-B-C.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 3.0 Points  
EN | 92  
P## Pt Response  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection: 0 to F  
Controlled (Non-24-Hour Points)  
Point Response  
0
I
1
I
2
I
3
I
4
D
I
5
D
I
6
I
7
I
8
D
D
9
I
A
I
B
I
C
I
D
I
E
F
Armed  
Open  
Short  
Open  
Short  
T
I
Armed  
I
I
I
I
D
D
T
I
I
I
I
I
Disarmed  
Disarmed  
T
T
T
I
I
T
I
I
T
T
T
I
T
I
24-Hour Points  
Point Response  
Open  
0
I
1
T
I
2
I
3
T
T
4
I
5
6
I
7
T
8
S
T
9
T
S
A
S
B
S
C
S
S
D
E
F
Short  
I
T
T
Key:  
I = Instant alarm  
D = Delayed alarm  
T = Trouble  
If this time expires before disarming, or if the point is  
configured with an instant response (I), an alarm  
occurs.  
Make entries in 5 sec increments. The  
programmer does not allow off-increment  
entries.  
S = Supervisory  
Blank = Audible or visual response  
Example of Controlled point:  
Point Type = 1  
With Passcode Length set to a non-zero value,  
entering a valid Passcode during Entry Delay disarms  
the system as soon as the last digit is entered. No  
other keys are required. When the control panel is in  
Exit Delay or is armed, entering a valid Passcode  
must be followed by the [ENTER] or [ENT] key.  
Point Response = 8  
Perimeter point with delayed alarm response when  
armed (opened or shorted) and no response when  
disarmed.  
If another Perimeter or Interior Follower  
Delay point trips while the area is already  
in entry delay, the control panel adjusts  
the delay time to the Delay point with the  
least amount of delay time.  
Example of 24-hour point:  
Point Type = 0  
Point Response = 8  
P## Entry Delay  
When a user enters an area, a Perimeter  
point is faulted and the entry delay starts.  
If an interior point must fault during entry  
delay to allow the user to disarm the area  
at a keypad, program P## Type as 3  
(Interior Follower).  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection: 5 sec to 600 sec  
Use this option to enter the amount of entry delay  
time that a user has after faulting a Controlled point  
(P## Type 1, 2, 3) with a delayed response (D) (P##  
Pt Response) of 4, 5, 6, 7, or 8. DISARM NOW  
appears for the duration of the time programmed  
when the point is faulted in the delay condition.  
For SIA CP-01 Compliance:  
P## Entry Delay must be between 30 sec and  
240 sec.  
The D1255 alternates between DISARM  
NOW and the point text of the point that  
caused the area to enter into entry delay.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 3.0 Points  
EN | 93  
If you want this point to ring the bell  
P## Entry Tone Off  
because the message failed to reach the  
central station receiver, program P##  
Audible After 2 Failures as Yes.  
Default:  
Selection:  
Yes  
No  
Yes or No  
Disables the entry delay tone when  
this perimeter point is faulted.  
P## Ring Until Restored  
Default:  
Selection:  
Yes  
No  
This is intended for use with points  
set to P## Type 1 (Perimeter).  
Yes or No  
No  
A tone sounds at keypads when this  
point starts entry delay.  
The relay programmed to provide  
fire alarm output for this point cannot  
be de-activated until the point  
restores to normal.  
This option enables and disables the entry delay  
warning tone for this point.  
No  
The relay programmed to provide  
fire alarm output for this point can be  
de-activated before the point  
restores to normal.  
Do not set points to No if they are actually  
used to notify the user to disarm the  
system. The possibility of false alarms  
increases if the entry delay warning is not  
used.  
Use this option to determine if the bell continues to  
ring until the Fire Bell time expires. The point returns  
to a normal condition when the user acknowledges  
the alarm to silence the bell.  
Entry Tone can also be turned off when  
programming your CC Entry Tone, in  
Section 2.9 Keypad (Command Center)  
on page 50, that allows you to manage  
the tone by keypad.  
If the point restores and the fire alarm is  
not silenced from the keypad, the fire  
alarm output continues until Fire Bell time  
expires. If the point does not restore, the  
fire alarm output continues even after bell  
time expires.  
You might want to disable the entry tone  
in high security applications where you do  
not want to annunciate entry delay.  
Use this option for fire applications to  
meet the requirement that audible alarms  
cannot be silenced until the fault condition  
clears or the Fire Bell time expires.  
P## Silent Bell  
Default:  
Selection:  
Yes  
No  
Yes or No  
P## Audible After 2 Failures  
Activate the Silent Alarm Relay when  
this point enters into alarm. Keypads  
do not sound the alarm tone for Non-  
fire points.  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
A# Burg Alarm relay activates after  
two failed attempts.  
No  
Activate either the Fire Bell relay or  
Alarm Bell relay and sound the alarm  
tone at keypads when this point  
enters into alarm. If this is a Fire  
point, it activates the Fire Bell relay  
programmed in Relay Parameters.  
Otherwise, it activates the Alarm Bell  
relay. The amount of time and  
pattern of the relay activation is  
programmed by area in Bell  
P## Silent points do not cause the  
A# Burg Alarm relay to activate even  
if the report does not get to the  
central station receiver.  
When set to Yes, if the report fails to reach the  
central station after two attempts, a silent alarm rings  
the A## Burg Alarm bell. A silent alarm is generated  
when a point with P## Silent set to Yes is faulted  
while armed.  
Parameters.  
To meet UL 864 requirements, set this  
parameter to No.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 3.0 Points  
EN | 94  
When a point programmed for P## Silent  
Bell is faulted, the timer for the A# Burg  
Time starts, even though the bell is not  
yet ringing. As much as 3 min can elapse  
before the second attempt fails. Ensure  
that A# Burg Time is programmed to  
provide the amount of bell time you need,  
minus the additional 3 min that might  
elapse before the bell actually begins to  
ring.  
P## Invisible Point  
Default:  
Selection:  
Yes  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Yes or No  
Keypads do not display alarm  
activity from this point.  
No  
Activity from this point is visible at  
the keypads.  
To meet UL 864 requirements, set this  
parameter to No.  
Use this option to determine whether the point  
appears in the keypad display upon an alarm  
condition. For LED keypads, the LED does not  
illuminate upon an alarm condition. Point text  
appears and annunciation is made for Invisible points  
programmed for a trouble condition in point response.  
To prevent the keypad alarm tone and the  
A# Burg Alarm bell from sounding,  
program P## Silent Bell as Yes.  
If a user enters a valid passcode while a  
bell is ringing for an invisible alarm, the  
keypad shows ALARM SILENCED.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 3.0 Points  
EN | 95  
P## Buzz On Fault  
Default:  
0
Selection:  
Selection  
0 to 3  
Operation for Controlled Points  
(Point Types 1, 2, and 3)  
Operation for 24-hour, Fire and Aux AC  
Supervision Points (Point Types 0 and  
11)  
0
1
The point buzzes at the keypad only if it enters  
into the trouble condition indicated in the P##  
Point Response.  
Same as operation for controlled points  
The point generates a Buzz Until Restore at the The point generates a Buzz Until Restore at  
keypad for any fault condition while the point the keypad for any fault condition  
is disarmed. The buzz continues until the point regardless of the armed state. The buzz  
restores and the user acknowledges the  
condition using a passcode or COMMAND 4.  
The point must be normal before the user can  
silence the buzz.  
continues until the point restores and the  
user acknowledges the condition using a  
passcode or COMMAND 4. The point must  
be normal before the user can silence the  
buzz.  
2
3
The point buzzes at the keypad for any fault  
condition when the point is disarmed. The  
user can silence the buzz before the point  
returns to normal.  
The point buzzes at the keypad for any fault  
condition regardless of the armed state.  
The point does not need to be normal before  
the user can silence the buzz.  
The point buzzes at the keypad for any fault  
condition when the area is disarmed. The user  
cannot silence this buzz, but it silences  
The point buzzes at the keypad for any fault  
condition regardless of the armed state.  
The user cannot silence this buzz, but it  
silences automatically when the point is  
automatically when the point is restored. If the  
fault condition results in a trouble response, the restored. If the fault condition results in a  
keypad continues to buzz even after the user  
acknowledges the condition if the fault is still  
present.  
trouble response, the keypad continues to  
buzz even after the user acknowledges the  
condition if the fault is still present.  
Points bypassed (by the user, Sked, Swinger Bypass, or RPS) do not generate a Buzz On Fault  
condition at the keypad.  
The buzz does not automatically stop when the point is restored when using Option 1 or 2. The user  
must acknowledge the buzz before the buzz stops. However, when using Option 3, the buzz stops  
automatically when the point restores to normal without user intervention.  
If a point with the type of 11 Aux AC Supervision is bypassed, 24 HOUR PT BYPASSED is shown  
on the keypads.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 3.0 Points  
EN | 96  
Do not use the Change Relays? function  
P## Watch Point  
to toggle relays reserved for special  
functions. Special function relays are  
Area and Panel Wide Relay functions as  
well as relays assigned to CC## Enter  
Key Relay and P## Relay Response  
Type.  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
Activates Watch Mode responses if  
the point is faulted while the control  
panel is in Watch Mode.  
Does not activate Watch Mode  
responses for this point.  
P## Display as Device  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Use this option to allow a Controlled point to generate  
a watch tone while the area is disarmed and not  
faulted to a trouble or alarm condition.  
Yes  
Display CHECK DEVICE when this  
point is off-normal.  
P## Relay Response Type  
No  
Do not display CHECK DEVICE  
when this point is off-normal.  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection: 0 to 2  
Use P## Display as Device to cause the keypad to  
display CHECK DEVICE when a point is off-normal or  
is acknowledged after going into alarm.  
0
1
Point state does not affect the  
operation of the corresponding relay.  
Relay Follows Point: The relay  
corresponding with this point  
activates when the point is faulted to  
any off-normal condition, even if the  
point is bypassed. The relay  
automatically resets when the point  
returns to normal.  
Use this function for devices with a dry  
contact output that faults a point when  
the device is in a trouble condition.  
P## Local While Disarmed  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
2
Relay Latches: The relay  
Selection: Yes or No  
corresponding with this point latches  
when the point enters into an alarm  
condition. This relay provides a  
steady output until the alarm is  
acknowledged by a valid passcode,  
then cleared from alarm memory with  
an acknowledgment from the keypad.  
Yes  
Suppress Alarm, Trouble and  
Restoral* Reports from this point  
while the area to which it is assigned  
is disarmed.  
No  
Send event reports occurring from  
this point while the area is disarmed.  
Use this option to cause a relay (1 to 127 for  
D9412GV3; 1 to 64 for D7412GV3) to respond when  
a corresponding point with the same number (1 to  
127) is faulted. This requires connecting D8129  
OctoRelays to Zonex Bus 1 and Zonex Bus 2  
(D9412GV3 only). Refer to the address settings on  
the back of the D9412GV3/D7412GV3 Program  
Record Sheet (P/N: F01U170809).  
* Transmission of Restoral Reports continues if the alarm,  
trouble, or bypass (by Sked, RPS, or Swinger bypass)  
condition occurred when the area disarmed, and the point  
restored.  
To meet UL 864 requirements for  
Central Station and Remote Station  
applications, set this parameter to No.  
Use this option to allow a Controlled point (P## Type  
1, 2, 3), to report Alarms, Troubles, and Restoral  
Reports only when the area is armed. This prompt  
does not affect local annunciation.  
Point 128 is reserved for use other than  
an actual point. Only the first 127 points  
can have an associated relay. Relays are  
not available for Points 129 to 247.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 3.0 Points  
EN | 97  
Local While Disarmed suppresses all  
reports from 24-hour points. Do not use  
P## Type 0 for this prompt. Remember  
that this option works only for Disarmed  
points, and a Type 0 is a 24-hour Always  
Armed point. Instead, choose any type  
other than 0, and use a point response  
that reports an alarm, whether or not the  
point is armed. For instance, P## Type 1  
and P## Response 9 reports an alarm on  
an open or a short (I) whether the area is  
armed or not.  
Local While Armed suppresses all reports  
from 24-hour points. Do not use P## Type  
0 for this prompt. This setting works only  
for disarmed points. Type 0 is a 24-hour,  
always armed point. Choose any Type  
other than 0, and use a point response  
that reports an alarm whether or not the  
point is armed. For instance, P## Type 1  
and P## Response 9 reports an alarm on  
a trouble or a short whether or not the  
area is disarmed.  
Local While Armed affects Keyswitch  
Points. This prompt suppresses  
keyswitch (alarms, troubles, and  
restorals) and D279 (opening, closing,  
troubles, and restorals). Do not use this  
parameter for controlled points that arm  
or disarm.  
Local While Disarmed affects Keyswitch  
points. This prompt suppresses  
keyswitch (troubles and restorals) and  
D279 (alarms, troubles, and restorals).  
Do not use this parameter for these  
applications.  
P## Local While Armed  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
P## Disable Restorals  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
Suppress Alarm, Trouble and  
Yes  
Enable Restoral Reports from this  
Restoral* Reports from this point  
while the area to which it is assigned  
is armed.  
point.  
No  
Disable Restoral Reports from this  
point.  
No  
Report events occurring from this  
point while the area is armed.  
To meet UL 864 requirements for  
Central Station and Remote Station  
applications, set this parameter to No.  
* Transmission of Restoral Reports continues if the alarm,  
trouble, or bypass (by Sked, RPS, or Swinger bypass)  
condition occurred when the area disarmed, and the  
point restored.  
Use this option to disable any Restoral Reports from  
this point after it returns to normal from an alarm or  
trouble condition.  
To meet UL 864 requirements for  
Central Station and Remote Station  
applications, set this parameter to No.  
P## Force Arm Returnable  
Default:  
No  
Allows a controlled point (P## Type 1, 2, 3), to report  
Alarms, Troubles, and Restoral Reports only when  
the area is disarmed. This prompt does not affect  
local annunciation.  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
This point automatically returns to the  
system when it restores to normal.  
This point stays out of the system  
until the area is disarmed.  
Use this option to allow points that were force armed  
out of the area to return back to the armed state when  
they become normal again without having to disarm  
the system.  
Use on loading dock doors, that must  
remain open until loading is completed.  
After the loading dock door is closed, the  
point detects any subsequent opening  
and reports an alarm.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 3.0 Points  
EN | 98  
Bypassing a 24-hour point: When a 24-hour point or  
24-hour Supervisory point is bypassed, 24 HOUR  
BYPASS scrolls continuously at the keypad.  
P## Bypass Returnable  
Default:  
Selection:  
Yes  
No  
Bypassing a Fire Point: FIRE BYPASS scrolls to  
indicate that a 24-hour Fire point or a Fire Supervisory  
point is bypassed.  
Yes or No  
This point automatically returns to  
the system when the area is  
disarmed.  
Alternative to a 24-hour Point: For  
alarm capability of a 24-hour point  
without the continuous scrolling, use a  
Perimeter point with a Point Response of  
9 to E.  
No  
This point stays out of the system  
through arming and disarming  
cycles.  
Use this option to return a point that was bypassed,  
force armed, or swinger bypassed back into the  
system when the area to which this point is assigned  
is disarmed. This option applies to all point types.  
If the P## Bypassable option is set to  
Yes, a point can be bypassed in several  
ways. Refer to Table 27.  
Set this item to No for Interlock points.  
Table 27: Bypassing a Point  
When the point cannot return to the  
system through disarming, the point must  
be manually unbypassed using the  
Unbypass?, keypad function, Sked  
Functions 4 and 5, or remote  
Bypass with:  
Report sent:  
Keypad using the Bypass?  
function  
Command Bypass  
Keypad using Command 0  
Sked Function 3  
Command Bypass  
Sked Bypass  
RPS Bypass1  
programming software (RPS).  
Remote programming software  
(RPS)  
1
For Force Armed points to remain  
bypassed, ensure that P## Force Arm  
Returnable is set to No.  
RPS Bypass is sent at the end of the RPS session.  
If the P## Swinger Bypass option is  
set to Yes, a point is automatically  
bypassed after the fourth alarm or trouble  
report is sent. A swinger Bypass report is  
sent at the same time.  
P## Bypassable  
Default:  
Selection:  
Yes  
No  
Yes or No  
Programming Bypassable as Yes for  
Cross Points can cause missed Cross-  
Point alarms. For example, if Points 1  
and 2 were programmed as Cross Points  
and Point 1 was Bypassed or Force  
Armed, Point 2 cannot generate an Alarm  
Cross Point Event. Point 2 can; however,  
generate an Unverified or Alarm Event  
depending on how the point was faulted.  
Be careful when using this feature with  
Cross Point applications.  
This point can be bypassed and  
force armed.  
No  
This point cannot be bypassed or  
force armed from the keypad or  
remote programming software  
(RPS); however, it can be force  
armed by automatic arming at the  
end of the Closing Window (refer to  
the A# Auto Close prompt in  
Section 2.8.4 Open/Close Options  
on page 43 or by a Sked  
programmed to arm the area.  
To meet UL 864 requirements, set this  
parameter to No.  
Use this option to allow this point to be bypassed or  
force armed.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 3.0 Points  
EN | 99  
P## Swinger Bypass  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
P## Defer Bypass Report  
Default:  
Selection:  
Yes  
No  
Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
Enable Swinger Bypass for this point.  
Send a Point Bypass Report with the  
Closing Report instead of a  
Disable Swinger Bypass for this  
point.  
Command Bypass Report when a  
user bypasses the point.  
To meet UL requirements, set this  
parameter to No.  
No  
Do not defer Bypass Reports.  
Use this option to prevent P## Type (0 to F) points  
that are bypassed by the user (COMMAND BYPASS)  
from occurring until the area is armed. When the area  
is armed, the bypassed points and any point being  
bypassed during the arming sequence report as  
POINT BYPASS along with the Closing Report.  
Use the P## Swinger Bypass parameter to allow the  
control panel to bypass automatically a point that  
reports two or more alarm or trouble events within the  
same arm cycle. The maximum number of faults  
allowed on a point is set in the Swinger Count  
prompt (refer to page 138).  
When P## Defer Bypass Report is set to  
Yes and Closing Reports are suppressed  
by using Closing Windows, the deferred  
Bypass Reports are not sent.  
The control panel reports a Swinger Bypass when the  
Swinger Count is reached and P## Report Bypass  
at Occurrence is set to Yes. If the point has a partial  
count (less than the Swinger Count number of events  
during an hour), the count is reset to zero.  
Bypass Reports for 24-hour points do not  
report If P## Report Bypass at  
Occurrence and P## Defer Bypass  
Report are both set to No.  
P## Bypassable does not need to be  
programmed as Yes for swinger bypass  
to work.  
To report the bypass at occurrence and  
when the area is armed, program P##  
Report Bypass at Occurrence and P##  
Defer Bypass Report as Yes. A  
Command Bypass Report is sent as soon  
as the user manually bypasses a point,  
and a supplemental Point Bypass Report  
is sent with the Closing Report.  
A Swinger Shunted point returns to the  
system if P## Bypass Returnable? is  
Yes. If not, return the point to the system  
through manual unbypass or  
[COMMAND][0][0]. Refer to P## Bypass  
Returnable in the program entry guide  
for additional information.  
P## Cross Point  
P## Report Bypass at Occurrence  
Default:  
No  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
This point is a Cross Point.  
Yes  
No  
Send a Command Bypass Report  
This point is not a Cross Point.  
when the point is bypassed.  
Do not send a Command Bypass  
Report when the point is bypassed.  
Do not use Cross points for Fire points.  
Send a Command Bypass Report as soon as a user  
bypasses the point from the keypad. Enable this  
option for all Bypassable 24-hour points. You can  
also report a bypassed point at the time the area is  
armed. Refer to P## Defer Bypass Report on page  
99.  
The P## Cross Point option is designed to reduce  
false alarms. To achieve this, program two or more  
points within a Cross Point Group with this prompt  
enabled. The Cross point feature is available only on  
points where P## Pt Response is set to a value that  
generates an instant alarm response.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 3.0 Points  
EN | 100  
The Cross Point feature does not activate when a  
P## Alarm Verify  
Default: Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection: Yes or No  
fault occurs on Controlled points (Point Types 1, 2  
and 3) in the disarmed, entry delay, or exit delay  
states. Refer to Section 5.9 Cross Point Parameters  
on page 139 for additional programming  
requirements to program the Cross Point Timer.  
Yes  
Enable alarm verification on this  
point.  
If an abort window delay is needed for the cross zone  
alarms, all cross zone points in the group must have  
P## Alarm Abort (refer to page 101)set to Yes.  
Alarm verification points must be  
programmed as resettable.  
The Cross Point function applies only to  
Instant Alarm conditions. It does not  
apply to Trouble or Supervisory  
conditions.  
No  
Disable alarm verification on this  
point.  
Use this option only with Fire points to designate them  
for alarm verification.  
Cross zones have the ability to individually protect  
the intended area (e.g. motion detectors, which  
overlap).  
When an Alarm Verification point enters into alarm,  
the control panel removes power to all Resettable  
points for the duration programmed in A# Verify Time  
in Section 2.8 Area Parameters on page 36. If the  
point (or another Resettable point in the area) is still  
faulted, or returns to a faulted state within 60 sec after  
the initial verification time reset, an alarm is  
generated.  
For SIA CP-01 Compliance:  
P## Cross Point can be set to Yes or No.  
P## Fire Point  
Default:  
No  
During a Fire Walk Test the reset time is  
5 sec. The time programmed in A# Verify  
Time is ignored.  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
This point is a Fire point.  
This point is not a Fire point.  
P## Resettable  
To meet UL 864 requirements, set this  
parameter to Yes for all applicable Fire  
points.  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
This point is reset by the Reset  
Sensor? function and during the  
alarm verification sequence.  
Use this option to make a 24-hour point a Fire point.  
This option makes this point the highest priority event  
in the control panel when an alarm occurs for both  
reporting and displaying on the keypad. Refer to  
Section 3.2.2 Characteristics of a Fire Point on  
page 91.  
This point is not resettable.  
To meet UL 864 requirements, set this  
parameter to Yes for applicable  
resettable points.  
You should dedicate a fire annunciation  
device to all your Fire points if they are  
assigned to a single area in a multiple  
area system. Special red keypads and  
annunciators with specific keys for fire  
systems are designed for this type of  
application (D1256RB and D1257RB).  
Use this option if this is a Powered point that requires  
interruption of power to reset a latched alarm  
condition. The Resettable point option is typically used  
with smoke detectors and glass break detectors.  
When initiated (either through a Fire Walk Test or the  
keypad’s Reset Sensor? function) or when the remote  
programming software (RPS) interrupts power to the  
device for 5 sec, a Sensor Reset report is sent to the  
central station receiver.  
Do not use the Cross point function for  
Fire points.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 3.0 Points  
EN | 101  
3.3  
Point Assignments  
When a sensor reset occurs, the control  
panel does not accept alarms from any  
points with P## Resettable programmed  
as Yes. During the 5-sec reset time,  
alarms from these points are ignored.  
These entries assign point indexes to Points 1 to 127,  
129 to 247 for the D9412GV3 and Points 1 to 75 for  
the D7412GV3, and assign the points to the areas.  
Also included in this section are parameters used to  
set the point’s debounce count, Relay (for assigning  
relays to follow alarms for a group of points), and  
custom keypad and report text for each point.  
Do not mix fire and intrusion devices on  
the same powered loop.  
P## Alarm Abort  
Point Number  
Default:  
Yes  
Default:  
1
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Selection: 1 to 127, 129 to 247  
Yes  
If the point goes into an alarm  
condition, the system delays the  
alarm report for the amount of time  
specified in the control panel-wide  
parameter Abort Window.  
Enter the point number you are programming. When  
transmitting in Modem IIIa2, the three-digit point  
number is reported to the D6500 or D6600.  
Point number 128 is reserved for  
supervising Zonex 1.  
No  
If the point goes into an alarm  
condition, alarm reports are sent  
immediately.  
Point number 248 is reserved for  
supervising Zonex 2.  
This parameter allows points with the associated  
Point Index to delay a Burglar Alarm (non-fire) event  
for the time period specified in the Abort Window. An  
alarm is aborted by performing an alarm silence  
operation at a keypad showing the burglar alarm  
condition before this time elapses.  
P### Point Index  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection: 0 to 31  
This entry selects one of the 31 P## Index codes that  
define the point’s characteristics and determines how  
the control panel responds to various point conditions.  
When an alarm is successfully aborted, the keypad  
shows an optional ALARM NOT SENT message and  
no event is sent or written in the control panel event  
log. Refer to CC# Abort Display on page 56.  
A setting of 0 disables the point.  
Missing Point Report  
For SIA CP-01 Compliance:  
If a Point Index is assigned to a point that has an  
incorrect address or that is not connected to the point  
bus, a Missing Point Report occurs.  
P## Alarm Abort can be set to Yes or No.  
When a POPIT is missing, the control panel generates  
the following responses based on the point type:  
This feature does not apply to Fire Alarms  
or invisible point alarms.  
Fire points generate missing trouble responses.  
Non-fire 24-hour points generate missing alarm  
responses.  
Non-fire, non 24-hour points generate missing  
alarm responses while armed, and trouble  
responses while disarmed. Exception: Non-fire,  
non-24-hour points with a point response of 9 to D  
generate a missing alarm response while  
disarmed.  
POPIT modules monitor their sensor loops for three  
conditions: loop normal, loop open, and loop shorted.  
They send reports on these three conditions to the  
control panel. The control panel uses point  
programming to interpret the sensor loop information  
sent by the POPITs and to make the appropriate  
system response.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 3.0 Points  
EN | 102  
Keypad Programming of P### Point Index  
P### Debounce  
D1255  
Default:  
2
1. Refer to Figure 1 on page 7 to access Keypad  
Programming and navigate to the POINT  
PARAMETERS option. The PT NUM 1 - ###  
option shows.  
2. Enter the point number you wish to configure and  
press [ENT].  
Selection:  
1 to 15  
.300 sec  
.600 sec  
.900 sec  
1.2 sec  
1.5 sec  
1.8 sec  
2.1 sec  
2.4 sec  
2.7 sec  
3.0 sec  
3.3 sec  
3.6 sec  
3.9 sec  
4.2 sec  
4.5 sec  
1
2
3
3. The keypad shows the point number and the  
index number (for example, INDEX: 3).  
4. Press [ENT]. An invisable editing cursor is  
enabled for point index number.  
5. The [PREV] button acts as a [Backspace] key.  
Press [PREV] to delete the characters of the  
index number, and then enter the new index  
number.  
4
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
The keypad does not accept invalid index  
numbers.  
6. Press [ENT] to save the changes.  
When the keypad reads PARAMETER SAVED, your  
selection has been configured.  
D1260  
The debounce count is the number of times the  
control panel scans a point before generating an  
alarm. Scan cycles are 300 ms.  
Press [ENT] to save the changes  
1. Refer to Figure 2 on page 8 to access Keypad  
Programming and navigate to the Point  
Parameters option.  
2. Press [ENTER]. The Point Num 1 – 247 (1 – 75  
for a D7412GV3) option shows.  
3. Enter the point number you wish to configure and  
press [ENTER]. The keypad reads Point# Index,  
and then the currently configured index number  
(for example, Point (1) Index: 3).  
For appropriate settings consult the manufacturer’s  
instructions for the device connected to this point.  
Use an entry of two or higher. Interior  
Follower points need a Debounce value  
of at least three.  
4. Press the Edit softkey to change the point index.  
5. The Backspace softkey allows you to erase  
characters. The Clear softkey allows you to clear  
the entire index number. Use the softkeys and  
the number buttons on the keypad to enter the  
new point index number.  
Door points assigned to D9210B modules  
need a Debounce value of at least four.  
6. Press the Save softkey to save the changes.  
When the keypad reads Parameter Saved, your  
selection has been configured.  
P### Area Assign  
Default:  
1
Selection:  
1 to 32 for D9412GV3  
1 to 8 for D7412GV3  
Select the area number to which the point is  
assigned.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 3.0 Points  
EN | 103  
P### Relay  
P### Point Text  
Default: Refer to the program record sheet  
Default:  
Refer to the program record sheet  
Selection: Up to sixteen alphanumeric  
characters  
Selection: 0 to 8  
Use this option to activate a relay when the point is  
faulted. Refer to Table 28.  
Enter alphabetic characters (A to Z) in capital letters.  
Enter up to sixteen characters of text to describe the  
point. This point text is shown at keypads, if the point  
is programmed as visible, and sent to the D6500 or  
D6600 when transmitting in Modem IIIa2 format (if it is  
a reporting point).  
Relays do not activate for Fire  
Supervisory or Non-Fire Supervisory  
points.  
Include the point number in custom point text. This  
helps the user when viewing events, creating  
bypasses, and so on. It can also simplify  
troubleshooting.  
Table 28: P### Relay Codes/Relays  
Faults Relay  
D8129 on  
Zonex Bus 2  
for D9412GV3*  
D8129 on  
Zonex Bus 1  
for D7412GV3*  
Relay Code  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
73  
74  
75  
76  
77  
78  
79  
80  
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
* Address setting = 1 (on), 2 (off), 3 (on), 4 (on)  
Do not assign a relay to Invisible points.  
To avoid activating one of the associated  
relays, program this prompt  
as 0.  
Two relays can activate when this point  
enters into alarm if the P## Relay  
Response Type for this point is  
programmed.  
Use these codes to activate relays on the  
D8129 OctoRelay (or C8137 Transmitter  
Interface). You can assign the same code  
to several points providing a summary  
zone alarm output. When the point enters  
into alarm, the relay activates. When the  
alarm is acknowledged and is no longer  
scrolling in the keypad display, the relay  
resets.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 3.0 Points  
EN | 104  
3.4  
COMMAND 7 and COMMAND 9  
CMD9 Point Index  
Default: 31  
Selection: 0 to 31  
These entries assign point indexes, associated relays  
that activate, and the text for the COMMAND 7 and  
COMMAND 9 keypad functions.  
This entry selects one of the 31 P## Index codes that  
define how the control panel reacts when a  
COMMAND 9 is initiated.  
CMD7 Point Index  
Default:  
31  
The point index code used for  
COMMAND 7 and COMMAND 9 must not  
be used for any other points on the  
system.  
Selection: 0 to 31  
This entry selects one of the 31 P## Index codes that  
define how the control panel reacts when a  
COMMAND 7 is initiated.  
If the point index for COMMAND 9 has  
Fire points programmed as Yes, this  
causes access control doors to unlock if  
Fire Unlock is also programmed as Yes.  
Refer to the D9210B Program Entry  
Guide (P/N: 32207).  
The point index code used for  
COMMAND 7 must not be used for any  
other points on the system.  
If the point index for COMMAND 7 has  
Fire points programmed as Yes, this  
causes access control doors to unlock if  
Fire Unlock is also programmed as Yes.  
Refer to the D9210B Program Entry  
Guide (P/N: 32207).  
CMD9 Relay  
Default:  
1
Selection:  
0 to 8  
This entry selects a relay (73 to 80 on the D9412GV3  
or 9 to 16 on the D7412GV3) when COMMAND 9 is  
initiated (refer to the P### Relay prompt on page 103  
for relay number association).  
CMD7 Relay  
Default:  
1
Selection:  
0 to 8  
This entry selects a relay (73 to 80 for the D9412GV3  
or 9 to 16 for the D7412GV3) when COMMAND 7 is  
initiated (refer to the P### Relay prompt on page  
103 for relay number association).  
COMMAND 9 does not activate the  
Summary Fire Alarm relay.  
CMD9 Point Text  
COMMAND 7 does not activate the  
Summary Fire Alarm relay.  
Default:  
COMMAND 9  
Selection:  
Up to sixteen alphanumeric  
characters  
CMD7 Point Text  
Enter alphabetic characters (A to Z) in capital letters  
Default:  
COMMAND 7  
Enter up to sixteen characters of text to describe the  
point. This point text is displayed at keypads (if the  
point is programmed as visible) and sent to the D6500  
or D6600 when transmitting in Modem IIIa2 format (if it  
is a reporting point).  
Selection: Up to sixteen alphanumeric  
characters  
Enter alphabetic characters A to Z in capital letters  
Enter up to sixteen characters of text to describe the  
point. This point text appears at keypads (if the point  
is programmed as visible) and sent to the D6500 or  
D6600 when transmitting in Modem IIIa2 format (if it is  
a reporting point).  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 Schedules (Skeds)  
EN | 105  
Table 29: Window Selections  
4.0 Schedules (Skeds)  
4.1  
Windows  
Selection Sked  
#
Window Sked # Windo  
w
Use this programming module to define the windows  
for Opening and Closing and User Access.  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
41  
43  
45  
47  
49  
51  
53  
55  
Open  
Open  
Open  
Open  
Open  
Open  
Open  
Open  
42  
44  
46  
48  
50  
52  
54  
56  
Close  
Close  
Close  
Close  
Close  
Close  
Close  
Close  
4.1.1 Opening and Closing  
Use these windows to set a schedule for disarming  
and arming. The disarming and arming schedules  
have several independent features:  
Suppress normal Opening or Closing Reports  
when A# Disable O/C in Windows is  
programmed as Yes.  
Generate a Fail to Open Report if the area is not  
disarmed on schedule when A# Fail To Open is  
programmed as Yes.  
Window  
Provide a warning tone and a PLEASE CLOSE  
NOW display at the keypad when it is time to arm  
the area.  
Default:  
1
Selection: 1 to 8  
Enter the window number you want to program.  
Generate a Fail to Close Report if the area is not  
armed on schedule when A# Fail To Close is  
programmed as Yes.  
W# Sunday  
Automatically arm the area at the end of the  
Closing Window when A# Auto Close is  
programmed as Yes.  
Default:  
Selection:  
Yes  
No  
Yes or No  
Activate this window on Sundays.  
Opening and closing schedules can be set up  
independently. For example, if you want to use  
features provided only by Closing Windows, leave  
times at default (00:00) in the Opening Windows  
prompts and program Closing Window times.  
No  
Do not activate this window on  
Sundays.  
This prompt and the next six day-of-the-week prompts  
select the days of the week the Opening and Closing  
windows are active.  
A worksheet is provided at the end of this section for  
your convenience. Following the worksheet are  
examples of programming Opening and Closing  
Windows for particular applications (refer to Table 33  
on page 111 through Table 37 on page 112).  
Exceptions:  
To prevent the windows from activating on certain  
days of the year, program Xept Holiday as Yes, and  
enable at least one Holiday Index. When Xept  
Holiday is Yes, the window executes on the days of  
the week programmed unless the Holiday Index  
designates the date as a holiday.  
About the program record sheet: A column labeled  
Sked # is found in the program record sheet provided  
with the control panel. The numbers in that column  
appear in D6500 and D6600 reports and local printer  
reports when the window Begin Time executes.  
If Opening and Closing Windows are only needed on  
certain days of the year, do not program the windows  
to execute on any days of the week. Instead, program  
Xept Holiday as No and select a Holiday Index with  
the days of the year you want the window to be active.  
Window selections 1 through 8 correspond with odd-  
numbered Skeds 41 through 55 for Open Window  
and correspond with even numbered Skeds 42  
through 56 for Close Window. For example, when the  
Opening Window for Window 1 executes, a Sked 41  
Executed event is generated. Refer to Table 29.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 Schedules (Skeds)  
EN | 106  
If Disable O/C in Window is set to No and the  
area is disarmed at any time, an Opening Event  
is sent without an Early to Open or Late to Open  
modifier.  
W# Monday  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Disarming the area between the Open Window Start  
and open Window Stop times creates a local event in  
the control panel event log, but does not send the  
Opening Report to the central station.  
W# Tuesday  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Disarming the area between the Open Window Stop  
time and before the next window’s Open Early Begin  
time (or midnight, whichever is earlier) generates an  
Opening Event with a Late to Open modifier.  
W# Wednesday  
Default:  
No  
When configuring multiple windows to operate on the  
same day, ensure that they are added to the system  
in chronological order. For example, if three windows  
are programmed to execute on Tuesday, Window 1  
(W1) must occur before Window 2 (W2), and Window  
2 must occur before Window 3 (W3).  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
W# Thursday  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Avoid programming the Open Early Begin  
time before a time that is between  
another window’s Open Window Start  
and Open Window Stop times.  
W# Friday  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Do not program a window to cross the  
midnight boundary.  
W# Saturday  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Disabled windows have a beginning time of 00:00. If  
the entry for this prompt is 00:00, but times are  
programmed for Open Window Start and Open  
Window Stop, the window is disabled.  
W# Open Early Begin  
Default:  
00:00  
To disable the window, all hours and minutes spaces  
must be 00:00.  
Selection:  
HH:MM (hours and minutes)  
00:00 to 23:59  
Make time entries using a 24-hour clock.  
For example:  
Open Early Begin: This program item is one of three  
required to create an Opening Window. To finish  
programming an Opening Window, Open Window  
Start and Open Window Stop must be programmed.  
Midnight is entered as 00:00  
7:00 AM is entered as 07:00  
2:45 PM is entered as 14:45  
11:59 PM is entered as 23:59  
The time programmed in the W# Open Early Begin  
field is the earliest time that the user is allowed to  
open an area before the Opening Window Start time.  
If Opening and Closing Reports are enabled,  
disarming the area between midnight and the open  
Early Begin time generates an Opening Report.  
Reboot the control panel to activate today’s window,  
if the window needs to activate on the same day you  
program it.  
If A# Disable O/C in Window is set to Yes and  
the area is disarmed between the Open Early  
Begin time and the Open Window Start time, the  
Opening event is sent with an Early to Open  
modifier. If the Open Early Begin time is the  
same as the Open Window Start time, no  
Opening Event is sent.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 Schedules (Skeds)  
EN | 107  
W# Open Window Start  
Make time entries using a 24-hour clock.  
For example:  
Default:  
00: 00  
Midnight is entered as 00:00  
7:00 AM is entered as 07:00  
2:45 PM is entered as 14:45  
11:59 PM is entered as 23:59  
Selection:  
HH:MM (hours and minutes)  
Enter the time you want the control panel to start the  
Opening Window. The window goes into effect at the  
beginning of the minute.  
This program item is one of three required to create  
an Opening Window. To program an Opening  
Window, Open Early Begin and Open Window Start  
must also be programmed.  
Make time entries using a 24-hour clock.  
For example:  
Midnight is entered as 00:00  
7:00 AM is entered as 07:00  
2:45 PM is entered as 14:45  
11:59 PM is entered as 23:59  
If the area is not disarmed by the time the Open  
Window Stop time expires, the control panel  
generates a Fail to Open Report if A# Fail to Open is  
enabled in Area-Wide Parameters.  
This program item is one of three required to create  
an Opening Window. To program an Opening  
Window, Open Early Begin and Open Window Stop  
must also be programmed. Refer to the W# Open  
Early Begin prompt on page 106 for explanations of  
report features.  
Opening Reports generated between the Open  
Window Start time and Open Window Stop time can  
be suppressed by programming A# Disable O/C in  
Window as Yes. Refer to the W# Open Early Begin  
prompt on page 106 for additional explanations of  
report features.  
W# Open Window Stop  
Do not use a time of 23:59 as a window  
stop time unless another window begins  
on the next day at 00:00.  
Default:  
00: 00  
Selection: HH:MM (hours and minutes)  
Fail to Open Reports are not sent for  
windows that stop at 23:59.  
Enter the time you want the control panel to end the  
Opening Window. The window stops at the end of the  
minute.  
Figure 5: Example Opening Window Timeline (using two Opening Windows on same day)  
8
4
1
3
6
9
5
7
2
1 - Areas disarmed between midnight and 6 AM  
generate Opening Reports.  
6 - Areas that are disarmed between 1 PM and 2  
PM generate Early to Open Reports.  
2 - Areas disarmed between 6 AM and 7 AM  
generate Early to Open Reports.  
3 - If the area is disarmed between 7 AM and 8 AM  
regular Opening Reports are generated. If  
Disable O/C in Window is programmed Yes the  
Opening Report is not sent to the central station.  
4 - If the area is not disarmed by 8:01 AM, a Fail to  
Open Event is generated if Fail to Open is  
programmed Yes in Opening and Closing  
Options.  
7 - If the area is disarmed between 2 PM and 3  
PM regular Opening Reports are generated. If  
Disable O/C in Window is programmed Yes,  
the Opening Report is not transmitted to the  
central station.  
8 - If the area is not disarmed by 3:01 PM, a Fail to  
Open Event is generated if Fail to Open is  
programmed Yes in Opening and Closing  
Options.  
9 - If the user disarms the area between 3:01 PM  
and 11:59 PM, a Late to Open Event is  
generated.  
5 - If the user disarms the area between 8:01 AM  
and 12:59, PM a Late to Open Event is  
generated.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 Schedules (Skeds)  
EN | 108  
Table 30: Programming for Two Same Day Opening Windows (refer to Figure 5)  
Open  
Close  
Start  
Early  
Begin  
06: 00  
Early  
Begin  
eXcept On  
Holiday  
Holiday  
Index  
W#  
1
Day of Week  
S M T W T F S  
S M T W T F S  
Area(s)  
Start  
07 : 00  
14 : 00  
Stop  
08: 00  
15 : 00  
Stop  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
1
1
2
2
3
3
4
4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
2
13 : 00  
Do not program a single window to cross the midnight boundary. The window stop time must be later than the  
window start time. To program a window that effectively crosses the midnight boundary, you must program two  
windows.  
For example, to program windows for an area that opens between 11:30 PM and 12:30 AM, five days a week,  
use two windows as shown in Table 31.  
Table 31: Programming to Link Two Days over Midnight*  
Open  
Close  
Start  
Early  
Begin  
22 : 00  
00 : 00  
Early  
Begin  
eXcept On  
Holiday  
Holiday  
Index  
W#  
1
Day of Week  
S M T W T F S  
S M T W T F S  
Area(s)  
Start  
23 : 30  
00 : 00  
Stop  
23 : 59  
00 : 30  
Stop  
Yes No  
Yes No  
1
1
2
2
3
3
4
4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
2
* The setting for midnight is 00:00.  
Arming the area between the Close Window Start  
and Close Window Stop times creates a local event  
in the control panel event log, but does not send the  
Closing Report to the central station.  
W# Close Early Begin  
Default:  
00: 00  
Selection:  
HH:MM (hours and minutes)  
00:00 to 23:59  
Arming the area after the Close Window Stop time  
and before the next window’s Close Early Begin time  
(or midnight, whichever is earlier) generates a  
Closing Event with a Late to Close modifier.  
Close Early Begin: This program item is one of  
three required to create a Closing Window. To finish  
programming a Closing Window, Close Window Start  
and Close Window Stop must be programmed.  
When configuring multiple windows to operate on the  
same day, ensure that they are added to the system  
in chronological order. For example, if three windows  
are programmed to execute on Tuesday, Window 1  
(W1) must occur before Window 2 (W2), and Window  
2 must occur before Window 3 (W3).  
The time programmed in the Close Early Begin field  
is the earliest time the user can close an area before  
the Closing Window Start time. If Opening and  
Closing Reports are enabled, arming the area  
between midnight and the Close Early Begin time  
generates a Closing Report. Additionally:  
Avoid programming the Open Early Begin  
time before a time that is between  
another window’s Open Window Start  
and Open Window Stop times.  
If A# Disable O/C in Window is set to Yes and  
the area is armed between the Close Early Begin  
time and the Close Window Start time, the  
Closing Event is sent with an Early to Close  
modifier. If the Close Early Begin time is the  
same as the Close Window Start time, no Closing  
Event is sent.  
Disabled windows have a beginning time of 00:00. If  
the entry for this prompt is 00:00, but times are  
programmed for Close Window Start and Close  
Window Stop, the window is disabled.  
To disable the window, both the hours and minutes  
spaces must be 00:00.  
If A# Disable O/C in Window is set to No and  
the area is armed at any time, a Closing Event is  
sent without the Early to Close or late to Close  
modifiers.  
00:00 is midnight, 23:59 is 11:59 PM. Make entries  
using a 24-hour clock (for example, 7:00 AM is  
entered as 07:00, 2:45 PM is entered as 14:45).  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 Schedules (Skeds)  
EN | 109  
If the window must activate on the same day as it is  
programmed, reboot the control panel to activate the  
window immediately.  
W# Close Window Stop  
Default: 00: 00  
W# Close Window Start  
Selection: HH:MM (hours and minutes)  
Enter the time that you want the control panel to end  
the Closing Window. The window stops at the end of  
the minute.  
Default:  
00: 00  
Selection:  
HH:MM (hours and minutes)  
Enter the time that you want the control panel to start  
the Closing Window. The window goes into effect at  
the beginning of the minute.  
00:00 is midnight, 23:59 is 11:59 PM. Make entries  
using a 24-hour clock (for example, 7:00 AM is  
entered as 07:00, 2:45 PM is entered as 14:45).  
00:00 is midnight, 23:59 is 11:59 PM. Make entries  
using a 24-hour clock (for example, 7:00 AM is  
entered as 07:00, 2:45 PM is entered as 14:45).  
This program item is one of three required to create a  
Closing Window. To program a Closing Window,  
Close Early Begin and Close Window Start must also  
be programmed.  
This program item is one of three required to create a  
Closing Window. To program a Closing Window,  
Close Early Begin and Close Window Stop must also  
be programmed.  
If the area is not armed by the time the Close  
Window Stop time expires, the control panel  
generates a Fail to Close Report if enabled in Fail To  
Close.  
If the area is not armed when the Close Window Start  
time comes, a warning tone sounds and PLEASE  
CLOSE NOW appears at the keypad. To temporarily  
silence the tone, press the [ESC] key on the keypad.  
The warning tone restarts in 10 min if the area is not  
armed.  
Closing Reports generated between the Close  
Window Start time and Close Window Stop time can  
be suppressed by programming Disable O/C in  
Window as Yes. Refer to the W# Close Early Begin  
prompt for other explanations of report features.  
Refer to the W# Close Early Begin prompt in this  
section for explanations of report features.  
Do not use a time of 23:59 as a window stop time  
unless the window continues on the next day at  
00:00. Fail to Close Reports are not sent, and the  
Auto Close feature does not work for windows that  
stop at 23:59.  
Do not program a single window to cross the  
midnight boundary. The window stop time must be  
later than the window start time. To program a  
window that effectively crosses the midnight  
boundary, you must program two windows.  
For example, to program windows for an area that  
closes between 11:30 PM and 12:30 AM, five days a  
week, use two windows as shown in Table 32.  
Table 32: Programming Example: Linking Two Closing Windows over Midnight  
Open  
Close  
Start  
eXcept  
On  
Holiday  
W
#
Early  
Begin  
Early  
Begin  
Holiday  
Index  
Day of Week  
S M T W T F S  
S M T W T F S  
Area(s)  
Start  
Stop  
Stop  
1
2
22 : 00  
00 : 00  
23 : 30 23 : 59  
00 : 00 00 : 30  
Yes No  
Yes No  
1
1
2
2
3
3
4
4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 Schedules (Skeds)  
EN | 110  
W# Xept Holiday  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
W# Holiday 1  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
Do not activate this window on  
holidays.  
Yes  
Use Holiday Index 1 with this  
window.  
To use this selection, the window  
must be programmed to activate on  
at least one day of the week and a  
Holiday Index must be enabled.  
No  
Do not use Holiday Index 1 with this  
window.  
W# Holiday 2  
No  
A holiday does not prevent this  
window from activating.  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
You also use this selection if  
Yes  
No  
Use Holiday Index 2 with this window.  
Opening or Closing Windows are  
needed only on certain days of the  
year. Do not program the windows to  
execute on any days of the week.  
Instead, program Xept Holiday as  
No, and select at least one Holiday  
Index with the days of the year you  
want the window to be active.  
Do not use Holiday Index 2 with this  
window.  
W# Holiday 3  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Determine if the window is disabled on holidays, or is  
active only on holidays.  
Yes  
No  
Use Holiday Index 3 with this window.  
Do not use Holiday Index 3 with this  
window.  
To prevent the windows from activating on certain  
days of the year, program Xept Holiday as Yes, and  
enable at least one Holiday Index. When Xept  
Holiday is programmed as Yes, the window  
executes on the days of the week programmed  
unless the date is designated as a Holiday by the  
Holiday Index(es) selected.  
W# Holiday 4  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
Use Holiday Index 4 with this window.  
Holiday Indexes for O/C Windows  
Do not use Holiday Index 4 with this  
window.  
You can enable up to four Holiday Indexes for use  
with Opening/Closing Windows. Enable at least one  
Holiday Index if W# Xept Holiday is programmed as  
Yes for this window, or if you want this window to  
activate only on specific dates. Holidays are  
programmed in Section 4.3 Holiday Indexes on page  
124.  
W# Area 1 [through 8]  
Default:  
Selection:  
Yes  
No  
Yes or No  
Activate the window in the area  
number (#) specified.  
No  
Disable the window in the area  
number (#) specified.  
Eight separate program items determine whether a  
particular window activates in each of the eight areas  
of the control panel.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 Schedules (Skeds)  
EN | 111  
Table 33: Opening and Closing Windows Worksheet  
Open  
Close  
Start  
eXcept  
On  
Holiday  
Holiday  
Index  
Early  
Begin  
Early  
Begin  
W#  
1
Day of Week  
S M T W T F S  
S M T W T F S  
S M T W T F S  
S M T W T F S  
S M T W T F S  
S M T W T F S  
S M T W T F S  
S M T W T F S  
Area(s)  
Start  
Stop  
Stop  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _ _ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _ _ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _ _ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _ _ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _ _ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _ _ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _ _ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _ _ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
Yes No  
Yes No  
Yes No  
Yes No  
Yes No  
Yes No  
Yes No  
Yes No  
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Table 34: Opening and Closing Windows  
The column below briefly describes how  
to activate an Opening—Closing  
Window.  
Use the guidelines shown in the other  
columns to choose the appropriate  
entries.  
eXcept  
On  
Holiday  
Holiday  
Index  
Day of Week  
Areas  
Program at least Day(s) of the week  
No  
None  
Program at least  
one day Yes.  
one area Yes.  
Program at least Day(s) of the week, but not on holidays  
one day Yes.  
Yes  
Select at  
least one  
Index  
Program at least  
one area Yes.  
Program at least Day(s) of the Week, plus holidays  
one day Yes.  
No  
No  
Select at  
least one  
Index  
Select at  
least one  
Index  
Program at least  
one area Yes.  
All days must be Only on holidays  
programmed No.  
Program at least  
one area Yes.  
Table 35: Normal Store Hours*  
Open  
Close  
eXcept  
On  
Holiday  
Early  
Begin  
04: 00  
Early  
Begin  
20: 00  
00: 00  
Holiday  
Index  
W#  
1
Day of Week  
S M T W T F S  
S M T W T F S  
Area(s)  
Start  
05 : 00  
Stop  
06: 00  
Start  
23 : 00  
00 : 00  
Stop  
23: 59  
01 : 00  
Yes No  
Yes No  
1
1
2
2
3
3
4
4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
2
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
* Monday to Friday, Opening between 5 AM and 6 AM. Closing between 11 PM and 1 AM.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 Schedules (Skeds)  
EN | 112  
Table 36: Delivery Schedule*  
Open  
Close  
eXcept  
On  
Early  
Begin  
Early  
Holiday  
Index  
W#  
Day of Week  
Holiday  
Area(s)  
Start  
Stop  
Begin  
Start  
Stop  
S M T W T F S  
3
02 : 30  
02 : 45  
03 : 00  
03 : 05  
03: 15  
03: 30  
Yes No  
1
2
2
3
3
4
4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
00 : 00 01 : 00 Yes No  
Day(s) of the week, but not on holidays Yes  
1
Program at least  
one day Yes.  
Select at  
least one  
index  
Program at least  
one area Yes.  
* Monday and Wednesday, In between 2:45 AM and 3:00 AM. Out between 3:15 AM and 3:30 AM.  
Another alternative for delivery schedules is to automatically bypass specific points using skeds.  
Table 37: Monthly Auditor’s Schedule*  
Open  
Close  
eXcept  
On  
Early  
Begin  
Early  
Holiday  
Index  
W#  
Day of Week  
Holiday  
Area(s)  
Start  
Stop  
Begin  
Start  
Stop  
S M T W T F S  
4
07 : 00  
08 : 00  
08 : 30  
14 : 00  
14: 30  
17: 00  
Yes No  
1
2
3
4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
All days must be  
programmed No.  
Only on holidays  
No  
Select at  
least one  
index  
Program at least  
one area Yes.  
* Sunday, In between 8:00 AM and 8:30 AM. Out between 2:30 PM and 5:00 PM..  
4.1.2 User Group Windows  
User Windows #  
In this section, you can create up to eight User Group  
periods where the passcodes for the group chosen is  
enabled. One user group can have multiple windows  
assigned to it over a 24-hour period. Refer to the  
U### User Group prompt in Section 2.1 Passcode or  
Token Worksheet to assign individuals to a group.  
Default:  
1
Selection:  
1 to 8  
Enter the User Windows number you want to  
program.  
When you assign a U### User Group to one of the  
eight windows, all passcodes for the group are  
enabled ONLY for the period between the Enable  
Time and Disable Time for assigned User Windows  
#.  
UW# User Group  
Default:  
1
Selection:  
0 to 8  
Enter the number programmed for the group of users  
in the U### User Group prompt. This group has its  
user passcodes enabled or disabled when this  
window runs.  
If a user is not assigned to a U### User Group or  
the number programmed for the user for U### User  
Group is not assigned to a User Windows #, the  
passcode for that user is enabled all the time.  
A User Group can be assigned to more  
than one window in a 24-hour period, but  
the windows must not overlap or exceed  
the midnight boundary.  
User Group Windows do not affect the  
users token or card access authority. To  
enable/disable tokens, the Sked Function  
Access Levels On/Off must be used.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 Schedules (Skeds)  
EN | 113  
UW# Sunday  
UW# Group Enable  
Default:  
No  
Default:  
00:00  
HH:MM (hours and minutes)  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Selection:  
This prompt, and the next six day of the week  
prompts, select the days of the week that the User  
Group Window is active.  
This prompt must be programmed if this  
User Group Window is assigned to a user  
group.  
Refer to the W# Sunday prompt in  
Section 4.1.1 Opening and Closing on  
page 105 for more information about  
programming this prompt.  
Enter the time of day when the window starts.  
Beginning at this time, users assigned to this  
window’s group can use their passcodes. The window  
goes into effect at the beginning of the minute. Make  
entries using a 24-hour clock (for example, 7:00 AM is  
entered as 07:00, 2:45 PM is entered as 14:45).  
UW# Monday  
Default:  
No  
If the window must activate on the same day that you  
program it, reboot the control panel to activate it  
immediately.  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
UW# Tuesday  
Default:  
No  
Yes or No  
UW# Group Disable  
Selection:  
Default:  
00:00  
UW# Wednesday  
Selection:  
HH:MM (hours and minutes)  
Default:  
No  
This prompt must be programmed if this  
User Group Window is assigned to a user  
group.  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
UW# Thursday  
Enter the time of day when the window ends. This  
time marks the end of the period in which users  
assigned to this window’s group can use their  
passcodes. The window stops at the end of the  
minute. Make entries using a 24-hour clock (for  
example, 7:00 AM is entered as 07:00, 2:45 PM is  
entered as 14:45).  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
UW# Friday  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
To disable the window, set the time to the default  
(00:00).  
UW# Saturday  
Do not program a single window to cross the midnight  
boundary. The window stop time must be later than  
the window start time.  
Default:  
No  
Yes or No  
Selection:  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 Schedules (Skeds)  
EN | 114  
Each sked can be programmed with up to four  
Holiday Indexes. The Holiday Indexes can execute  
the sked on the holidays as well as on the date or  
day(s) of the week, or, they can prevent the sked from  
executing on the holidays (refer to S## Xept Holiday  
prompt in this section).  
4.1.3 Holiday Indexes for User Group Windows  
You can enable up to four Holiday Indexes to use with  
User Group Windows. Enable at least one Holiday  
Index if UW# Xept Holiday is programmed as Yes for  
this user window, or if you want this window to  
activate only on specific dates. Holidays are  
programmed in Holiday Indexes. Refer to Section 4.3  
Holiday Indexes on page 124 for programming  
information.  
Sked Number  
Default:  
1
Selection:  
1 to 40  
UW# Xept Holiday  
Enter the number of the sked you are programming.  
Default:  
No  
S## TimeEdit  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Determine if the window is disabled on holidays, or is  
active only on holidays. Use the instructions provided  
in the W# Xept Holiday prompt on page 110.  
Default:  
Selection:  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes or No  
The user can edit the time of this  
sked from the keypad and  
UW# Holiday 1 [through 4]  
determines if this sked appears in  
the CHG SKED display.  
Default:  
Selection:  
Yes  
No  
Yes or No  
No  
The user cannot edit the time of this  
sked from the keypad and the sked  
does not appear in the CHG SKED  
display.  
The selected holiday index can be  
used by users in the User Group  
window.  
Select whether the user can edit the time of this sked  
from the keypad.  
No  
The selected holiday index does not  
apply to users in this User Group.  
4.2  
Schedules (Skeds)  
S## Function Code  
Use the Skeds module to program the control panel to  
automatically execute functions that are otherwise  
started by the end user at the keypad. Each sked can  
be programmed to occur at a specific time on a  
specific date or day of the week. Up to 40 Skeds can  
be programmed.  
RPS automatically retrieves the appropriate sub-  
menu when the user enters a function code. Refer to  
the following examples:  
Example 1: When Function Code 1 (Arm Area) is  
entered, the S## Area 1 [through #] prompt  
appears.  
A sked can be edited from the keypad if S## Time  
Edit? is Yes. The date and time can be changed  
using the Change Sked function.  
Example 2: When Function Code 3 (Bypass a  
Point) is entered, the S## Point Number prompt  
appears.  
Each sked number can be programmed with one of  
24 functions for the S## Function Code. In addition  
to the function, a choice must be made as to what is  
affected by the function. For example, when choosing  
Function 2 (Disarm Sked), the disarming is the  
After you program the parameter choices associated  
with the Sked function, program the sked for date, day  
of week, time, or holiday.  
function and the selected areas are what is affected.  
The functions and their associated parameters are  
listed in the Sked Function Code Table in the  
D9412GV/D7412GV3 Program Record Sheet  
(P/N: F01U170809), and they are explained in detail  
following the S## Function Code prompt on page  
114.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 Schedules (Skeds)  
EN | 115  
Default:  
0
Selection: 0 to 24, 28, 29  
Arm Area: This function simulates  
the Master Arm Delay keypad  
function. Entries in the S## Area #  
prompts define the area(s) this sked  
arms. The sked can arm multiple  
areas. If any point is faulted when the  
sked executes, it is force armed  
regardless of the A# Force Arm  
Bypass Max setting.  
1
Yes  
No  
Arm Area #.  
Default: No  
Do not arm  
Area #.  
Selections: Yes or No  
Enable the sked to arm the  
areas indicated with Yes.  
Disarm Area: This function emulates  
the DISARM #? or DISARM ALL?  
keypad function list options. Entries in  
the S## Area # prompts define the  
area(s) this sked disarms. The sked  
can disarm multiple areas.  
2
3
Yes  
No  
Disarm Area #.  
Default: No  
Do not disarm  
Area #.  
Selection: Yes or No  
Enable the sked to disarm the  
areas indicated with Yes.  
Bypass a Point: This function  
emulates the Bypass Pt? keypad  
function. The entry in the S## Point  
Number prompt defines the point this  
sked bypasses. The point can be  
bypassed only if Bypassable is  
programmed Yes in the point index  
assigned to the point. The bypass is  
reported if the Bypass Reports is  
enabled by the point index settings  
assigned to the point. The sked can  
bypass one point.  
Blank (0)  
No point is  
bypassed  
1 to 127,  
129 to  
247  
Default: Blank  
Point to bypass  
Selections: Blank, 1 to 127,  
129 to 247 for D9412GV3,  
1 to 75 for D7412GV3  
Enter the number of the point  
the sked bypasses.  
Unbypass a Point: This function  
emulates the Unbypass Pt? keypad  
function. The entry in the S## Point  
Number prompt defines the point this  
sked unbypasses. The sked can  
unbypass one point.  
4
Blank (0)  
No point is  
unbypassed.  
1 to 127,  
129 to  
247  
Default: Blank  
Point to  
unbypass.  
Selections: Blank, 1 to 127,  
129 to 247 for D9412GV3,  
1 to 75 for D7412GV3  
Enter the number of the point  
the sked unbypasses.  
(Continued on next page.)  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 Schedules (Skeds)  
EN | 116  
Default:  
0
Selection: 0 to 24, 28, 29  
Unbypass All Points: This function  
is not available as a keypad function.  
The entry in the S## Area # prompt  
defines the area(s) where the sked  
unbypasses all points. The sked  
unbypasses all points in the area,  
regardless of how they were  
Yes  
No  
5
Unbypass all  
points in Area #.  
Default: No  
Do not  
unbypass all  
points in  
Area #.  
Selection: Yes or No  
Select Yes to unbypass all  
points in the areas indicated.  
bypassed. This sked can unbypass  
all points in multiple areas.  
Relay On: This function emulates  
the Change Relay keypad function to  
turn relays on. The entry in the S##  
Relay Number prompt defines the  
specific relay this sked activates.  
The sked can activate one relay.  
6
Blank  
No relay is  
activated.  
Default: Blank  
1 to 128  
Relay to  
activate.  
Selections: Blank,  
1 to 128 for D9412GV3,  
1 to 64 for D7412GV3  
Enter the number of the relay  
the sked activates  
Relay Off: This function emulates  
the Change Relay? keypad function  
to turn relays off. The entry in the  
S## Relay Number prompt defines  
the relay this sked turns off. The  
sked can turn off only relays that are  
set by a sked. The sked can turn off  
one relay.  
7
Blank  
No relay is  
turned off.  
Default: Blank  
1 to 128  
Relay to turn off.  
Selections: Blank,  
1 to 128 for D9412GV3,  
1 to 64 for D7412GV3  
Enter the number of the relay  
that turns the sked off.  
8
All Relays Off: This function is not available as a keypad function. This sked function turns off all  
relays that are turned on by a sked. This is a panel-wide function.  
No other parameters require input for this option.  
(Continued on next page.)  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 Schedules (Skeds)  
EN | 117  
Default:  
0
Selection: 0 to 24, 28, 29  
Test Report: This function emulates  
the Test Report? sub-function of the  
Send Report? keypad function  
([COMMAND][4][1]). This function  
generates a Test Report only from  
Area 1 but contains panel-wide status  
information. The report is sent to the  
phone(s) programmed for Test and  
Status Reports in Section 2.3.8  
9
Yes  
No  
Defer the Test  
Report.  
Default: No  
Send the Test  
Report on  
schedule.  
Selection: Yes or No  
Enable sked to defer the Test  
Report  
Yes  
No  
Send the Test  
Report every hour.  
Communication Attempts on page 18.  
Default: No  
Send the Test  
Report only as  
scheduled.  
If Expand Test Report in Phone  
parameters is programmed as Yes,  
the Test Report also includes all off-  
normal states for events listed in Test  
Reports (refer to Table 12 on page  
23) and some events listed in  
Selection: Yes or No  
Select Yes to send the Test  
Report every hour.  
Diagnostic Reports (refer to the  
footnotes with Table 13 on page 24)  
The Test Report can be deferred if  
any other report was sent since the  
last Test Report. To defer the Test  
Report, program S## Defer Test.  
The Test Report can be sent every  
hour beginning at the time scheduled  
in S## Time. To send a Test Report  
every hour, program S## Hourly  
Report.  
To meet UL 864  
requirements, use the  
Sked function to meet the  
daily Test Report  
requirement.  
Status Report: This function  
10  
Yes  
No  
Defer the Status  
Report.  
generates a Status Report for each  
area that is enabled. The report is  
sent to the phone(s) programmed for  
Test and Status Reports in Routing.  
Default: No  
Send the Status  
Report on  
schedule.  
Selection: Yes or No  
Enable sked to defer the  
Status Report.  
The Status Report can be deferred if  
any other report was sent since the  
last Status Report. To defer the  
Status Report, program S## Defer  
Status.  
(Continued on next page.)  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 Schedules (Skeds)  
EN | 118  
Default:  
0
Selection:  
0 to 24, 28, 29  
11  
Execute Custom Func: This  
function emulates any of the custom  
functions assigned to the keypad  
that can be executed by a user from  
the keypad. When a sked executes  
a custom function, it is subject to  
the scope of the selected keypad.  
Cmd Center and Custom Func  
prompts appear after entering  
Function Code 11. Both entries are  
required.  
Blank  
(0)  
No keypad is  
specified for  
Custom Function  
activation.  
Default: Blank (0)  
Selections: Blank (0), 1 to 8  
Identify the specific keypad  
(CC #) where the Custom  
Function is entered. Only one  
keypad can be assigned for  
this sked function.  
1 to 8  
Command center  
(keypad) address  
specified for  
Custom Function  
activation.  
Blank  
(0)  
No Custom  
Function is  
activated.  
Default: Blank (0)  
Selections: Blank (0),  
128 to 143 for D9412GV3,  
128 to 131 for D7412GV3  
128 to  
143  
Custom Function  
to activate.  
Enter the custom function this  
sked executes.  
12  
Contact RPS: This function  
attempts to contact an Unattended  
RPS at the configured time. The  
control panel’s account in RPS  
controls the operations performed  
upon successful contact.  
Avoid having multiple functions occur at the same time at the same address. Functions can clash  
and the effect on the control panel is unpredictable.  
Ensure that the Custom Function being executed or any of the commands nested inside the  
Custom Function are not passcode protected.  
Do not program multiple skeds to execute at the same keypad during the same time.  
Do not program skeds to execute at times when a user is likely to be executing functions at the  
keypad. If it is necessary to do so, there are two ways to work around the situation:  
1. For a D1255 keypad type, program "C","C"at the beginning of the Custom Function Key  
Strokes entry. This aborts the user’s function and allows the sked to execute.  
2. Program the sked to execute at an address (Cmd Center) with no keypad physically attached to  
it. The CC # must be assigned to an area and have the appropriate scope programmed.  
(Continued on next page.)  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 Schedules (Skeds)  
EN | 119  
Default:  
0
Selection:  
0 to 24, 28, 29  
13  
Adjust Time Forward One Hour: This sked function is used to make adjustments to the control  
panel’s clock. A typical application is to program this to go into effect at 2:00 AM on the date that  
Daylight Saving Time begins (during the springtime). No Time Change Report is sent or logged, but the  
new time appears in the next report logged.  
No other parameters require input for this option.  
14  
Adjust Time Backward One Hour: This sked function is used to make adjustments to the control  
panel’s clock. A typical application is to program this to go into effect at 2:00 AM on the date that  
Daylight Saving Time ends (during the fall). This function can operate only once in a day, even if  
multiple Skeds with this function are programmed. No Time Change Report is sent or logged, but the  
new time appears in the next report logged.  
There are no other parameters that require input for this option.  
Sound Watch Tone at  
15  
Yes Watch tone  
sounds at this  
keypad.  
Command Center (Keypad): This  
function sounds the Watch Tone  
at the keypad address  
programmed in Parameter 1. The  
Watch Tone sounds at all  
keypads with the address  
programmed. Press [ESC] to  
silence the tone.  
Default: Blank  
Selection: Yes or No  
Watch tone does  
not sound at this  
keypad.  
No  
Enable the sked to beep the keypad  
programmed Yes.  
Sound Watch Tone defines the  
keypad address where the Watch  
Tone sounds. Enter the specific  
address at the S## Cmd Center  
prompt.  
Access Control Level On: This  
function emulates the ACCESS  
CMD LEVEL command that  
determines whether a user’s  
token or card level is ENABLED?,  
allowing access granted rights.  
This affects all doors that this  
user is assigned to with this  
specific authority level.  
16  
Yes Enable Access  
Default: No  
Control Level #  
Selection: Yes or No  
Do not enable  
Access Control  
Level #.  
No  
Activate a sked, which enables the  
Access Level(s) 1 through 14 with  
Yes.  
The D9412GV3 supports eight doors; the D7412GV3 supports two doors.  
To regulate a user’s access for certain doors, assign the user a different authority level # with the same authority functions  
enabled. For example, a user can be assigned Authority Level 1 for Door 1 and Authority Level 2 for the remaining doors.  
You can enable or disable Authority Level 1 for Door 1 without affecting his authority level for Doors 2 through 8).  
(Continued on next page.)  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 Schedules (Skeds)  
EN | 120  
Default:  
0
Selection: 0 to 24, 28, 29  
Access Control Level Off:  
This function emulates the  
ACCESS CMD LEVEL  
command that determines  
whether a user’s token or card  
level is disabled. This function  
allows access to be turned off  
for the levels programmed.  
17  
Yes  
No  
Turn off access for  
level #.  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Do not turn off  
access for level #.  
The first parameter enables the sked  
to turn off access for Levels 1 through  
14.  
Unlock Door: This function  
emulates the UNLOCK?  
12345678 keypad function for  
unlocking a door.  
18  
19  
Yes  
No  
Unlock Door #.  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Do not unlock  
Door #.  
Enable the sked to unlock the doors  
programmed Yes.  
Secure Door: This function  
emulates the SECURE?  
12345678 keypad function for  
securing a door.  
Yes  
No  
Secure Door #.  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Do not secure  
Door #.  
Enable the sked to return the doors  
programmed Yes to the secured  
state.  
Lock Door: This function  
returns an unlocked (Function  
18) or secured (Function 19)  
door to a normal locked door  
state.  
20  
21  
Yes  
No  
Lock Door #.  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Do not lock Door  
#.  
Enable the sked to lock the doors  
programmed as Yes and return them  
to the normal Door Mode.  
Access Authority Events  
On: The control panel can log  
Access Granted Events when  
a valid token, RTE, REX, or  
Unlock Door event is detected  
for a specific door. These  
events can be directed to print  
at a local printer or send a  
report remotely through phone  
routing. This sked enables  
Access Granted Events to be  
reported for Door #.  
Yes  
No  
Enable the  
sending of Access  
Granted Events  
for Door #.  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Do not enable the  
sending of Access  
Granted Events  
for Door #.  
This parameter enables the sending  
of Access Granted Events for Door #.  
(Continued on next page.)  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 Schedules (Skeds)  
EN | 121  
Default:  
0
Selection: 0 to 24, 28, 29  
Access Authority Events  
Off: The control panel can log  
Access Granted Events when  
a valid token, RTE, REX, or  
Unlock Door Event is detected  
for a specific door. These  
events can be directed to print  
at a local printer or send a  
report remotely through phone  
routing. This sked disables  
Access Granted Events to be  
reported for Door #.  
22  
Yes  
No  
Disable the  
Default: No  
sending of Access  
Granted Events  
for Door #.  
Selection: Yes or No  
This parameter disables the sending  
of Access Granted Events for Door #.  
Do not disable the  
sending of Access  
Granted Events  
for Door #.  
No Entry Events On: The  
control panel can log No Entry  
Events when an invalid token  
is detected for a specific door.  
No Entry Events include No  
Entry-Secured, No Entry-  
Interlock, No Entry-Unknown  
ID, and No Entry-Level. These  
events can be directed to print  
at a local printer or send a  
report remotely through phone  
routing. This sked enables No  
Entry Events to be reported for  
Door #.  
23  
Yes  
No  
Enable the  
sending of No  
Entry Events for  
Door #.  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Do not enable the  
sending of No  
Entry Events for  
Door #.  
This parameter enables the sending  
of No Entry Events for Door #.  
No Entry Events Off: The  
control panel can log No Entry  
Events when an invalid token  
is detected for a specific door.  
No Entry Events include No  
Entry-Secured, No Entry-  
Interlock, No Entry-Unknown  
ID, and No Entry-Level. These  
events can be directed to print  
at a local printer or send a  
report remotely through phone  
routing. This sked disables No  
Entry Events to be reported for  
Door #.  
24  
Yes  
No  
Enable the  
reporting of No  
Entry Events for  
Door #.  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Do not enable the  
reporting of No  
Entry Events for  
Door #.  
This parameter disables the sending  
of No Entry Events for Door #.  
28  
Expanded Off-Normal Test Report: To generate this event, one or more points must be in an off-  
normal state at the time the sked executes. In addition, any system trouble that is active also  
generates an Expanded Off-Normal Test Report. Expanded Off-Normal Test Reports include the Off  
Normal Test Report Event as well as the supplementary event at the time the report is generated.  
The Event Log shows only a Test Report Event.  
If none of these conditions exists at the time the sked executes, only a Sked Executed Event is  
generated and the Off-Normal Test Report is not sent.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 Schedules (Skeds)  
EN | 122  
29  
Non-Expanded Off-Normal Test Report: Non-Expanded Off-Normal Test Report Events are only  
sent when any point is in the off-normal state from any area, but only sends the Off Normal Test  
Report Event. Any system trouble that is active also generates a Non-Expanded Off-Normal Test  
Report.  
The Event Log only shows a Test Report Event.  
If none of these conditions exist at the time the sked executes, only a Sked Executed Event is  
generated and the Non-Expanded Off-Normal Test Report is not sent.  
To meet UL 864 daily Test Report requirements (when using two phone lines), you must still use  
Sked Function Code 9, Test Report and program it to occur on a daily basis as per AHJ  
requirements.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 Schedules (Skeds)  
EN | 123  
S## Monday  
S## Time  
Default:  
No  
Default:  
00:00  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Selection: HH:MM (hours and minutes)  
Enter the time that the sked executes. Make entries  
using a 24-hour clock (for example, 7:00 AM is  
entered as 07:00, 2:45 PM is entered as 14:45).  
S## Tuesday  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Disabled skeds can have their time set to Disabled;  
however, to ensure that a sked is fully disabled, enter  
[COMMAND][5][2] (Change Skeds function) and  
select DISABLE?.  
S## Wednesday  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
S## Date  
S## Thursday  
Default:  
_ _ / _ _  
Selection: MM/DD (month and date)  
Default:  
No  
Enter the date that the sked executes.  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Disabled skeds have their date set to Disabled. If  
you receive from the control panel and the entry for  
this prompt is Disabled, but dates were programmed  
before, the sked can be disabled from the keypad  
using the Change Skeds function.  
S## Friday  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
S## Saturday  
S## Sunday  
Default:  
No  
Default:  
Selection:  
Yes  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes or No  
Activate this sked on Sundays.  
S## Xept Holiday  
No  
Do not activate this sked on  
Sundays.  
Default:  
Selection:  
Yes  
No  
Yes or No  
This prompt and the next six prompts select the days  
of the week when the sked is active.  
Prevent this sked from operating on  
the holidays identified in the specific  
Holiday Index(es) used with this  
sked. Specific Holiday Indexes are  
selected in this programming section  
and programmed in the next  
Exceptions:  
To prevent the sked from activating on certain days  
of the year, program Xept Holiday as Yes, and  
enable at least one Holiday Index. When Xept  
Holiday is programmed as Yes, the window  
executes on the days of the week programmed  
unless the date is designated as a holiday by the  
Holiday Index selected.  
programming module.  
No  
This sked operates on holidays  
programmed in the Holiday  
Index(es) used with this sked.  
If a sked is only needed on certain days of the year,  
do not program the sked to execute on specific days  
of the week. Instead, program Xept Holiday as No,  
and select a Holiday Index with the dates you want  
the window to be active.  
If no days of the week are programmed, this sked  
operates only on the holidays programmed in the  
Holiday Index(es) used with this sked. This sked also  
operates if the holiday falls on a day of the week that  
is programmed.  
To meet UL 864 requirements for  
Central Station and Remote Station  
applications, program each day of the  
week to Yes for the required Test  
Report Sked.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide |  
EN | 124  
S## Holiday #  
4.3  
Holiday Indexes  
Default:  
None  
This programming module has two sections:  
Add/Change/Delete and View Holidays. Use the  
Add/Change/Delete section to program the Holiday  
Indexes. The View Holidays section is a view-only  
section provided for your convenience. Use View  
Holidays to review the dates programmed in the  
Holiday Indexes.  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
Use Holiday Index 1 with this sked.  
Do not use Holiday Index 1 with this  
sked.  
4.3.1 Add/Change/Delete  
Program the dates for each of the Holiday Indexes.  
You can program up to four Holiday Indexes in the  
control panel. Within each index, you can select up to  
365 dates to be designated as holidays.  
The Holiday Indexes function independently of each  
other. The same day can be programmed in all four  
schedules. Holiday Indexes are used in programming  
O/C Windows, User Access Windows, and skeds.  
Date  
Default:  
_ _ / _ _  
Selection:  
MM/DD (month and date)  
This entry selects the month and day you are  
designating as a holiday.  
To delete the date completely, select No for all of the  
Holiday Index # entries.  
Holiday Index #  
Default:  
None  
Selection:  
Select Dates from the Calendar  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 AUXPARM  
EN | 125  
5.3  
SDI Automation  
5.0 AUXPARM  
SDI automation defines the characteristics of a serial  
interface module (SIM) when used with home or  
business automation software. The SIM is a two-way  
SDI to a serial communication module that allows the  
control panels to send and receive information to and  
from an external software program.  
5.1  
Introduction  
The programming prompts in this section are  
primarily used for programming enhanced  
communication capabilities for the GV3 Series  
Control Panels.  
The SIM can be a D9133, DX4010i, or  
DX4020 (configured to emulate serial  
communication).  
Enhanced communications is the ability to provide  
communication functions for the control panels over  
SDI. These communication methods include:  
A DX4010i can be used only for  
programming.  
Routing control panel events through a network  
interface module (NIM). A network interface  
module (NIM) can be a DX4020 or an ITS-  
DX4020-G.  
This automation protocol allows external software  
programs to interact and perform functions such as:  
Communicating with remote programming  
software (RPS) using a (NIM).  
arming and disarming areas,  
changing user passcodes and names, and  
turning relays on and off.  
Communicating with a remote or local automation  
software package.  
The items described in this section allow some  
simple configuration options. To receive the SIM  
automation protocol; however, you must contact  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. Technical Support at  
(888) 886-6189.  
5.2  
RPS Requirements  
The AUXPARM section currently has seven sections:  
SDI Automation  
SDI RPS Parameters  
Enhanced Communications  
Enable SDI Auto  
Default:  
Selection:  
Yes  
No  
SDI RPS/Enhanced Communication  
Configuration  
Yes or No  
Miscellaneous  
Enable Automation software.  
Disable Automation software.  
Cross Point Parameters  
Route Group Rate  
No  
Changing this item to Yes enables the automation  
address (SDI Address 80).  
Supervise SDI 80  
Default:  
Selection:  
Yes  
No  
Yes or No  
Supervise the serial interface  
module (SIM).  
No  
Do not supervise the serial interface  
module (SIM).  
This item determines whether the serial interface  
module (SIM) is supervised or not. If the SIM is  
supervised, disconnecting the SIM from the control  
panel creates a Trouble SDI 80 Event and the  
keypad annunciates a trouble tone (if programmed)  
and displays SERVC SDI 80.  
Trouble SDI 80 Reports are always sent  
using the account number for Area 1.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 AUXPARM  
EN | 126  
Status Rate  
5.4  
SDI RPS Parameters  
Default:  
Selection:  
0
0
Configure remote programming software (RPS)  
parameters when communicating over a private local-  
area network (LAN), wide-area network (WAN), or  
general packet radio system (GPRS). To allow RPS  
to communicate with a control panel over a LAN or  
WAN, an SDI-Ethernet network interface module  
(NIM) and RPS (version 5.13 or higher) are required.  
The computer on which RPS is installed needs a  
network card. See your information systems  
0 to 255  
Status information is sent only when  
requested.  
1 to 255  
Status information is sent at the  
interval programmed.  
If the Status Rate is set to a value less  
than 10, and 1 to 6 SDI devices are  
connected to the system, the fastest the  
control panel can send the status  
information is in approximately 1 sec. If  
more than six SDI devices are connected  
to the control panel, the fastest the  
control panel can send the information is  
in approximately 1.5 sec to 2 sec.  
administrator for network requirements.  
This section allows you to:  
Provide for local programming by a DX4010V2  
Serial Interface Module.  
Provide remote programming by a Conettix  
DX4020 Network Interface Module or an  
ITS-DX4020-G.  
This item determines how often the default status  
information is sent to the serial interface module  
(SIM). The status information includes:  
Provide enhanced route paths for event reporting  
through a network using a Conettix DX4020  
Network Interface Module or an ITS-DX4020-G.  
Although not listed in this section, RPS checks for the  
RPS passcode (refer to Section 2.6 RPS Parameters  
on page 32), Datalock Code, and control panel type  
to determine if this RPS session should continue.  
The current point status (normal or off-normal),  
The control panel’s area status (Master Armed,  
Master Instant Armed, Perimeter Delay Armed,  
Perimeter Instant Armed, Disarmed, Area Entry  
Delay, Perimeter Entry Delay, Area Exit Delay,  
and Perimeter Exit Delay)  
The control panel status (AC Fail, Battery  
Missing, AC Restore, Battery Low, and so on)  
Relay status (relay on or relay off)  
Entries are in 100 millisecond increments. If a 5 is  
entered, the status information is sent every 500  
milliseconds (or 0.5 sec). An entry of 10 equals 1 sec.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 AUXPARM  
EN | 127  
5.4.1 Configuration for RPS Over Network  
RPS Address Verification  
COMMAND 43 (Remote Programming) can establish  
communication with RPS over the phone or over the  
network. Figure 6 on page 128 and Figure 7 on page  
129 show the structure of COMMAND 43.  
Default:  
Selection:  
Yes  
No  
Yes or No  
Verifies that the incoming RPS IP  
address matches the address  
entered in RPS IP Address.  
Answer RPS Over Network  
No  
Do not verify the RPS IP address.  
Allow RPS to connect to the control  
panel from any network source .  
Default:  
Selection:  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes or No  
Enable automatic answer of RPS  
initiated sessions over the network.  
When enabled, this feature will verify that the Remote  
Programming Software connecting to the control  
panel is coming from a known IP address. This  
verification can be momentarily disabled by selecting  
ALLOW ANSWER through COMMAND 43 (Remote  
Programming) menu (refer to Figure 6 on page 128  
and Figure 7 on page 129).  
No  
Do not automatically answer RPS  
initiated sessions over the network.  
This prompt determines if the control panel  
automatically answers RPS initiated sessions through  
a network interface module on the SDI bus.  
This prompt can be momentarily disabled by  
selecting ALLOW ANSWER through COMMAND 43  
(Remote Programming) menu (refer to Figure 6 on  
page 128 and Figure 7 on page 129).  
If the Reset switch (labeled S1) label is in  
the locked position, network RPS  
programming is allowed even if this  
prompt is set to No.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 AUXPARM  
EN | 128  
Figure 6: COMMAND 43 Flow Chart (D1255)  
Command 43, Remote Program  
idle text  
(Area Name)  
(area text)  
<Help?  
Menu>  
Command key pressed  
*System Command*  
43 pressed  
Enter choice:  
Enter choice:  
Use port 7700>  
RPS  
via Network  
RPS via Phone>  
Select  
Port  
RPS via Network>  
<Exit Allow Answer>  
Enter Port Number>  
<Exit  
RPS  
via phone  
Enter choice:  
Enter Port: #####  
Allow Answer  
(or ringing)  
rps via  
Port 7700  
<Exit  
Enter>  
RPS connecting...  
<Exit  
RPS connecting...  
via phone  
rps via  
(via network)  
Port ####  
<Exit  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 AUXPARM  
EN | 129  
Figure 7: COMMAND 43 Flow Chart (D1265)  
Idle text  
COMMAND 43  
RPS VIA PHONE ?  
NEXT  
NEXT  
ESC  
RPS VIA NETWORK?  
NEXT  
ENT  
ENT  
ALLOW ANSWER ?  
USE PORT ##### ?  
ENT  
(or ringing)  
NEXT  
NEXT  
ENT  
ENTER PORT NUM ?  
ENT  
RPS CONNECTING  
ENTER PORT #####  
##### ENT  
ESC  
RPS CONNECTING  
Idle text  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 AUXPARM  
EN | 130  
7. When the keypad reads RPS IP ADDRESS, press  
[NEXT] to advance to the RPS IP PORT option.  
The keypad shows the currently configured port  
number.  
8. Press [ENT] to change the port number.  
9. The [PREV] button acts as a [Backspace] key.  
Press [PREV] to delete the characters of the port  
number and then enter the new port number.  
10. Press [ENT] to save the changes.  
RPS IP Address #  
Default: 0.0.0.0  
Selection: 0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255  
0 to 255  
There are four numbers for an IP  
address. Leading zeros are not  
required.  
This prompt contains the IP address for RPS.  
When the keypad reads PARAMETER SAVED, your  
selection is configured.  
An IP address has four fields. Each field has a range  
of 0 to 255. For example, an IP address is expressed  
as 110.227.64.190. Contact your network  
administrator to determine the IP address to which  
the RPS computer is connected.  
D1260  
1. Refer to Figure 2 on page 8 to access Keypad  
Programming and navigate to the RPS  
Refer to Keypad Programming of RPS IP Address #  
and RPS PortNumber on page 130.  
Parameters option. Press [ENT].The keypad  
shows the RPS Passcode option and the  
currently configured passcode.  
2. Press Phone Number softkey. The keypad shows  
the currently configured phone number and the IP  
Address option.  
RPS Port Number  
Default:  
7750  
3. Press the IP Address softkey. The currently  
configured IP address shows.  
Selection: 1 to 65535  
This prompt specifies the destination port for  
outgoing RPS session requests to the IP address  
specified in RPS IP Address #.  
4. Press the Edit softkey to change the IP address.  
5. The Previous and Next softkeys move the cursor  
through the bytes. The Backspace softkey allows  
you to erase characters. The Clear softkey allows  
you to clear the entire IP address. Use the  
softkeys and the number buttons on the keypad to  
enter the new IP Address.  
Keypad Programming of RPS IP Address # and RPS  
PortNumber  
D1255  
1. Refer to Figure 1 on page 7 to access Keypad  
Programming and navigate to the RPS  
PARAMETERS option. Press [ENT].The keypad  
shows the RPS PASSCODE option and the  
currently configured passcode.  
The keypad does not accept invalid byte  
numbers.  
2. Press [NEXT] twice to advance to the RPS IP  
ADDRESS option and press [ENT]. The currently  
configured IP address shows.  
3. An invisible editing cursor is enabled for the first  
byte.  
4. The [PREV] button acts as a [Backspace] key.  
Press [PREV] to delete the characters of the  
byte, and then enter the new byte numbers, or  
press [NEXT] to move to the next byte.  
6. Press the Save softkey to save the changes.  
When the keypad reads Parameter Saved, your  
selection is configured.  
7. When the keypad reads RPS IP Address, press  
the Port Number softkey. The keypad shows the  
currently configured port number.  
8. Press the Edit softkey to change the port number.  
9. The Backspace softkey allows you to erase  
characters. The Clear softkey allows you to clear  
the entire port number. Use the softkeys and the  
number buttons on the keypad to enter the new  
port number.  
The keypad does not accept invalid byte  
numbers.  
10. Press the Exit softkey to save the changes.  
5. Repeat Step 4 to enter the correct numbers for  
each byte.  
6. Press [ENT] to save the changes.  
When the keypad reads Parameter Saved, your  
selection is configured.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 AUXPARM  
EN | 131  
3. Press [NEXT] or [PREV] to toggle to YES to  
5.5  
Programming Path Numbers and  
IP Addresses for Enhanced  
Communications  
enable enhanced communication or No to disable  
enhanced communication, and then press [ENT].  
When the keypad reads PARAMETER SAVED, your  
selection has been configured.  
Enhanced communications is the ability to  
communicate by some means other than the  
standard digital dialer. In this section, programmable  
parameters allow you to define up to four separate  
enhanced communication paths to which events can  
be routed. To route an event (such as an Alarm or  
Trouble) to an enhanced communication path,  
additional programming must also be completed in  
Section 2.3 Routing on page 17.  
D1260  
1. Refer to Figure 2 on page 8 to access Keypad  
Programming and navigate to the Enhanced  
Comm option. Press the Enhanced Comm  
softkey.  
2. The current Enhanced Enabled configuration  
shows (for example, Enhanced Enabled: Yes).  
3. Press the Edit softkey to change the  
configuration.  
Enhanced Comm  
4. Press the Yes or No softkey, and then press the  
Save softkey to save the changes.  
Default:  
Selection:  
Yes  
No  
Yes or No  
When the keypad reads Parameter Saved, your  
selection is configured.  
Enable enhanced communications  
over the SDI bus.  
Path # IP Address  
No  
Do not enable enhanced  
communications over the SDI bus.  
Default:  
0.0.0.0  
Selection:  
0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255  
If using IP Addresses as the  
communication means for UL 864  
Commercial Fire applications, set this  
parameter to Yes.  
0 to  
255  
There are four numbers in a valid IP  
address. Leading zeros are not required.  
If using IP Addresses as the  
Determines if the control panel allows enhanced  
communications over the SDI bus.  
communication means for UL 864  
Commercial Fire applications, set Path  
# IP Address as necessary.  
Events can be routed to as many as four available  
enhanced communication paths through the SDI bus.  
If an event (or group of events) is routed to an SDI  
path, the number entered in Primary Device  
Path # IP Address contains the IP addresses for each  
of the four enhanced communication paths available.  
determines which SDI path is used (provided that  
RG# Prim, Primary SDI was set to Yes in Routing).  
An IP address has four fields. Each field has a range  
of 0 to 255. For example, an IP address is expressed  
as 110.227.64.190. Contact your network  
administrator to obtain the appropriate IP Address to  
contact a central station receiver.  
If events are to be routed to an IP address (in a  
private LAN or WAN application), determine which  
path is used (Path 1 to Path 4), and enter the  
appropriate IP Address for that path (refer to Path #  
IP Address on page 131).  
Refer to Keypad Programming of Path # IP Address,  
Path # Port Number, and Path # Poll Rate on page  
132.  
If events are to be routed to an SDI Path but not to an  
IP Address, allow the setting for Path # IP Address  
to remain at 0. Path # Poll Rate, Path # Ack Wait,  
and Path # Retry Count must be programmed.  
Path # Port Number  
Default:  
7700  
Keypad Programming to Enable or Disable  
Enhanced Comm  
Selection:  
1 to 65535  
This prompt specifies the destinaton port number for  
each of the four enhanced communication route path  
destinations.  
D1255  
1. Refer to Figure 1 on page 7 to access Keypad  
Programming and navigate to the ENHANCED  
COMM option. Press [ENT].  
2. The keypad shows the current setting by  
alternating between COMMUNICATIONS> and  
ENHANCED> YES or NO. To configure  
enhanced communications, press [ENT].  
Whenever an IP address or port number  
configured in the control panel is  
changed, the central station must  
resynchronize the control panel’s  
anti-replay/anti-substitution static key.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 AUXPARM  
EN | 132  
Refer to Keypad Programming of Path # IP Address,  
Path # Port Number, and Path # Poll Rate on page  
132.  
The value programmed in Path # Poll Rate is the  
interval at which the control panel sends a Heartbeat  
Poll to the central station receiver. The value  
programmed in Path # Ack Wait is the length of time  
the control panel waits for an acknowledgment of a  
Heartbeat poll. If the acknowledgment is not received,  
the control panel checks to determine if the Path #  
Retry Count entry is greater than 0. If so, the control  
panel retries the number of times programmed (in  
Path # Retry Count) to send the Heartbeat Poll  
before declaring the Path failed and generating a  
COMM TROUBLE SDI ## for SDI 88  
(Path 1 = SDI 88, Path 2 = SDI 89, Path 3 = SDI 90,  
Path 4 = SDI 91) Event. For SDI 92 (Path 1 = SDI 92,  
Path 2 = SDI 93, Path 3 = SDI 94, Path 4 = SDI 95)  
event.  
Path # Poll Rate  
Default:  
Selection:  
0
0
0, 5 to 65535 sec  
Disables the heartbeat poll (not  
recommended, refer to the first  
Important Note that follows).  
5 to 65534  
65535  
Enables the poll rate for the amount  
of time programmed here.  
The maximum number of 65535 sets  
the poll rate to once every 24 hr.  
If Path # Poll Rate is programmed with a value and  
the central station does not acknowledge the poll from  
the control panel, keypads annunciate a trouble  
condition. To send this event to the central station,  
refer to the Comm Trouble prompt in Section 2.12.2  
Panel-Wide Relays on page 81.  
This prompt and the next two prompts determine how  
the SDI Path is supervised between the SDI device  
and the central station receiver(s). Do not confuse  
the SDI Path supervision with the supervision of the  
SDI device itself (the connection of the SDI device to  
the control panel). Each SDI Path can be configured  
to transmit a Heartbeat Poll to the central station for  
supervision purposes. This ensures the integrity of  
the connection at all times.  
Example of Heartbeat:  
Path # Poll Rate is set to 120 sec  
Path # Ack Wait time is set to 10 sec  
Path # Retry Count is set to 2  
If using IP Addresses as the  
Keypad Programming of Path # IP Address, Path #  
Port Number, and Path # Poll Rate  
communication means for UL 864  
Commercial Fire applications, program  
this parameter as necessary.  
D1255  
1. Refer to Figure 1 on page 7 to access Keypad  
Programming and navigate to the ENHANCED  
COMM option. Press [ENT].  
In order to supervise the virtual link  
between the control panel and a central  
station receiver over a network path, you  
must set Path # Poll Rate to a non-zero  
value.  
2. The keypad alternates between  
COMMUNICATIONS> and ENHANCED> YES.  
Press [NEXT] to access the Path 1 - 4 prompt.  
3. Enter the path number you wish to configure and  
press [ENT]. The currently configured IP address  
shows.  
4. Press [ENT] to change the IP address. An  
invisible editing cursor is enabled for the first byte.  
5. The [PREV] button acts as a [Backspace] key.  
Press [PREV] to delete the characters of the byte,  
and then enter the new byte numbers, or press  
[NEXT] to move to the next byte.  
If the control panel is programmed to  
send Heartbeat Poll to the central station,  
a rate of 75 sec maintains the virtual link  
in most network configurations.  
Decreasing the value for Path # Poll  
Rate increases the amount of idle  
communication between the SDI device  
and the central station receiver.  
Increased idle communication between  
the control panel and the receiver  
decreases the control panel’s event  
reporting efficiency.  
The keypad only accepts byte numbers  
valid for the current prompt.  
6. Repeat Step 5 to enter the correct numbers for  
each byte.  
7. Press [ENT] to save the changes.  
The control panel readjusts the Heartbeat  
Poll rate temporarily to less than 300 sec  
to 300 sec when online with RPS. The  
poll rate returns to the programmed value  
after the RPS session ends.  
When the keypad reads PARAMETER SAVED, your  
selection is configured.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 AUXPARM  
EN | 133  
8. The keypad shows the currently configured IP  
address. Press [NEXT]. The currently configured  
port number shows.  
9. Press [ENT] to change the port number.  
10. The [PREV] button acts as a [Backspace] key.  
Press [PREV] to delete the characters of the port  
number and then enter the new port number.  
11. Press [ENT] to save the changes.  
9. The Backspace softkey allows you to erase  
characters. The Clear softkey allows you to clear  
the entire IP address. Use the softkeys and the  
number buttons on the keypad to enter the new  
port number.  
10. Press the Save softkey to save the changes.  
When the keypad reads Parameter Saved, your  
selection is configured.  
When the keypad reads PARAMETER SAVED, your  
selection is configured.  
12. Press [NEXT]. The currently configured path poll  
rate shows.  
11. When the keypad shows the currently configured  
port number and the Poll Rate option, press the  
Poll Rate softkey. The currently configured path  
poll rate shows.  
12. Press the Edit softkey to change the path poll  
rate.  
13. Press [ENT] to change the path poll rate.  
14. The [PREV] button acts as a [Backspace] key.  
Press [PREV] to delete the characters of the poll  
rate then enter the new poll rate.  
13. The Backspace softkey allows you to erase  
characters. The Clear softkey allows you to clear  
the entire poll rate. Use the softkeys and the  
number buttons on the keypad to enter the new  
poll rate.  
15. Press [ENT] to save the changes.  
When the keypad reads PARAMETER SAVED, your  
selection is configured.  
14. Press the Save softkey to save the changes.  
D1260  
When the keypad reads Parameter Saved, your  
selection is configured.  
1. Refer to Figure 2 on page 8 to access Keypad  
Programming and navigate to the Enhanced  
Comm option. Press [ENT].  
2. The Enhanced Enabled configuration shows, as  
does the Select IP Path option. Press the Select  
IP Path to access the Path (1 – 4) prompt.  
3. Enter the path number you wish to configure and  
press [ENTER]. The currently configured IP  
address shows.  
4. Press the Select IP Path softkey to change the  
IP address. An editing cursor is enabled for the  
first byte.  
5. The Previous and Next softkeys move the  
cursor through the bytes. The Backspace  
softkey allows you to erase characters. The  
Clear softkey allows you to clear the entire IP  
address. Use the softkeys and the number  
buttons on the keypad to enter the new IP  
address.  
The keypad only accepts byte numbers  
valid for the current prompt.  
6. Press the Save softkey to save the changes.  
When the keypad reads Parameter Saved, your  
selection is configured.  
7. The keypad shows the currently configured IP  
address and the Port Number option. Press the  
Port Number softkey. The currently configured  
port number shows.  
8. Press the Edit softkey to change the port  
number.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 AUXPARM  
EN | 134  
When the control panel first powers up, the first Heartbeat Poll for Path 1 is sent and is acknowledged in 1 sec.  
120 sec after the first Heartbeat Poll is sent, the second Heartbeat Poll for Path 1 is generated and sent to the  
central station receiver.  
Figure 8: Poll Rate Timeline  
3
1
4
5
6
2
10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120 130 140 150 160 170 180 190 200 210 220 230 240 250 260 270  
7
8
1 - Heartbeat Poll sent  
5 - No acknowledgment, Heartbeat re-sent, retry  
#2  
2 - Acknowledgment received  
6 - Path declared failed  
7 - 10-sec interval  
3 - Second Heartbeat Poll sent  
4 - No acknowledgment, Heartbeat re-sent, retry #1  
8 - Additional Heartbeats sent at the poll rate time  
until acknowledged  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 AUXPARM  
EN | 135  
Example of Retry Count:  
Path # Retry Count  
An acknowledgment of the heartbeat was not  
received within 10 sec. The control panel sends the  
next Heartbeat Poll after the first 10-sec ACK wait  
period expires. If the central station does not  
acknowledge this Heartbeat Poll, the control panel  
continues to re-send. When the resend count is  
reached, the control panel declares this path as failed  
(and generates the Comm Trouble ## Event). The  
control panel continues to re-send the Heartbeat Poll  
at the original poll rate time until it receives an  
acknowledgment, even after declaring a Comm  
Trouble.  
Default:  
Selection:  
0
5
0 to 255  
COMM FAIL RG# SDI ### Events  
are not generated.  
1 to 255  
COMM FAIL RG# SDI ### Events  
are generated after resending  
Heatbeat Poll the number of times  
selected for a given SDI path.  
Determines how many times the control panel  
resends the Heartbeat Poll before declaring a path  
failure and generating a COMM FAIL RG# SDI ###  
(RG # = 1 to 4, SDI ### = 88 for Path 1, 89 for Path  
2, 90 for Path 3, 91 for Path 4) Event.  
When the control panel receives acknowledgment  
from the central station, the control panel returns to  
the normal Poll Rate (which, in this example, is 120  
sec).  
If using IP Addresses as the  
If more than one SDI Path is used, the control panel  
handles them on a successive basis. For example, if  
acknowledgment from SDI Path 1 is not received  
within 10 sec (using the previous example), the  
control panel moves to SDI Path 2 to send its  
Heartbeat Poll (and subsequently waits for the ack)  
before returning to SDI Path 1 to re-send its  
heartbeat.  
communication means for UL 864  
Commercial Fire applications, program  
this parameter as necessary.  
The default settings meet or exceed the  
UL specifications.  
5.5.1 Ant-Replay Security Feature  
The Anti-Replay feature is always enabled in the  
control panel and must be supported by the central  
station receiver.  
If Heartbeat Polls are enabled to send by  
an SDI path, and the Path # Ack Wait  
time is exceeded, a COMM TRBL SDI ##  
event occurs. When this condition occurs,  
all events routed to this path go  
immediately to the backup path  
destination.  
Anti-replay is a strategy that counters “replay”  
attacks. This feature prevents a malicious attack that  
substitutes a control panel or another network  
interface module (NIM) from delivering counterfeit  
events over a network in place of events sent by the  
actual control panel. A replay attack occurs when  
someone records a message sent over the network  
by Device A, and replays this message at a later time  
while pretending to be Device A.  
Entries are made in one-sec increments.  
5 min = 300 sec  
1 hour = 3600 sec  
12 hours = 43,200 sec  
18 hours = 64,800 sec  
5.6  
SDI RPS/Enhanced  
Communications Configuration  
This section provides the necessary prompts for  
configuring the SDI-Network Interface Module (NIM)  
when using it for SDI RPS or SDI enhanced  
communication applications.  
Path # Ack Wait  
Default:  
13  
Selection:  
5 to 65535  
5 sec to 65535 sec  
The control panel waits this amount  
of time to receive an  
Supervise SDI 88  
acknowledgment from the central  
station.  
Default:  
Selection:  
Yes  
No  
Determines how long the control panel waits for an  
acknowledgment from the central station after a  
Heartbeat Poll or an actual event was transmitted.  
This prompt is applicable to SDI transmitted events  
and Heartbeat Polls. Entries are made in one-sec  
increments.  
Yes or No  
Supervise the network interface  
module (NIM) at SDI address 88.  
No  
Do not supervise the network  
interface module (NIM) at SDI  
address 88.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 AUXPARM  
EN | 136  
This item determines whether the NIM is supervised.  
RG# Same Network Receiver  
If the NIM is supervised, disconnecting it from the  
control panel creates a Trouble SDI 88 Event and the  
keypad annunciates a trouble tone and displays  
SERVC SDI 88.  
Default:  
Selection:  
Yes  
No  
Yes or No  
The control panel uses the same  
authentication keys to communicate  
with both the primary and backup  
paths that are the same receiver and  
upon detection of a Communication  
Trouble on either the primary or  
backup enhanced communication  
paths, the working path immediately  
changes to the faster poll rate.  
Supervise SDI 92  
Default:  
Selection:  
Yes  
No  
Yes or No  
Supervise the network interface  
module (NIM) at SDI address 92.  
Do not supervise the network  
interface module (NIM) at SDI  
address 92.  
No  
No  
The control panel uses separate  
authentication keys to communicate  
with the primary and backup  
receivers and upon detection of a  
Communication Trouble on either the  
primary or backup enhanced  
communication paths, the working  
path continues to use its configured  
poll rate.  
This item determines whether the NIM is supervised.  
If the NIM is supervised, disconnecting it from the  
control panel creates a Trouble SDI 92 Event and the  
keypad annunciates a trouble tone and displays  
SERVC SDI 92.  
Trouble SDI 88 or SDI 92 Reports are  
always reported using the account  
number for Area 1.  
For Example: This would be used when a DX4020 is  
reporting to a receiver over a LAN/ WAN and a ITS-  
DX4020-G is reporting to the same receiver over the  
Internet from the cellular service provider. This  
configuration also typically has the poll rate for the  
ITS-DX4020-G set to a slower poll rate than the  
primary such as every 4 hours.  
5.7  
Route Group Parameters  
The RG # Same Network Receiver parameters define  
whether a primary and backup network receiver  
configured within a Route Group are the same  
receiver. This is required to ensure that the  
authentication keys from the control panel to receiver  
are the same when the paths to the receiver use  
different IP Addresses or Port Numbers. These  
parameters also enable the backup path poll time to  
change to the primary poll time in the event of a  
Communication Trouble condition. This operates  
when the following conditions apply:  
In the above example, if there is a  
Communication Trouble Condition on the  
DX4020, then the ITS-DX4020-G will poll  
at the configured poll rate of the DX4020.  
If the poll rate of the DX4020 is set to 5  
minutes or faster, there is a possibility of  
excessive data usage that may exceed  
your data plan with the cellular service  
provider. Be sure that any  
Both primary and backup devices use  
enhanced communication via an SDI device.  
Communication Trouble events are  
addressed as soon as possible.  
Both primary and backup path destinations  
are the same receiver that can be accessed  
from more than one network such as on a  
LAN/WAN and over the Internet (even if they  
have different IP/port settings).  
Either the primary or the backup path (not  
both) has a Communication Trouble  
condition.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 AUXPARM  
EN | 137  
If a second passcode is not entered within the  
5.8  
Miscellaneous  
programmed time, a Duress event is generated  
based on the first user code. Duress reports must be  
enabled in Routing in order to be sent to a central  
station.  
Fire Summary Sustain  
Default:  
Selection:  
Yes  
No  
Yes or No  
Secondary Ambush Code  
Forces the Summary Fire relay  
output to remain on after the Alarm  
Silence command.  
Default:  
Unique  
Selection: Unique or any  
No  
Allows Summary Fire relay output  
to be silent when the Fire Alarm Bell  
output is silenced and all Fire Points  
return to normal.  
Unique  
Any  
The code used to end the timer must  
be different from the code used to  
disarm the area.  
The timer can be stopped using a  
different code, or the same code that  
disarmed the area.  
Use this parameter to set the Summary Fire relay  
output to continue or to stop after the Fire Alarm Bell  
is silenced or times out. Refer to the Summary Fire  
prompt in Section 2.12.2 Panel-Wide Relays on  
page 82.  
The Secondary Ambush Code determines whether  
the same passcode can be used to begin and end  
the Early Ambush process.  
Fire Supervision Restoral Type  
Default:  
Selection:  
0
0
Abort Window  
0, 1, 2  
Default:  
30 sec  
The control panel sends a FIRE  
TROUBLE RESTORE when a Fire  
Supervision point restores to normal.  
Selection:  
15 to 45 sec  
This parameter determines the amount of time the  
control panel delays a Burglar Alarm event from a  
point with P## Alarm Abort set to Yes. If an alarm  
silence operation is performed before this time  
elapses, the alarm transmission is aborted and the  
keypad shows an optional ALARM NOT SENT  
message. When an alarm transmission is  
successfully aborted, no event is written to the control  
panel event log.  
1
2
The control panel sends a FIRE  
ALARM RESTORE when a Fire  
Supervision point restores to normal.  
The control panel sends a FIRE  
SUPERVISION RESTORE when a  
Fire Supervision point restores to  
normal.  
Determines how the control panel sends a Fire  
Supervision Restoral Event.  
When an abort alarm timer starts, it does not stop  
until an alarm silence operation is performed or the  
time expires.  
The Fire Supervision Restore Event is  
part of Fire Events in Routing. If Fire  
Supervision Restore Events are needed,  
simply enable them in Routing.  
This feature does not apply to Fire Alarms  
or invisible point alarms.  
Early Ambush Timer  
Default:  
10 min  
Selection:  
5 to 30 min  
The programmed time is the maximum value of the  
Early Ambush Timer. When Early Ambush is set to  
Yes for a specified area (refer to A# Early Ambush on  
page 48) and the area is disarmed, the user has the  
amount of time programmed here to enter a second  
code into the keypad.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 AUXPARM  
EN | 138  
When a point has P# Swinger Bypass set to Yes,  
the value set in Swinger Count determines the  
number of times the point is faulted erroneously  
within an hour before it is automatically bypassed.  
For SIA CP-01 Compliance:  
Abort Window is a required parameter.  
To meet UL requirements, the combined  
For SIA CP-01 Compliance:  
Entry Delay time and Abort Window time  
must not exceed 60 sec. For Entry Delay  
time programming information, refer to  
P## Entry Delay in the Point Responses  
section of your control panel’s program  
entry guide.  
P## Swinger Bypass can be Yes or No.  
If P## Swinger Bypass is Yes, Swinger Count must  
be 1 or 2.  
Remote Warning  
UL note: Maximum settings for  
residential use:  
Default:  
Yes  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Exit Delay – 120 sec  
Entry Delay = 45 sec bell  
Off-Premise Transmission = 60 sec  
Yes  
The system uses the Alarm Bell  
output to annunciate the arming and  
disarming of an area through remote  
software, or a remote arming device  
such as a key switch or key fob.  
Maximum settings for commercial use:  
Exit Delay – 120 sec no line security  
Entry Delay = 60 sec bell  
Off-Premise Transmission = 60 sec  
No  
No remote warning occurs to  
annunciate the arming and disarming  
of an area through remote software,  
or a remote arming device such as a  
key switch or key fob.  
The system must use both the bell and  
off-premise transmission.  
Passcode Length  
Upon remote arming, the output pulses on for 2 sec.  
Upon remote disarming, the output pulses on, off, on,  
off for 2 sec each.  
Default:  
0
Selection:  
0, 3, 4, 5, or 6  
For SIA CP-01 Compliance  
0
Sets a variable length for user  
passcodes, allowing for backward  
compatibility  
Remote Warning must be set to Yes.  
Crystal Time Adjust  
3, 4, 5,  
or 6  
Sets a fixed length to all user  
passcodes.  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
During entry delay, the code is accepted when the  
last digit is pressed to disarm the area.  
Yes  
No  
Set the clock time control on the  
control panel to the on-board crystal  
frequency.  
For SIA CP-01 Compliance:  
Passcode Length must be set to 3, 4, 5, or 6.  
Do not set the clock time control on  
the control panel to the on-board  
crystal frequency.  
Swinger Count  
Default:  
1
When set to Yes, the control panel switches its clock  
time control from the traditional AC frequency to the  
on-board crystal frequency.  
Selection:  
1, 2, 3, or 4  
1, 2  
Number of fault or trouble bypasses  
allowed per hour for SIA CP-01  
compliance.  
3
4
Optional fault count  
Value used for backward  
compatibility with previous control  
panel operation.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 AUXPARM  
EN | 139  
5.9  
Cross Point Parameters  
Perimeter Relay  
This section discusses the requirements necessary to  
program Cross Point functions.  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Use the Cross Point function on non-fire  
points only.  
Yes  
Change the function of the area-wide  
fail-to-close relays to follow the  
perimeter armed states of their  
areas.  
The Cross Point option reduces false alarms. Points  
can be programmed so that the control panel needs  
to see an Alarm condition within a programmed  
period of time (called Cross Point Time) from at least  
two points within a Cross Point Group (Table 38)  
before Cross Point Alarm Events are generated.  
These points must have P## Cross Point set to Yes  
to generate this event.  
No  
The area-wide fail-to-close relay  
operates normally.  
When set to Yes, the A# Fail to Close relay  
becomes an area-wide perimeter armed relay. This  
relay is activated when all areas assigned to the  
same relay have perimeter points that are armed.  
There are 31 Cross Point Groups in the D9412GV3  
and ten in the D7412GV3. Each Cross Point Group  
consists of eight points and is identified by the point  
numbers in them (for example, Cross Points 1 to 8,  
Cross Points 9 to 16, and so on). The maximum  
number of points that can be programmed to meet  
the Cross Point criteria is two. Point numbers from  
different Cross Point Groups do not affect each other.  
Refer to Table 38 for a complete listing of Cross  
Points comprising each Cross Point Group.  
Early Armed Relay  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
Change activation of Area Armed or  
Perimeter Armed Relay to the  
beginning of the exit delay time.  
Maintain the activation of Area  
Armed or Perimeter Armed Relay at  
the end of the exit delay time.  
When any point with P## Cross Point set to Yes  
detects an alarm condition, the control panel starts a  
timer as programmed in the Cross Point Time  
prompt.  
When this prompt is set to Yes, the Area Armed or  
Perimeter Armed Relay activates at the beginning of  
the exit delay time.  
If a second Cross Point within the same Cross Point  
Group detects an alarm condition, the control panel  
creates a Cross Point Alarm Event for both points,  
provided both points activate inside the Cross Point  
Window. A Cross Point is considered to be in alarm  
when it meets the criteria for Instant Alarm response.  
The Cross Point index must have P## Pt Response  
set to a value that generates an instant alarm  
response.  
Daylight Saving Time  
Default:  
Disabled  
Selection:  
Disabled  
Disabled or US Calendar  
The control panel clock is not  
adjusted for daylight saving time.  
US  
Calendar  
The control panel clock is adjusted  
to the US start/end dates for daylight  
saving.  
If a single Cross Point detects an alarm and stays  
faulted throughout the duration of the Cross Point  
Window, a standard Alarm Report is generated for  
that point.  
Conversely, if a single Cross Point detects an alarm,  
then restores, and no other conditions occur, an  
Unverified Event is generated for that point. A second  
alarm on the first point does not create an Alarm  
Event but rather an Unverified Event.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 6.0 ACCESS CONTROL  
EN | 140  
Cross Point Time  
Table 38: Cross Point Ranges Within Groups  
Default:  
20 sec  
5 sec to 255 sec  
Selection:  
Cross Point  
Group  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Point Range  
Select the amount of time (in seconds) that points  
within a Cross Point Group are in alarm before a  
Cross Point event is generated.  
1
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
8
16  
24  
32  
40  
48  
56  
64  
72  
80  
88  
96  
104  
112  
120  
127  
136  
144  
152  
160  
168  
176  
184  
192  
200  
208  
216  
224  
232  
240  
247  
9
17  
25  
33  
6.0 ACCESS CONTROL  
6.1 Door Profile  
41  
49  
57  
65  
This programming category is used to:  
8
9
Assign an area that also activates the D9210B  
Assign a point to the door  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
73  
81  
89  
97  
Program the door state to change the time when  
the arm state changes  
Allow for the Strike relay to activate upon a fire  
alarm  
105  
113  
121  
129  
137  
145  
153  
161  
169  
177  
185  
193  
201  
209  
217  
225  
233  
241  
Programming the Interlock point.  
Door #  
Default:  
1
Selection:  
1 to 8  
Enter the number of the door you are programming.  
The D9412GV3 supports up to eight  
doors. The D7412GV3 supports two  
doors.  
D# Entry Area #  
Default:  
Selection:  
1 to 8  
0
0 to 8  
The area assigned to the door  
controller to which the reader allows  
access.  
0
Door controller does not function.  
Refer to Section 2.3 Routing on page 17 for  
information about programming the destination (for  
example, the central station) for Unverified Events.  
An Unverified Event does not produce a  
corresponding Restoral Event.  
Assign an area to the door controller. This entry  
allows the D9210B to be polled, activating  
communication to the control panel. This is also the  
area a user exits when initiating an REX.  
The Cross Point function applies only to alarm  
conditions. It does not apply to supervisory or trouble  
conditions. Points programmed with point response D  
(Delayed) eventually enter into an alarm condition if  
the area is not disarmed in time.  
The D# Entry Area # prompt for the  
D9412GV3 is limited to the first 8 areas.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 6.0 ACCESS CONTROL  
EN | 141  
If D# Disarm On Open is set to Yes for the same  
All SDI devices, regardless of area  
assigned, report to Area 1, Account 1 by  
default upon SDI failure. If a D9210B  
becomes disconnected, an SDI Fail ##  
and a Missing Point ### Event is  
created.  
door, and L## Function Level? is set to D or C, the  
custom function executes when the door is physically  
opened.  
A user’s access level and the armed state  
of the area determine whether the custom  
function activates. This access level is  
programmed in the L## Function Level?  
prompt. Refer to 2.10 User Interface on  
page 59.  
If the D9210B is not programmed with a  
D# Entry Area, 9210 NOT READY  
appears at the keypad with this door  
assigned to it when you press the  
[ENTER] key.  
Table 39 on page 141 shows how this programming  
affects custom function activation.  
D#CC#Scope  
Table 39: Effects of Programming on Custom  
Function Activation  
Default:  
Selection:  
1 to 8  
0
0 to 8  
Determines disarming rights. The  
user’s access level and the CC #  
Scope determines which areas are  
disarmed.  
L## Function  
Level?  
Custom Function Activation  
M
User token activates the custom  
function assigned to the Door  
Controller only while the entry area  
for the Door Controller is Master  
Armed or Perimeter Armed.  
(Armed)  
0
Only the area assigned to the D#  
Entry Area disarms this door.  
Enter the keypad number (CC#) which determines  
the scope of the user ID’s disarming rights. Areas  
disarm on the basis of this keypad’s scope and the  
authority level of the user.  
D
User token activates the custom  
function assigned to the Door  
Controller only while the entry area  
for the Door Controller is disarmed.  
(Disarmed)  
C
User token activates the custom  
function assigned to the Door  
Controller regardless of the armed  
state of the entry area.  
(Armed and  
Disarmed)  
The D# CC# Scope prompt is limited to  
the first 8 keypads.  
-
User token does not run the custom  
function assigned to the Door  
Controller.  
D# Custom Function  
Default:  
0 (Disabled)  
Selection:  
0, 128-143 (128-131 on the  
D7412GV3)  
A user’s security level must have an M,  
P, or D to operate the custom function.  
0
Custom function disabled.  
128-143  
The custom function number that  
executes upon a valid ID, given the  
appropriate user access level and  
area arm state.  
D# Door Point  
Default:  
0
Selection:  
0 to 127, 129 to 247(0 to 75 on the  
D7412GV3)  
You can program a custom function to run at the  
keypad programmed for CC# Scope. This custom  
function activates only for users with an L##  
Function Level? Assignment (refer to Section 2.10  
User Interface on page 76) in which a valid ID can  
execute a custom function during the armed or  
disarmed state. The user number to which the token  
is assigned must have an assigned passcode.  
1 to 127,  
129 to 247  
The point number assigned to this  
door. Points 128 and 248 are  
reserved by the control panel for  
internal use.  
0
No point number is assigned to this  
door.  
Enter the point number assigned to this door. This  
point cannot be used for any other point  
assignments.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 6.0 ACCESS CONTROL  
EN | 142  
Door points must be programmed as  
Perimeter points. If a 24-hour point type  
D# Auto Door?  
is required for the Door point, you can  
use a Perimeter point type with a point  
response of 9 to C. Also, the debounce  
count must be set to 4 in Point  
Assignments.  
Default:  
Selection:  
Yes  
No  
Yes or No  
When the area assigned in D# Entry  
Area # is disarmed, the door is in  
the unlocked state. When that area  
is armed, the door returns to the  
locked state.  
When assigning Points 1 to 8 (control  
panel zones), the end-of-line (EOL)  
resistors must be removed from the  
control panel.  
No  
Door state is not affected by the  
armed state of the area.  
Also, do not enable any POPIT points (or  
OctoPOPIT points) sharing the same  
point number as the Door point. Failure  
to do so results in extra point trouble  
conditions upon reboot.  
Use this program item to automatically unlock the  
door (latched, shunt, and strike) when the entry area  
is disarmed. The door re-locks upon Master or  
Perimeter Arming the area.  
The unlocked state cannot be overridden  
manually.  
D# Interlock Point  
Default:  
Blank  
Selection:  
0 to 127, 129 to 247  
(0 to 75 on the D7412GV3)  
D# Fire Unlock?  
1 to 127,  
129 to 247  
The point number assigned to the  
Interlock point. Points 128 and 248  
are reserved by the control panel for  
internal use.  
Default:  
Selection:  
Yes  
No  
Yes or No  
Relay activates and shunt is applied  
for the door contact automatically  
upon a Fire Alarm.  
0
No point number is assigned to the  
Interlock point.  
No  
Door remains in its current mode  
upon a Fire Alarm.  
Enter the interlock point number. This point, when  
faulted, prevents the door controller from allowing  
access upon a valid ID read or door request.  
Use this program item to activate the relay for the  
door strike and shunt the door zone automatically  
upon a Fire Alarm. This feature overrides a Secure  
Door state, Locked Door state, Auto Door, and an  
Interlock Faulted point. The relay activates for all  
doors with this prompt programmed as Yes when a  
Fire Alarm occurs in any area. Relays that are  
activated by Fire Unlock can be returned to normal  
only through the keypad using the Door Control  
function.  
Do not assign this point to another D# Door Point.  
You can, however, assign it to another controller to  
prevent multiple controllers from activating.  
Door points must be programmed as  
Perimeter points. If a 24-hour point type is  
required for the Door point, you can use a  
Perimeter point type with a Point  
Response of 9 to C. Also, the debounce  
count must be set to 4 in Point  
Doors that are activated by Fire Unlock  
must be returned to normal using the  
Door Control function on the keypad.  
Assignments.  
The Interlock point is considered in a  
normal state if it is bypassed, swinger  
bypassed, or forced armed. This results in  
normal access even if the door remains  
open.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 6.0 ACCESS CONTROL  
EN | 143  
6.2  
Strike Profile  
This command unlocks the door  
regardless of the armed state.  
This programming category is used to create a  
specific door profile for:  
Strike and shunt times.  
Extending strike and shunt times if a door is left  
open.  
Each fire alarm that is generated causes  
a Door Unlocked – Automatic Event.  
Resetting the strike when the door opens.  
Door #  
D# Disarm on Open?  
Default:  
1
Default:  
Selection:  
Yes  
Yes  
Selection:  
1 to 8  
Yes or No  
Enter the door you are programming.  
The area disarms only after the door  
is opened for a user with a valid  
disarm level.  
D# Strike Time  
Default:  
Selection:  
0
10 sec  
No  
The area disarms whether or not the  
door is opened as soon as a user  
with a valid disarm level presents a  
valid token or card.  
1 sec to 240 sec  
Strike Time is not programmed for  
this door.  
Use this program item to determine if the door needs  
to be physically opened before disarming the area  
upon a valid access request. The user initiating the  
access request needs access levels that allow  
disarming with ID.  
1 to 240  
The strike activates for the amount  
of time programmed.  
Enter the amount of time the door controller toggles  
the relay output to activate the door strike. When the  
door strike is activated, the user can open the door.  
The strike activates for a valid token, RTE, REX, and  
the keypad CYCLE DOOR? function.  
D# Card Type  
Default:  
0
D# Shunt Time  
Selection:  
0 to 3  
Default:  
Selection:  
0
10 sec  
0
3
Card format is 26-bit Wiegand.  
0 to 240 sec  
Do not use. Card format is 37-bit  
fidelity.  
Shunt Time is not programmed for  
this door.  
This item must be kept to a value of 0 (26 bit  
Wiegand format).  
1 to 240  
The shunt activates for the amount  
of time programmed.  
Enter the amount of time that the Door point is  
shunted to allow a user to open the door. The  
duration of time should be sufficient so that the  
opened door does not cause the point to enter into a  
trouble, alarm, or faulted condition.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 6.0 ACCESS CONTROL  
EN | 144  
D# Buzz Time  
D# Deactivate On Open?  
Default:  
Selection:  
Yes  
Yes  
Default:  
Selection:  
0
2 sec  
Yes or No  
0 to 240 sec  
Strike deactivates when the door is  
opened after a valid Access Granted  
request.  
Buzz Time is not programmed for  
this door.  
1 to 240  
The buzzer sounds for the amount  
of time programmed.  
No  
Strike remains activated for the  
amount of the programmed strike  
time whether door is opened or  
closed.  
Enter the amount of time the buzzer output sounds to  
notify the user that the strike was activated and the  
door is ready to open. The buzzer stops as soon as  
the door is opened.  
Determines if the strike deactivates immediately upon  
physically opening the door.  
A separate buzzer is required. Many  
readers have an internal buzzer that is  
not affected by Buzz Time.  
In order for this function to work, a point  
needs to be assigned to the door.  
D# Extend Time  
To Reduce False Alarms, maintain D#  
Deactivate on Open? as the default  
(Yes). This helps prevent the door from  
bouncing open and causing a false  
alarm.  
Default:  
10  
Selection:  
0 to 30 sec  
Enter the amount of time that strike, buzz, and shunt  
activation is prolonged if a door is left open and the  
shunt time expires. At the end of the programmed  
extend time, the buzzer continues to buzz until the  
door closes. If programmed, the point assigned to the  
door indicates a trouble, alarm, or fault at the keypad.  
D# RTE Shunt Only?  
Default:  
Selection:  
Yes  
No  
Yes or No  
The CLOSE DOOR # display on keypad  
does not activate if D# Extend Time is  
set to 0.  
Programmed shunt time activates  
so door can be manually opened.  
No  
RTE automatically activates the  
programmed strike and shunt time.  
Regardless of how the Door point is  
programmed, the system generates a  
Trouble Door Left Open Event while the  
system is disarmed, and an Alarm Door  
Left Open Event if the system is armed  
and the door is held open beyond Extend  
Time. Door Closed - Restoral Events are  
generated after the door is held open  
past Extend Time and the door returns to  
normal.  
Use this program item to disable the strike, but still  
activate the programmed shunt time at a Request to  
Enter (RTE) area.  
Use this parameter when a user can  
open a door manually without relying on  
a token or card to activate the strike  
(such as with a push bar).  
When RTE Shunt Only is Yes, RTE  
Events are not logged, reported, or  
printed.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 6.0 ACCESS CONTROL  
EN | 145  
D# REXShunt Only?  
D# Access Granted?  
Default:  
Selection:  
Yes  
No  
Default:  
Selection:  
Yes  
No  
Yes or No  
Yes or No  
Programmed shunt time activates  
so the door can be manually  
opened.  
Access Events from this door  
controller are sent to the control  
panel for processing.  
No  
REX automatically activates the  
programmed strike and shunt time.  
No  
Access Events from this door  
controller are not sent to the control  
panel for processing.  
Use this program item to disable the door strike, but  
activate the programmed D# Shunt Time upon a  
request to exit (REX) from an area.  
This program item determines if Access Granted and  
Door Request Events are sent to the control panel for  
processing memory, printing, and remote reporting.  
Use this parameter when a user can  
open a door manually without relying on  
a token or card to activate the strike  
(such as with a push bar).  
A successful Access Event can be  
started by a(n):  
Valid user ID  
Valid door state changed at the  
keypad.  
When REXShunt Only is Yes, REX  
Events are not logged, reported, or  
printed.  
Automatically scheduled or armed  
state change that holds a door open  
6.3  
Event Profile  
RTE or REX.  
This programming category is used to determine if  
events are created for:  
D# No Entry?  
Access Granted and Access Denied  
Door Requests  
Default:  
Selection:  
Yes  
No  
Yes or No  
Door state changes due to manual (keypad) or  
automatic scheduled or armed state changes  
(skeds/hold open on disarm, normal on armed)  
operation.  
Access Denied Events from this  
door controller are sent to the  
control panel for processing.  
No  
Access Denied Events from this  
door controller are not sent to the  
control panel for processing.  
Door #  
Default:  
1
This program item determines if No Entry Events are  
sent to the control panel for processing memory,  
printing, and remote reporting.  
Selection:  
1 to 8  
Enter the door you plan to program.  
A No Entry Event can be caused by:  
RTE Events require Access Granted to  
be programmed as Yes.  
Invalid or unknown user ID, interlock  
or secured door, or incorrect authority  
level  
RTE or REX at an interlocked door.  
RTE or REX at a door in the secured  
mode.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 6.0 ACCESS CONTROL  
EN | 146  
D# Enter Request?  
Default:  
Selection:  
Yes  
No  
Yes or No  
A Door RTE Event from this door  
controller is sent to the control panel  
for processing.  
No  
A Door RTE Event from this door  
controller is not sent to the control  
panel for processing.  
This program item determines if RTE Events are sent  
to the control panel for processing memory, printing,  
and remote reporting.  
RTE Events require D# Access Granted  
to be programmed as Yes.  
D# Exit Request?  
Default:  
Selection:  
Yes  
No  
Yes or No  
A Door REX Event from this door  
controller is sent to the control panel  
for processing.  
No  
A Door REX Event from this door  
controller is not sent to the control  
panel for processing.  
This program item determines if REX Events are sent  
to the control panel for processing memory, printing,  
and remote reporting.  
REX Events require D# Access Granted  
to be programmed as Yes.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | 7.0 SIA CP-01 Quick Reference  
EN | 147  
7.0 SIA CP-01 Quick Reference  
Table 40: Programming the Control Panels for SIA CP--01 Compliance  
Prompt Name  
Bosch Recommended Settings  
for SIA CP-01 Compliance  
Shipping Default  
References  
Phone #  
(Prefix backup phone number with  
Call Waiting disable command)  
{Blank}  
Page 12  
Duress Type  
Option 3  
Yes  
0 (disabled)  
Page 36  
Page 36  
Page 38  
Page 39  
Page 49  
Page 49  
Page 47  
Page 48  
Page 49  
Page 50  
Page 42  
Page 79  
Page 54  
Page 54  
Page 56  
Page 56  
Page 60  
Page 60  
Page 75  
Page 67  
Page 75  
Page 92  
Page 101  
Page 137  
Page 138  
Page 138  
Page 138  
Page 140  
Page 99  
Cancel Report  
Yes  
A# Exit Dly Time  
A# Duress Enable  
A# Exit Restart  
A# Arm No Exit  
A# Two Man Rule  
A# Early Ambush  
A# Exit Warning  
A# Entry Warning  
A# Burg Time1  
45 sec to 255 sec  
Yes  
60 sec  
No  
Yes or No  
Yes or No  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
No  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
6 min to 90 min  
1 to 128(64), A, B, C  
Yes or No  
Yes or No  
Yes or No  
Yes or No  
-
6 min  
A# Alarm Bell  
A (on-board alarm output)  
CC# Entry Tone  
CC# Exit Tone  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
-
CC# Abort Display  
CC# Cancel Display  
Master Arm Instant  
Perimeter Instant  
L## Send Duress  
L## Disarm  
-
-
- or E  
E2  
- or E  
E2  
L## Passcode Disarm  
P## Entry Delay  
P## Alarm Abort  
Abort Window  
- or E  
E2  
30 sec to 240 sec  
Yes or No  
15 sec to 45 sec  
3 to 6 digits  
1 to 2 trips  
Yes  
30 sec  
Yes3  
30 sec  
Disabled  
1 trip  
Yes  
20 sec  
No  
Passcode Length  
Swinger Count  
Remote Warning  
Cross Point Time  
P## Cross Point  
5 to 255 sec  
Yes or No  
1
2
3
The SIA allowed range is 1 min to 90 min. Must additionally comply with UL requirements, refer to section A# Burg Time.  
L14 is the default duress user index.  
The default for P## Alarm Abort is No for P3, P4, P5, and P22.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | Programming Prompts Directory  
EN | 148  
Programming Prompts Directory  
Panel and Area Wide Parameters ................ 12  
Phone ....................................................... 12  
Phone # ............................................ 12  
Phone Parameters................................... 14  
Phone # Format................................. 14  
Point/User Flag .................................. 14  
DTMF Dialing..................................... 15  
Phone Supv Time .............................. 16  
Alarm On Fail..................................... 16  
Buzz on Fail....................................... 16  
Two Phone Lines ............................... 16  
Expand Test Report........................... 17  
Routing..................................................... 17  
Communication Attempts ...................... 18  
R# Primary Device............................. 19  
R# Backup Device.............................. 20  
Fire Reports................................. 21  
P## Burglar Event ..............................31  
P## Access Event ..............................31  
P## User Event..................................31  
P## Test Event...................................31  
P## Diag Event ..................................31  
P## Auto Functions Event..................31  
P## RPS Event ..................................31  
P## Relay Event.................................31  
P## Point Event..................................32  
P## Usr Chng Evt...............................32  
RPS Parameters.......................................32  
Panel Initiated Unattended RPS ...........32  
RPS Passcode ...................................32  
Log % Full ..........................................33  
RPS Call Back.....................................34  
RPS Line Monitor ...............................34  
Answer Armed....................................34  
Answer Disarmed...............................34  
RPS Phone # .....................................35  
Miscellaneous..........................................36  
Duress Type.......................................36  
Cancel Report ....................................36  
Area Parameters......................................36  
Area Parameters....................................36  
Area# Area On ...................................36  
Area# Account Number......................37  
A# Force Arm/Bypass Max.................37  
A# Delay Restorals.............................38  
A# Exit Tone.......................................38  
A# Exit Dly Time.................................38  
A# Auto Watch ...................................38  
A# Verify Time....................................38  
A# Duress Enable ..............................39  
A# Area Type .....................................40  
Bell Parameters......................................41  
A# Fire Time.......................................42  
A# Fire Pattern ...................................42  
A# Burg Time .....................................42  
A# Burg Pattern..................................42  
A# Single Ring ...................................43  
A# Bell Test........................................43  
Burglar Reports ........................... 21  
User Reports ............................... 22  
Test Reports................................ 16  
Diagnostics Reports .................... 23  
Relay Reports.............................. 24  
Auto Function Reports................. 25  
RPS Reports ............................... 25  
Point Reports..................................... 26  
User Chng Reports...................... 26  
Access Reports ........................... 27  
Power Supervision.................................. 29  
AC Fail Time...................................... 29  
AC Fail Display .................................. 29  
AC Fail/Restoral Report ..................... 29  
AC Tag Along .................................... 29  
AC/Battery Buzz................................. 30  
Bat Fail/Restoral Report..................... 30  
Printer Parameters.................................. 30  
Printer Address.................................. 30  
P### Area Assign ............................ 102  
P## Supervised.................................. 30  
P## Scope ......................................... 31  
P## A1 [through A#] in Scope ..... 31  
P## Fire Events ................................. 31  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | Programming Prompts Directory  
EN | 149  
Open/Close Options .............................. 43  
A# Account O/C ................................. 44  
A# Area O/C ...................................... 45  
A# Disable O/C in Window................. 45  
A# Auto Close.................................... 45  
A# Fail to Open.................................. 45  
A# Fail to Close.................................. 46  
A# Restrictd O/C................................ 46  
A# Perimeter O/C............................... 47  
A# Latest Close Time......................... 44  
Arming Features .................................... 47  
A# Two Man Rule .............................. 47  
A# Early Ambush ............................... 48  
A# Exit Restart................................... 49  
A# Arm No Exit .................................. 49  
A# Exit Warning ................................. 49  
A# Entry Warning............................... 50  
Keypad (Command Center) ................... 50  
Keypad (Command Center) Assignment50  
Cmd Center ...................................... 50  
CC# Supervised................................. 51  
CC# Area Assign ............................... 51  
CC# Scope ........................................ 52  
CC# A1 [through A#] in Scope..... 52  
Custom Function ................................58  
CF### Text ........................................58  
CF### Key Strokes ............................58  
User Interface...........................................59  
Command Authorization.........................60  
Master Arm Delay...............................60  
Master Arm Instant.............................60  
Perimeter Instant................................60  
Perimeter Delay..................................61  
Watch Mode.......................................61  
Perimeter Partial.................................61  
View Area Stat....................................61  
View Memory .....................................62  
View Point Status ...............................62  
Walk Test ...........................................62  
Fire Test.............................................62  
Send Report.......................................62  
Access Control Functions ......................62  
Door Control.......................................62  
Access Ctl Level.................................62  
Change Display..................................63  
Change Time/Date .............................63  
Change Passcode..............................63  
Add User ............................................63  
Del User .............................................63  
Extend Close......................................63  
View Log ............................................64  
Print Log.............................................64  
User Cmd 7........................................64  
User Cmd 9........................................64  
Bypass a Point ...................................64  
Unbypass a Point ...............................64  
Reset Sensors....................................65  
Change Relay ....................................65  
Remote Program................................65  
Move to Area......................................65  
Display Rev........................................65  
Service Walk ......................................65  
Default Text........................................66  
Change Skeds....................................66  
Invisible Walk Test ............................66  
C Function 128 [through 143].............66  
Authority Level Selections......................67  
CC# Enter Key Relay......................... 53  
CC# Enter Key Cycle Door ................ 53  
CC# Assign Door ............................... 53  
CC# Trouble Tone ............................. 54  
CC# Entry Tone ................................. 54  
CC# Exit Tone ................................... 54  
CC# Arm Now Warning...................... 55  
CC# Close Door................................. 55  
CC# Passcode Follows Scope........... 55  
CC# Scroll Lock ................................. 56  
CC# Menu Key Lock.......................... 56  
CC# Abort Display ............................. 56  
CC# Cancel Display........................... 56  
Area Text ............................................... 56  
Area# Is On........................................ 57  
Area# Not Ready ............................... 57  
Area# Is Off........................................ 57  
Area# Account Is On.......................... 57  
Custom Function.................................... 57  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | Programming Prompts Directory  
EN | 150  
Authority Level................................... 67  
L## Disarm ........................................ 67  
L## Master Arm Delay ....................... 68  
L## Master Arm Instant  
L## Area O/C .....................................75  
L## Restricted O/C.............................75  
L## Perimeter O/C .............................75  
L## Send Duress................................75  
L## Passcode Arm.............................75  
L## Passcode Disarm ........................75  
Access Control Levels ..............................75  
L## Security Level..............................75  
L## Disarm Level ...............................76  
L## Function Level.............................76  
Function List............................................77  
Menu Item ..........................................77  
M## Function .....................................77  
M## CC Address 1 [through 16].........78  
Relay Parameters ....................................78  
Area Relays............................................79  
A# Alarm Bell .....................................79  
A# Fire Bell.........................................79  
A# Reset Sensors ..............................79  
A# Fail to Close..................................80  
A# Force Armed .................................80  
A# Watch Mode..................................80  
A# Area Armed...................................80  
A# Area Fault .....................................80  
A# Duress Relay ................................81  
A# Perimeter Fault .............................81  
A# Silent Alarm...................................81  
Panel-Wide Relays.................................81  
AC Failure ..........................................81  
Battery Trouble...................................81  
Phone Fail..........................................81  
Comm Fail..........................................82  
Log % Full ..........................................82  
Summary Fire.....................................82  
Summary Alarm..................................82  
Summary Fire Trouble........................82  
Summary SupFire ..............................82  
Summary Trouble...............................82  
Summary SupBurg.............................82  
Passcode or Token Worksheet..............82  
Reporting and Logging...........................84  
User ### ............................................85  
U### Passcode..................................85  
L## Perimeter Instant......................... 68  
L## Perimeter Delay .......................... 68  
L## Watch Mode................................ 68  
L## Perimeter Partial ......................... 68  
L## View Area Stat ............................ 68  
L## View Memory .............................. 69  
L## View Point Status........................ 69  
L## Walk Test.................................... 69  
L## Fire Test...................................... 69  
L## Send Report................................ 70  
L## Door Control................................ 70  
L## Cycle Door............................ 70  
L## Unlock Door.......................... 70  
L## Secure Door ......................... 70  
L## Access Control Level .................. 71  
L## Change Display........................... 71  
L## Change Time/Date...................... 71  
L## Change Passcode....................... 71  
L## Add User..................................... 72  
L## Del User...................................... 72  
L## Extend Close............................... 72  
L## View Log..................................... 72  
L## Print Log ..................................... 72  
L## User Cmd 7................................. 72  
L## User Cmd 9................................. 72  
L## Bypass a Point............................ 73  
L## Unbypass a Point........................ 73  
L## Reset Sensors ............................ 73  
L## Change Relay ............................. 73  
L## Remote Program......................... 73  
L## Move to Area............................... 73  
L## Display Rev................................. 73  
L## Service Walk............................... 73  
L## Default Text................................. 74  
L## Change Skeds ............................ 74  
L## Invisible Walk Test...................... 74  
Custom Functions.................................. 75  
L## C Function 128 [through 143]...... 75  
L## Force Arm................................... 75  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | Programming Prompts Directory  
EN | 151  
U### User Group............................... 85  
U### Area 1 [through Area #] Auth.... 85  
U### Name........................................ 86  
U### Mstr Site ................................... 86  
U### Mstr Crd Data........................... 86  
U### SU1 through SU3 Site .............. 86  
U### SU1 through SU3 C/D .............. 86  
Points.............................................................. 87  
Point Index............................................... 87  
Point Index......................................... 87  
P## Type ........................................... 87  
Point Responses .........................................91  
P## Pt Response............................... 92  
P## Entry Delay................................. 92  
P## Entry Tone Off ............................ 93  
P## Silent Bell ................................... 93  
P## Ring Until Restored..................... 93  
P## Audible After 2 Failures .............. 93  
P## Invisible Point ............................. 94  
P## Buzz On Fault............................. 95  
P## Watch Point ................................ 96  
P## Relay Response Type ................ 96  
P## Display as Device....................... 96  
P## Local While Disarmed................. 96  
P## Local While Armed ..................... 97  
P## Disable Restorals ....................... 97  
P## Force Arm Returnable ................ 97  
P## Bypass Returnable ..................... 98  
P## Bypassable................................. 98  
P## Swinger Bypass.......................... 99  
P## Report Bypass at Occurrence..... 99  
P## Defer Bypass Report .................. 99  
P## Cross Point................................. 99  
P## Fire Point.................................. 100  
P## Alarm Verify.............................. 100  
P## Resettable ................................ 100  
P## Alarm Abort............................... 101  
Point Assignments................................ 101  
Point Number................................... 101  
P### Point Index.............................. 101  
P### Area Assign ............................ 102  
P### Debounce ............................... 102  
P### Relay ...................................... 103  
P### Point Text................................103  
COMMAND 7 and COMMAND 9............104  
CMD7 Point Index ............................104  
CMD7 Relay.....................................104  
CMD7 Point Text..............................104  
CMD9 Point Index ............................104  
CMD9 Relay.....................................104  
CMD9 Point Text..............................104  
Windows.................................................105  
Opening and Closing............................105  
Window ............................................105  
W# Sunday.......................................105  
W# Monday......................................106  
W# Tuesday.....................................106  
W# Wednesday................................106  
W# Thursday....................................106  
W# Friday.........................................106  
W# Saturday ....................................106  
W# Open Early Begin.......................106  
W# Open Window Start....................107  
W# Open Window Stop....................107  
W# Close Early Begin ......................108  
W# Close Window Start....................109  
W# Close Window Stop....................109  
W# Xept Holiday...............................110  
W# Holiday 1....................................110  
W# Holiday 2....................................110  
W# Holiday 3....................................110  
W# Holiday 4....................................110  
W# Area 1 [through 8] ......................110  
User Group Windows...........................112  
User Windows # ...............................112  
UW# User Group..............................112  
UW# Sunday....................................113  
UW# Monday ...................................113  
UW# Tuesday ..................................113  
UW# Wednesday .............................113  
UW# Thursday .................................113  
UW# Friday ......................................113  
UW# Saturday..................................113  
UW# Group Enable ..........................113  
UW# Group Disable .........................113  
Holiday Indexes for User Group Windows114  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | Programming Prompts Directory  
Supervise SDI 80 .............................125  
Status Rate ......................................126  
EN | 152  
UW# Xept Holiday............................ 114  
UW# Holiday 1 [through 4]............... 114  
Schedules (Skeds)................................ 114  
Sked Number................................... 114  
S## TimeEdit ................................... 114  
S## Function Code .......................... 114  
S## Area 1[through #] ............... 115  
S## Area 1[through #] ............... 115  
S## Point Number ..................... 115  
S## Point Number ..................... 115  
S## Area 1[through #] ............... 116  
S## Relay Number .................... 116  
S## Relay Number .................... 116  
S## Defer Test .......................... 117  
S## Hourly Report..................... 117  
S## Defer Status ....................... 117  
S## Cmd Center........................ 118  
S## Custom Func...................... 118  
S## Cmd Center 1[through 8].... 119  
S## Access Ctl Level #.............. 119  
S## Access Ctl Level #.............. 120  
S## Door 1 [through 8] .............. 120  
S## Door 1 [through 8] .............. 120  
S## Door 1 [through 8] .............. 120  
S## Door 1 [through 8] .............. 121  
S## Door 1 [through 8] .............. 121  
S## Door 1 [through 8] .............. 121  
S## Time ......................................... 123  
S## Date.......................................... 123  
S## Sunday ..................................... 123  
S## Monday..................................... 123  
S## Tuesday.................................... 123  
S## Wednesday............................... 123  
S## Thursday .................................. 123  
S## Friday ....................................... 123  
S## Saturday................................... 123  
S## Xept Holiday ............................. 123  
S## Holiday # ................................. 124  
Holiday Indexes..................................... 124  
Add/Change/Delete ............................. 124  
Date................................................. 124  
AUXPARM ................................................... 125  
SDI Automation .................................... 125  
SDI RPS Parameters.............................126  
RPS Port Number.............................130  
Programming Path Numbers and IP  
Addresses for Enhanced Communications  
.................................................................131  
Enhanced Comm..............................131  
Path # IP Address ............................131  
Path # Port Number..........................131  
Path # Ack Wait................................135  
Path # Retry Count...........................135  
SDI RPS/Enhanced Communications  
Configuration .............................................135  
Supervise SDI 88 .............................135  
Supervise SDI 92 .............................136  
Route Group Parameters ........................136  
RG# Same Network Receiver .........136  
Miscellaneous.......................................137  
Fire Summary Sustain......................137  
Fire Supervision Restoral Type ........137  
Early Ambush Timer.........................137  
Secondary Ambush Code.................137  
Abort Window...................................137  
Passcode Length..............................138  
Swinger Count..................................138  
Remote Warning ..............................138  
Perimeter Relay................................139  
Early Armed Relay ...........................139  
Cross Point Parameters........................139  
Cross Point Time..............................140  
ACCESS CONTROL .....................................140  
Door Profile............................................140  
Door # ..............................................140  
D# Entry Area #................................140  
D#CC#Scope ...................................141  
D# Custom Function.........................141  
D# Door Point...................................141  
D# Interlock Point.............................142  
D# Auto Door? .................................142  
D# Fire Unlock?................................142  
D# Disarm on Open?........................143  
D# Card Type...................................143  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412GV3/D7412GV3 | Program Entry Guide | Programming Prompts Directory  
EN | 153  
Strike Profile.......................................... 143  
Door #.............................................. 143  
D# Strike Time ................................. 143  
D# Shunt Time................................. 143  
D# Buzz Time .................................. 144  
D# Extend Time ............................... 144  
D# Deactivate On Open?................. 144  
D# RTE Shunt Only? ....................... 144  
D# REXShunt Only? ........................ 145  
Event Profile .......................................... 145  
Door #.............................................. 145  
D# Access Granted?........................ 145  
D# No Entry? ................................... 145  
D# Enter Request? .......................... 146  
D# Exit Request?............................. 146  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc. | 10/11 | F01U170807-02  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Bosch Security Systems, Inc.  
130 Perinton Parkway  
Fairport, NY, 14450  
USA  
www.boschsecurity.com  
© Bosch Security Systems, Inc. 2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Black Box Log Splitter AC156A 8 User Manual
Black Box TV Cables VGA Video Cable User Manual
Black Decker Trimmer HH2450 User Manual
Bosch Power Tools Trimmer 1608LX User Manual
Boston Acoustics Car Speaker ISTS User Manual
Cables to Go Switch KNV104D User Manual
Campbell Hausfeld Nail Gun NB0064 User Manual
Cannon Boating Equipment 1979220 User Manual
Canon Printer QY8 1360 000 User Manual
Casio Cell Phone OMC811 User Manual